PowerPC64 dynamic symbol tweaks
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf64-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC64-specific support for 64-bit ELF.
2 Copyright (C) 1999-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Linus Nordberg, Swox AB <info@swox.com>,
4 based on elf32-ppc.c by Ian Lance Taylor.
5 Largely rewritten by Alan Modra.
6
7 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
20 with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
21 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22
23
24 /* The 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI may be found at
25 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/PPC-elf64abi.txt, and
26 http://www.linuxbase.org/spec/ELF/ppc64/spec/book1.html */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc64.h"
35 #include "elf64-ppc.h"
36 #include "dwarf2.h"
37
38 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_ha_reloc
39 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
40 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_branch_reloc
41 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
42 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc
43 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
44 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc
45 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
46 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc
47 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
48 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_reloc
49 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
50 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc
51 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
52 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc
53 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc
55 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc
57 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
58 static bfd_vma opd_entry_value
59 (asection *, bfd_vma, asection **, bfd_vma *, bfd_boolean);
60
61 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf64_le_vec
62 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf64-powerpcle"
63 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_vec
64 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc"
65 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
66 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC64_ELF_DATA
67 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC64
68 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
69 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
70 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
71 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc64_elf_info_to_howto
72
73 #define elf_backend_want_got_sym 0
74 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 0
75 #define elf_backend_plt_alignment 3
76 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
77 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 8
78 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
79 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
80 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
81 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
82 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
83 #define elf_backend_default_execstack 0
84
85 #define bfd_elf64_mkobject ppc64_elf_mkobject
86 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup
87 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup
88 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
89 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_print_private_bfd_data ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data
90 #define bfd_elf64_new_section_hook ppc64_elf_new_section_hook
91 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create
92 #define bfd_elf64_get_synthetic_symtab ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
93 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_link_just_syms ppc64_elf_link_just_syms
94 #define bfd_elf64_bfd_gc_sections ppc64_elf_gc_sections
95
96 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc64_elf_object_p
97 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus
98 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo
99 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc64_elf_write_core_note
100 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections
101 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
102 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook
103 #define elf_backend_check_directives ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs
104 #define elf_backend_notice_as_needed ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed
105 #define elf_backend_archive_symbol_lookup ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup
106 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc64_elf_check_relocs
107 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
108 #define elf_backend_gc_keep ppc64_elf_gc_keep
109 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_dynamic_ref ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref
110 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook
111 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
112 #define elf_backend_hide_symbol ppc64_elf_hide_symbol
113 #define elf_backend_maybe_function_sym ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym
114 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust
115 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
116 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc64_elf_hash_symbol
117 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_2_index_sections
118 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc64_elf_action_discarded
119 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc64_elf_relocate_section
120 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
121 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class
122 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
123 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook
124 #define elf_backend_special_sections ppc64_elf_special_sections
125 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol_attribute ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute
126 #define elf_backend_merge_symbol ppc64_elf_merge_symbol
127 #define elf_backend_get_reloc_section bfd_get_section_by_name
128
129 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
130 section. */
131 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
132
133 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table. */
134 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 8)
135 #define LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 16 : 8)
136
137 /* The initial size of the plt reserved for the dynamic linker. */
138 #define PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 24 : 16)
139
140 /* Offsets to some stack save slots. */
141 #define STK_LR 16
142 #define STK_TOC(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 40 : 24)
143 /* This one is dodgy. ELFv2 does not have a linker word, so use the
144 CR save slot. Used only by optimised __tls_get_addr call stub,
145 relying on __tls_get_addr_opt not saving CR.. */
146 #define STK_LINKER(htab) (htab->opd_abi ? 32 : 8)
147
148 /* TOC base pointers offset from start of TOC. */
149 #define TOC_BASE_OFF 0x8000
150 /* TOC base alignment. */
151 #define TOC_BASE_ALIGN 256
152
153 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
154 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
155 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
156
157 /* .plt call stub instructions. The normal stub is like this, but
158 sometimes the .plt entry crosses a 64k boundary and we need to
159 insert an addi to adjust r11. */
160 #define STD_R2_0R1 0xf8410000 /* std %r2,0+40(%r1) */
161 #define ADDIS_R11_R2 0x3d620000 /* addis %r11,%r2,xxx@ha */
162 #define LD_R12_0R11 0xe98b0000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0@l(%r11) */
163 #define MTCTR_R12 0x7d8903a6 /* mtctr %r12 */
164 #define LD_R2_0R11 0xe84b0000 /* ld %r2,xxx+8@l(%r11) */
165 #define LD_R11_0R11 0xe96b0000 /* ld %r11,xxx+16@l(%r11) */
166 #define BCTR 0x4e800420 /* bctr */
167
168 #define ADDI_R11_R11 0x396b0000 /* addi %r11,%r11,off@l */
169 #define ADDI_R12_R11 0x398b0000 /* addi %r12,%r11,off@l */
170 #define ADDI_R12_R12 0x398c0000 /* addi %r12,%r12,off@l */
171 #define ADDIS_R2_R2 0x3c420000 /* addis %r2,%r2,off@ha */
172 #define ADDI_R2_R2 0x38420000 /* addi %r2,%r2,off@l */
173
174 #define XOR_R2_R12_R12 0x7d826278 /* xor %r2,%r12,%r12 */
175 #define ADD_R11_R11_R2 0x7d6b1214 /* add %r11,%r11,%r2 */
176 #define XOR_R11_R12_R12 0x7d8b6278 /* xor %r11,%r12,%r12 */
177 #define ADD_R2_R2_R11 0x7c425a14 /* add %r2,%r2,%r11 */
178 #define CMPLDI_R2_0 0x28220000 /* cmpldi %r2,0 */
179 #define BNECTR 0x4ca20420 /* bnectr+ */
180 #define BNECTR_P4 0x4ce20420 /* bnectr+ */
181
182 #define LD_R12_0R2 0xe9820000 /* ld %r12,xxx+0(%r2) */
183 #define LD_R11_0R2 0xe9620000 /* ld %r11,xxx+0(%r2) */
184 #define LD_R2_0R2 0xe8420000 /* ld %r2,xxx+0(%r2) */
185
186 #define LD_R2_0R1 0xe8410000 /* ld %r2,0(%r1) */
187 #define LD_R2_0R12 0xe84c0000 /* ld %r2,0(%r12) */
188 #define ADD_R2_R2_R12 0x7c426214 /* add %r2,%r2,%r12 */
189
190 #define LI_R11_0 0x39600000 /* li %r11,0 */
191 #define LIS_R2 0x3c400000 /* lis %r2,xxx@ha */
192 #define LIS_R11 0x3d600000 /* lis %r11,xxx@ha */
193 #define LIS_R12 0x3d800000 /* lis %r12,xxx@ha */
194 #define ADDIS_R2_R12 0x3c4c0000 /* addis %r2,%r12,xxx@ha */
195 #define ADDIS_R12_R2 0x3d820000 /* addis %r12,%r2,xxx@ha */
196 #define ADDIS_R12_R11 0x3d8b0000 /* addis %r12,%r11,xxx@ha */
197 #define ADDIS_R12_R12 0x3d8c0000 /* addis %r12,%r12,xxx@ha */
198 #define ORIS_R12_R12_0 0x658c0000 /* oris %r12,%r12,xxx@hi */
199 #define ORI_R11_R11_0 0x616b0000 /* ori %r11,%r11,xxx@l */
200 #define ORI_R12_R12_0 0x618c0000 /* ori %r12,%r12,xxx@l */
201 #define LD_R12_0R12 0xe98c0000 /* ld %r12,xxx@l(%r12) */
202 #define SLDI_R11_R11_34 0x796b1746 /* sldi %r11,%r11,34 */
203 #define SLDI_R12_R12_32 0x799c07c6 /* sldi %r12,%r12,32 */
204 #define LDX_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b602a /* ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
205 #define ADD_R12_R11_R12 0x7d8b6214 /* add %r12,%r11,%r12 */
206 #define PADDI_R12_PC 0x0610000039800000ULL
207 #define PLD_R12_PC 0x04100000e5800000ULL
208 #define PNOP 0x0700000000000000ULL
209
210 /* __glink_PLTresolve stub instructions. We enter with the index in R0. */
211 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE(htab) \
212 (8u + (htab->opd_abi ? 11 * 4 : 14 * 4))
213 /* 0: */
214 /* .quad plt0-1f */
215 /* __glink: */
216 #define MFLR_R12 0x7d8802a6 /* mflr %12 */
217 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005 /* bcl 20,31,1f */
218 /* 1: */
219 #define MFLR_R11 0x7d6802a6 /* mflr %11 */
220 /* ld %2,(0b-1b)(%11) */
221 #define MTLR_R12 0x7d8803a6 /* mtlr %12 */
222 #define ADD_R11_R2_R11 0x7d625a14 /* add %11,%2,%11 */
223 /* ld %12,0(%11) */
224 /* ld %2,8(%11) */
225 /* mtctr %12 */
226 /* ld %11,16(%11) */
227 /* bctr */
228 #define MFLR_R0 0x7c0802a6 /* mflr %r0 */
229 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
230 #define SUB_R12_R12_R11 0x7d8b6050 /* subf %r12,%r11,%r12 */
231 #define ADDI_R0_R12 0x380c0000 /* addi %r0,%r12,0 */
232 #define SRDI_R0_R0_2 0x7800f082 /* rldicl %r0,%r0,62,2 */
233
234 /* Pad with this. */
235 #define NOP 0x60000000
236
237 /* Some other nops. */
238 #define CROR_151515 0x4def7b82
239 #define CROR_313131 0x4ffffb82
240
241 /* .glink entries for the first 32k functions are two instructions. */
242 #define LI_R0_0 0x38000000 /* li %r0,0 */
243 #define B_DOT 0x48000000 /* b . */
244
245 /* After that, we need two instructions to load the index, followed by
246 a branch. */
247 #define LIS_R0_0 0x3c000000 /* lis %r0,0 */
248 #define ORI_R0_R0_0 0x60000000 /* ori %r0,%r0,0 */
249
250 /* Instructions used by the save and restore reg functions. */
251 #define STD_R0_0R1 0xf8010000 /* std %r0,0(%r1) */
252 #define STD_R0_0R12 0xf80c0000 /* std %r0,0(%r12) */
253 #define LD_R0_0R1 0xe8010000 /* ld %r0,0(%r1) */
254 #define LD_R0_0R12 0xe80c0000 /* ld %r0,0(%r12) */
255 #define STFD_FR0_0R1 0xd8010000 /* stfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
256 #define LFD_FR0_0R1 0xc8010000 /* lfd %fr0,0(%r1) */
257 #define LI_R12_0 0x39800000 /* li %r12,0 */
258 #define STVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c01ce /* stvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
259 #define LVX_VR0_R12_R0 0x7c0c00ce /* lvx %v0,%r12,%r0 */
260 #define MTLR_R0 0x7c0803a6 /* mtlr %r0 */
261 #define BLR 0x4e800020 /* blr */
262
263 /* Since .opd is an array of descriptors and each entry will end up
264 with identical R_PPC64_RELATIVE relocs, there is really no need to
265 propagate .opd relocs; The dynamic linker should be taught to
266 relocate .opd without reloc entries. */
267 #ifndef NO_OPD_RELOCS
268 #define NO_OPD_RELOCS 0
269 #endif
270
271 #ifndef ARRAY_SIZE
272 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
273 #endif
274
275 static inline int
276 abiversion (bfd *abfd)
277 {
278 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI;
279 }
280
281 static inline void
282 set_abiversion (bfd *abfd, int ver)
283 {
284 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC64_ABI;
285 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= ver & EF_PPC64_ABI;
286 }
287 \f
288 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
289 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
290 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
291 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
292 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
293 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
294 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
295 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
296 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
297 complain, special_func) \
298 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
299 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
300 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
301
302 static reloc_howto_type *ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) R_PPC64_max];
303
304 static reloc_howto_type ppc64_elf_howto_raw[] =
305 {
306 /* This reloc does nothing. */
307 HOW (R_PPC64_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
308 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
309
310 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
311 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
312 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
313
314 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
315 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
316 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
317 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
318
319 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
320 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
321 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
322
323 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
324 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Bits 16-31 of an address. */
328 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Bits 16-31 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low 16
332 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
333 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
334 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
335
336 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
337 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
338 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
339 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
340
341 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
342 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
343 bits must be zero. */
344 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
345 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
346
347 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
348 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
349 two bits must be zero. */
350 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
351 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
352
353 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
354 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
355 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
356
357 /* A variant of R_PPC64_REL24, used when r2 is not the toc pointer. */
358 HOW (R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC, 2, 26, 0x03fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
359 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
360
361 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
362 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
363 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc),
364
365 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
366 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
367 zero. */
368 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
369 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
370
371 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
372 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
373 be zero. */
374 HOW (R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0x0000fffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
375 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc),
376
377 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
378 symbol. */
379 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
380 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
381
382 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
383 the symbol. */
384 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
385 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
386
387 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
388 the symbol. */
389 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
390 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
391
392 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
393 the symbol. */
394 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
395 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
396
397 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
398 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
399 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
400 shared library into the object, because the object being
401 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
402 HOW (R_PPC64_COPY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
403 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
404
405 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR64, but used when setting global offset table
406 entries. */
407 HOW (R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
408 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
409
410 /* Created by the link editor. Marks a procedure linkage table
411 entry for a symbol. */
412 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
413 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
414
415 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
416 doubleword64 is set to the load address of the object, plus the
417 addend. */
418 HOW (R_PPC64_RELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
420
421 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
422 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
423 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
424
425 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
426 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
427 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
428
429 /* 32-bit PC relative. */
430 HOW (R_PPC64_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
431 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
432
433 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
434 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
435 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
436
437 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
438 FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL32 not supported. */
439 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
440 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
443 the symbol. */
444 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
445 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
446
447 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
448 the symbol. */
449 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
450 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
451
452 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
453 the symbol. */
454 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
455 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
456
457 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
458 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
459 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
460
461 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but no overflow warning. */
462 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
463 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
464
465 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
466 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
467 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
468
469 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
470 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
471 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc),
472
473 /* Like R_PPC64_REL24 without touching the two least significant bits. */
474 HOW (R_PPC64_REL30, 2, 30, 0xfffffffc, 2, TRUE, dont,
475 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
476
477 /* Relocs in the 64-bit PowerPC ELF ABI, not in the 32-bit ABI. */
478
479 /* A standard 64-bit relocation. */
480 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
481 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
482
483 /* The bits 32-47 of an address. */
484 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
485 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
486
487 /* The bits 32-47 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
488 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
489 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
490 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
491
492 /* The bits 48-63 of an address. */
493 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
494 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
495
496 /* The bits 48-63 of an address, plus 1 if the contents of the low
497 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
498 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
499 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
500
501 /* Like ADDR64, but may be unaligned. */
502 HOW (R_PPC64_UADDR64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
503 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
504
505 /* 64-bit relative relocation. */
506 HOW (R_PPC64_REL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
507 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
508
509 /* 64-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table. */
510 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
511 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
512
513 /* 64-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage
514 table. */
515 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTREL64 not supported. */
516 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, TRUE, dont,
517 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
518
519 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation. */
520 /* R_PPC64_TOC16 47 half16* S + A - .TOC. */
521 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
522 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
523
524 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation without overflow. */
525 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_LO 48 half16 #lo (S + A - .TOC.) */
526 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
527 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
528
529 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits. */
530 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HI 49 half16 #hi (S + A - .TOC.) */
531 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
532 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
533
534 /* 16 bit TOC-relative relocation, high 16 bits, plus 1 if the
535 contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is
536 negative. */
537 /* R_PPC64_TOC16_HA 50 half16 #ha (S + A - .TOC.) */
538 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
539 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc),
540
541 /* 64-bit relocation; insert value of TOC base (.TOC.). */
542 /* R_PPC64_TOC 51 doubleword64 .TOC. */
543 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
544 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc),
545
546 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but also informs the link editor that the
547 value to relocate may (!) refer to a PLT entry which the link
548 editor (a) may replace with the symbol value. If the link editor
549 is unable to fully resolve the symbol, it may (b) create a PLT
550 entry and store the address to the new PLT entry in the GOT.
551 This permits lazy resolution of function symbols at run time.
552 The link editor may also skip all of this and just (c) emit a
553 R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT to tie the symbol to the GOT entry. */
554 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16 not implemented. */
555 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE,signed,
556 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
557
558 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but without overflow. */
559 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
560 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
561 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
562
563 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address. */
564 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI not implemented. */
565 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT_GOT16, but using bits 16-31 of the address, plus
569 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
570 is negative. */
571 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA not implemented. */
572 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
573 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
574
575 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
576 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
577 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
578
579 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
580 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
581 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
582
583 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
584 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
585 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
586
587 /* Like R_PPC64_GOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
588 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
589 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
590
591 /* Like R_PPC64_PLT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
592 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
593 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
594
595 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF, but for instructions with a DS field. */
596 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
597 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
598
599 /* Like R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
600 HOW (R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
601 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc),
602
603 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
604 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
605 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
606
607 /* Like R_PPC64_TOC16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
608 HOW (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
609 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc),
610
611 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16, but for instructions with a DS field. */
612 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS not implemented. */
613 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
614 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
615
616 /* Like R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO, but for instructions with a DS field. */
617 /* FIXME: R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO not implemented. */
618 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
619 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
620
621 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
622 HOW (R_PPC64_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
623 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
624
625 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
626 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
627
628 HOW (R_PPC64_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
630
631 /* Marker reloc for optimizing r2 save in prologue rather than on
632 each plt call stub. */
633 HOW (R_PPC64_TOCSAVE, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
634 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
635
636 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
637 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
638 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
639
640 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
641 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
642
643 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
644 definition of its TLS sym. */
645 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPMOD64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
646 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
647
648 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
649 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
650 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
651 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
652 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
653
654 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
655 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
656 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
659 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
660 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
661
662 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
663 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
664 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
665
666 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
667 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
668 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
669
670 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
671 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
672 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
673
674 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
675 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
676 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
677
678 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
679 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
680 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
681
682 /* Like DTPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
683 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
684 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
685
686 /* Like DTPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
687 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
688 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
689
690 /* Like DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
691 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
692 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
693
694 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
695 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
696 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL64, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
697 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
698
699 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
700 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
701 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
702
703 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
704 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
705 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
706
707 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
708 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
709 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
710
711 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
712 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
713 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
714
715 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
716 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
717 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
718
719 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
720 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, FALSE, dont,
721 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
722
723 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHER, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
724 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
725 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
726
727 /* Like TPREL16_HIGHEST, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
728 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, FALSE, dont,
729 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
730
731 /* Like TPREL16, but for insns with a DS field. */
732 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
733 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
734
735 /* Like TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
736 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
737 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
738
739 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
740 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
741 to the first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
742 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
743 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
744
745 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
746 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
747 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
748
749 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
750 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
751 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
752
753 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
754 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
755 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
756
757 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
758 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
759 first entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
760 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
761 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
762
763 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
764 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
765 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
766
767 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
768 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
769 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
770
771 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
772 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
773 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
774
775 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
776 the offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
777 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
778 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
779
780 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
781 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
782 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
783
784 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
785 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
786 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
787
788 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
789 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
790 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
791
792 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
793 offset to the entry relative to the TOC base (r2). */
794 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
795 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
796
797 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_DS, but no overflow. */
798 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, 1, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, dont,
799 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
800
801 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
802 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
803 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
804
805 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
806 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, signed,
807 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
808
809 HOW (R_PPC64_JMP_IREL, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
810 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
811
812 HOW (R_PPC64_IRELATIVE, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
813 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
814
815 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
816 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
817 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
818
819 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
820 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
821 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
822
823 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
824 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
825 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
826
827 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
828 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
829 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, signed,
830 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
831
832 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
833 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
834
835 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
836 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
837
838 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
839 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
840
841 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 32, TRUE, dont,
842 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
843
844 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
845 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
846
847 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 48, TRUE, dont,
848 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
849
850 /* Like R_PPC64_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
851 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
852 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
853
854 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
855 HOW (R_PPC64_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
856 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
857
858 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI, but no overflow. */
859 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
860 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
861
862 /* Like R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA, but no overflow. */
863 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
864 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
865
866 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
867 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
868 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
869
870 /* Like R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
871 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
872 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
873
874 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI, but no overflow. */
875 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
876 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
877
878 /* Like R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA, but no overflow. */
879 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
880 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
881
882 /* Marker reloc on ELFv2 large-model function entry. */
883 HOW (R_PPC64_ENTRY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
884 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
885
886 /* Like ADDR64, but use local entry point of function. */
887 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL, 4, 64, 0xffffffffffffffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
888 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
889
890 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
891 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
892
893 HOW (R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
894 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
895
896 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
897 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
898
899 HOW (R_PPC64_D34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
900 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
901
902 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_LO, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, dont,
903 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
904
905 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HI30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, FALSE, dont,
906 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
907
908 HOW (R_PPC64_D34_HA30, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 34, FALSE, dont,
909 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
910
911 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
912 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
913
914 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
915 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
916
917 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
918 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
919
920 HOW (R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
921 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
922
923 HOW (R_PPC64_TPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
924 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
925
926 HOW (R_PPC64_DTPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
927 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
928
929 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
930 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
931
932 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
933 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
934
935 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
936 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
937
938 HOW (R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34, 4, 34, 0x3ffff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
939 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc),
940
941 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, FALSE, dont,
942 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
943
944 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, FALSE, dont,
945 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
946
947 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, FALSE, dont,
948 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
949
950 HOW (R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, FALSE, dont,
951 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
952
953 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, TRUE, dont,
954 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
955
956 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 34, TRUE, dont,
957 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
958
959 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, TRUE, dont,
960 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
961
962 HOW (R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34, 1, 16, 0xffff, 50, TRUE, dont,
963 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc),
964
965 HOW (R_PPC64_D28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, FALSE, signed,
966 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
967
968 HOW (R_PPC64_PCREL28, 4, 28, 0xfff0000ffffULL, 0, TRUE, signed,
969 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc),
970
971 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
972 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
973 NULL),
974
975 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
976 HOW (R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
977 NULL),
978 };
979
980 \f
981 /* Initialize the ppc64_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can
982 be done. */
983
984 static void
985 ppc_howto_init (void)
986 {
987 unsigned int i, type;
988
989 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
990 {
991 type = ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
992 BFD_ASSERT (type < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table));
993 ppc64_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
994 }
995 }
996
997 static reloc_howto_type *
998 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd,
999 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
1000 {
1001 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1002
1003 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1004 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1005 ppc_howto_init ();
1006
1007 switch (code)
1008 {
1009 default:
1010 /* xgettext:c-format */
1011 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), abfd,
1012 (int) code);
1013 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1014 return NULL;
1015
1016 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC64_NONE;
1017 break;
1018 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC64_ADDR32;
1019 break;
1020 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC64_ADDR24;
1021 break;
1022 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16;
1023 break;
1024 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO;
1025 break;
1026 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI;
1027 break;
1028 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH;
1029 break;
1030 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
1031 break;
1032 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA;
1033 break;
1034 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14;
1035 break;
1036 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;
1037 break;
1038 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;
1039 break;
1040 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC64_REL24;
1041 break;
1042 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC: r = R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC;
1043 break;
1044 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC64_REL14;
1045 break;
1046 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN;
1047 break;
1048 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN;
1049 break;
1050 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16;
1051 break;
1052 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO;
1053 break;
1054 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HI;
1055 break;
1056 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_HA;
1057 break;
1058 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC64_COPY;
1059 break;
1060 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT;
1061 break;
1062 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL32;
1063 break;
1064 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT32;
1065 break;
1066 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL32;
1067 break;
1068 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO;
1069 break;
1070 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HI;
1071 break;
1072 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_HA;
1073 break;
1074 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF;
1075 break;
1076 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO;
1077 break;
1078 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI;
1079 break;
1080 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA;
1081 break;
1082 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1083 break;
1084 case BFD_RELOC_64: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64;
1085 break;
1086 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER;
1087 break;
1088 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHER_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA;
1089 break;
1090 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST;
1091 break;
1092 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_HIGHEST_S: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA;
1093 break;
1094 case BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL64;
1095 break;
1096 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC64_PLT64;
1097 break;
1098 case BFD_RELOC_64_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_PLTREL64;
1099 break;
1100 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC64_TOC16;
1101 break;
1102 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
1103 break;
1104 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HI;
1105 break;
1106 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
1107 break;
1108 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC: r = R_PPC64_TOC;
1109 break;
1110 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16;
1111 break;
1112 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO;
1113 break;
1114 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI;
1115 break;
1116 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA;
1117 break;
1118 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS;
1119 break;
1120 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS;
1121 break;
1122 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_DS;
1123 break;
1124 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS;
1125 break;
1126 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS;
1127 break;
1128 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS;
1129 break;
1130 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS;
1131 break;
1132 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_DS;
1133 break;
1134 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS;
1135 break;
1136 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS;
1137 break;
1138 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS;
1139 break;
1140 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TLS_PCREL:
1141 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC64_TLS;
1142 break;
1143 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC64_TLSGD;
1144 break;
1145 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC64_TLSLD;
1146 break;
1147 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC64_DTPMOD64;
1148 break;
1149 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16;
1150 break;
1151 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
1152 break;
1153 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI;
1154 break;
1155 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH;
1156 break;
1157 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
1158 break;
1159 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA;
1160 break;
1161 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
1162 break;
1163 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16;
1164 break;
1165 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO;
1166 break;
1167 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI;
1168 break;
1169 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH;
1170 break;
1171 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA;
1172 break;
1173 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA;
1174 break;
1175 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL64;
1176 break;
1177 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16;
1178 break;
1179 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;
1180 break;
1181 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;
1182 break;
1183 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;
1184 break;
1185 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16;
1186 break;
1187 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;
1188 break;
1189 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;
1190 break;
1191 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;
1192 break;
1193 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS;
1194 break;
1195 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1196 break;
1197 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI;
1198 break;
1199 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA;
1200 break;
1201 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS;
1202 break;
1203 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1204 break;
1205 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;
1206 break;
1207 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;
1208 break;
1209 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS;
1210 break;
1211 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS;
1212 break;
1213 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER;
1214 break;
1215 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA;
1216 break;
1217 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST;
1218 break;
1219 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1220 break;
1221 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS;
1222 break;
1223 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS;
1224 break;
1225 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER;
1226 break;
1227 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA;
1228 break;
1229 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST;
1230 break;
1231 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA;
1232 break;
1233 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16;
1234 break;
1235 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_LO;
1236 break;
1237 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HI;
1238 break;
1239 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HA;
1240 break;
1241 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGH: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH;
1242 break;
1243 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA;
1244 break;
1245 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER;
1246 break;
1247 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA;
1248 break;
1249 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST;
1250 break;
1251 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA;
1252 break;
1253 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_16DX_HA;
1254 break;
1255 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA;
1256 break;
1257 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_ENTRY;
1258 break;
1259 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL: r = R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL;
1260 break;
1261 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34: r = R_PPC64_D34;
1262 break;
1263 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_LO: r = R_PPC64_D34_LO;
1264 break;
1265 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HI30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HI30;
1266 break;
1267 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D34_HA30: r = R_PPC64_D34_HA30;
1268 break;
1269 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
1270 break;
1271 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34;
1272 break;
1273 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34: r = R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34;
1274 break;
1275 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL34: r = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
1276 break;
1277 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL34: r = R_PPC64_DTPREL34;
1278 break;
1279 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34;
1280 break;
1281 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34;
1282 break;
1283 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34;
1284 break;
1285 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34: r = R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34;
1286 break;
1287 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34;
1288 break;
1289 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34;
1290 break;
1291 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34;
1292 break;
1293 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34;
1294 break;
1295 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34;
1296 break;
1297 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34;
1298 break;
1299 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34;
1300 break;
1301 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34: r = R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34;
1302 break;
1303 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_D28: r = R_PPC64_D28;
1304 break;
1305 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PCREL28: r = R_PPC64_PCREL28;
1306 break;
1307 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT;
1308 break;
1309 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY;
1310 break;
1311 }
1312
1313 return ppc64_elf_howto_table[r];
1314 };
1315
1316 static reloc_howto_type *
1317 ppc64_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1318 const char *r_name)
1319 {
1320 unsigned int i;
1321
1322 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_raw); i++)
1323 if (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
1324 && strcasecmp (ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
1325 return &ppc64_elf_howto_raw[i];
1326
1327 return NULL;
1328 }
1329
1330 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
1331
1332 static bfd_boolean
1333 ppc64_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd, arelent *cache_ptr,
1334 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
1335 {
1336 unsigned int type;
1337
1338 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
1339 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
1340 ppc_howto_init ();
1341
1342 type = ELF64_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
1343 if (type >= ARRAY_SIZE (ppc64_elf_howto_table))
1344 {
1345 /* xgettext:c-format */
1346 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1347 abfd, type);
1348 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1349 return FALSE;
1350 }
1351 cache_ptr->howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[type];
1352 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL || cache_ptr->howto->name == NULL)
1353 {
1354 /* xgettext:c-format */
1355 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
1356 abfd, type);
1357 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1358 return FALSE;
1359 }
1360
1361 return TRUE;
1362 }
1363
1364 /* Handle the R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA and similar relocs. */
1365
1366 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1367 ppc64_elf_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1368 void *data, asection *input_section,
1369 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1370 {
1371 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1372 long insn;
1373 bfd_size_type octets;
1374 bfd_vma value;
1375
1376 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1377 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1378 link time. */
1379 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1380 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1381 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1382
1383 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 (or 34) bits.
1384 We won't actually be using the low bits, so trashing them
1385 doesn't matter. */
1386 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1387 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34
1388 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34
1389 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34
1390 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34)
1391 reloc_entry->addend += 1ULL << 33;
1392 else
1393 reloc_entry->addend += 1U << 15;
1394 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA)
1395 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1396
1397 value = 0;
1398 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1399 value = symbol->value;
1400 value += (reloc_entry->addend
1401 + symbol->section->output_offset
1402 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
1403 value -= (reloc_entry->address
1404 + input_section->output_offset
1405 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1406 value = (bfd_signed_vma) value >> 16;
1407
1408 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
1409 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1410 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
1411 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
1412 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1413 if (value + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
1414 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1415 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1416 }
1417
1418 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1419 ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1420 void *data, asection *input_section,
1421 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1422 {
1423 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1424 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1425 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1426
1427 if (strcmp (symbol->section->name, ".opd") == 0
1428 && (symbol->section->owner->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0)
1429 {
1430 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (symbol->section,
1431 symbol->value + reloc_entry->addend,
1432 NULL, NULL, FALSE);
1433 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
1434 reloc_entry->addend = dest - (symbol->value
1435 + symbol->section->output_section->vma
1436 + symbol->section->output_offset);
1437 }
1438 else
1439 {
1440 elf_symbol_type *elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symbol;
1441
1442 if (symbol->section->owner != abfd
1443 && symbol->section->owner != NULL
1444 && abiversion (symbol->section->owner) >= 2)
1445 {
1446 unsigned int i;
1447
1448 for (i = 0; i < symbol->section->owner->symcount; ++i)
1449 {
1450 asymbol *symdef = symbol->section->owner->outsymbols[i];
1451
1452 if (strcmp (symdef->name, symbol->name) == 0)
1453 {
1454 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) symdef;
1455 break;
1456 }
1457 }
1458 }
1459 reloc_entry->addend
1460 += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
1461 }
1462 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1463 }
1464
1465 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1466 ppc64_elf_brtaken_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1467 void *data, asection *input_section,
1468 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1469 {
1470 long insn;
1471 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
1472 bfd_size_type octets;
1473 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
1474 bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
1475
1476 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1477 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1478 link time. */
1479 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1480 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1481 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1482
1483 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
1484 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1485 insn &= ~(0x01 << 21);
1486 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
1487 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
1488 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN)
1489 insn |= 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
1490
1491 if (is_isa_v2)
1492 {
1493 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
1494 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
1495 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
1496 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
1497 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
1498 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
1499 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
1500 else
1501 goto out;
1502 }
1503 else
1504 {
1505 bfd_vma target = 0;
1506 bfd_vma from;
1507
1508 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1509 target = symbol->value;
1510 target += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1511 target += symbol->section->output_offset;
1512 target += reloc_entry->addend;
1513
1514 from = (reloc_entry->address
1515 + input_section->output_offset
1516 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1517
1518 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
1519 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (target - from) < 0)
1520 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
1521 }
1522 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1523 out:
1524 return ppc64_elf_branch_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1525 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1526 }
1527
1528 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1529 ppc64_elf_sectoff_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1530 void *data, asection *input_section,
1531 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1532 {
1533 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1534 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1535 link time. */
1536 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1537 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1538 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1539
1540 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1541 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1542 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1543 }
1544
1545 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1546 ppc64_elf_sectoff_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1547 void *data, asection *input_section,
1548 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1549 {
1550 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1551 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1552 link time. */
1553 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1554 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1555 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1556
1557 /* Subtract the symbol section base address. */
1558 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1559
1560 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1561 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1562 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1563 }
1564
1565 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1566 ppc64_elf_toc_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1567 void *data, asection *input_section,
1568 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1569 {
1570 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1571
1572 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1573 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1574 link time. */
1575 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1576 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1577 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1578
1579 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1580 if (TOCstart == 0)
1581 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1582
1583 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1584 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1585 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1586 }
1587
1588 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1589 ppc64_elf_toc_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1590 void *data, asection *input_section,
1591 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1592 {
1593 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1594
1595 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1596 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1597 link time. */
1598 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1599 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1600 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1601
1602 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1603 if (TOCstart == 0)
1604 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1605
1606 /* Subtract the TOC base address. */
1607 reloc_entry->addend -= TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF;
1608
1609 /* Adjust the addend for sign extension of the low 16 bits. */
1610 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
1611 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1612 }
1613
1614 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1615 ppc64_elf_toc64_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1616 void *data, asection *input_section,
1617 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1618 {
1619 bfd_vma TOCstart;
1620 bfd_size_type octets;
1621
1622 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1623 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1624 link time. */
1625 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1626 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1627 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1628
1629 TOCstart = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_section->output_section->owner);
1630 if (TOCstart == 0)
1631 TOCstart = ppc64_elf_set_toc (NULL, input_section->output_section->owner);
1632
1633 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
1634 bfd_put_64 (abfd, TOCstart + TOC_BASE_OFF, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
1635 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1636 }
1637
1638 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1639 ppc64_elf_prefix_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1640 void *data, asection *input_section,
1641 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1642 {
1643 uint64_t insn;
1644 bfd_vma targ;
1645
1646 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1647 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1648 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1649
1650 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1651 insn <<= 32;
1652 insn |= bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1653
1654 targ = (symbol->section->output_section->vma
1655 + symbol->section->output_offset
1656 + reloc_entry->addend);
1657 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1658 targ += symbol->value;
1659 if (reloc_entry->howto->type == R_PPC64_D34_HA30)
1660 targ += 1ULL << 33;
1661 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1662 {
1663 bfd_vma from = (reloc_entry->address
1664 + input_section->output_offset
1665 + input_section->output_section->vma);
1666 targ -=from;
1667 }
1668 targ >>= reloc_entry->howto->rightshift;
1669 insn &= ~reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1670 insn |= ((targ << 16) | (targ & 0xffff)) & reloc_entry->howto->dst_mask;
1671 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
1672 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address + 4);
1673 if (reloc_entry->howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
1674 && (targ + (1ULL << (reloc_entry->howto->bitsize - 1))
1675 >= 1ULL << reloc_entry->howto->bitsize))
1676 return bfd_reloc_overflow;
1677 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1678 }
1679
1680 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1681 ppc64_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1682 void *data, asection *input_section,
1683 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1684 {
1685 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
1686 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
1687 link time. */
1688 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1689 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1690 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1691
1692 if (error_message != NULL)
1693 {
1694 static char buf[60];
1695 sprintf (buf, "generic linker can't handle %s",
1696 reloc_entry->howto->name);
1697 *error_message = buf;
1698 }
1699 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1700 }
1701
1702 /* Track GOT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
1703 than one got entry per symbol. */
1704 struct got_entry
1705 {
1706 struct got_entry *next;
1707
1708 /* The symbol addend that we'll be placing in the GOT. */
1709 bfd_vma addend;
1710
1711 /* Unlike other ELF targets, we use separate GOT entries for the same
1712 symbol referenced from different input files. This is to support
1713 automatic multiple TOC/GOT sections, where the TOC base can vary
1714 from one input file to another. After partitioning into TOC groups
1715 we merge entries within the group.
1716
1717 Point to the BFD owning this GOT entry. */
1718 bfd *owner;
1719
1720 /* Zero for non-tls entries, or TLS_TLS and one of TLS_GD, TLS_LD,
1721 TLS_TPREL or TLS_DTPREL for tls entries. */
1722 unsigned char tls_type;
1723
1724 /* Non-zero if got.ent points to real entry. */
1725 unsigned char is_indirect;
1726
1727 /* Reference count until size_dynamic_sections, GOT offset thereafter. */
1728 union
1729 {
1730 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1731 bfd_vma offset;
1732 struct got_entry *ent;
1733 } got;
1734 };
1735
1736 /* The same for PLT. */
1737 struct plt_entry
1738 {
1739 struct plt_entry *next;
1740
1741 bfd_vma addend;
1742
1743 union
1744 {
1745 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
1746 bfd_vma offset;
1747 } plt;
1748 };
1749
1750 struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata
1751 {
1752 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1753
1754 /* Shortcuts to dynamic linker sections. */
1755 asection *got;
1756 asection *relgot;
1757
1758 /* Used during garbage collection. We attach global symbols defined
1759 on removed .opd entries to this section so that the sym is removed. */
1760 asection *deleted_section;
1761
1762 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. Support for multiple GOT
1763 sections means we potentially need one of these for each input bfd. */
1764 struct got_entry tlsld_got;
1765
1766 union
1767 {
1768 /* A copy of relocs before they are modified for --emit-relocs. */
1769 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
1770
1771 /* Section contents. */
1772 bfd_byte *contents;
1773 } opd;
1774
1775 /* Nonzero if this bfd has small toc/got relocs, ie. that expect
1776 the reloc to be in the range -32768 to 32767. */
1777 unsigned int has_small_toc_reloc : 1;
1778
1779 /* Set if toc/got ha relocs detected not using r2, or lo reloc
1780 instruction not one we handle. */
1781 unsigned int unexpected_toc_insn : 1;
1782
1783 /* Set if PLT/GOT/TOC relocs that can be optimised are present in
1784 this file. */
1785 unsigned int has_optrel : 1;
1786 };
1787
1788 #define ppc64_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1789 ((struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1790
1791 #define ppc64_tlsld_got(bfd) \
1792 (&ppc64_elf_tdata (bfd)->tlsld_got)
1793
1794 #define is_ppc64_elf(bfd) \
1795 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1796 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC64_ELF_DATA)
1797
1798 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1799
1800 static bfd_boolean
1801 ppc64_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1802 {
1803 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc64_elf_obj_tdata),
1804 PPC64_ELF_DATA);
1805 }
1806
1807 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 64 bit input bfd when the
1808 default is 32 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1809
1810 static bfd_boolean
1811 ppc64_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1812 {
1813 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1814 return TRUE;
1815
1816 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
1817 {
1818 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1819
1820 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
1821 {
1822 /* Relies on arch after 32 bit default being 64 bit default. */
1823 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1824 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64);
1825 }
1826 }
1827 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1828 }
1829
1830 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1831
1832 static bfd_boolean
1833 ppc64_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1834 {
1835 size_t offset, size;
1836
1837 if (note->descsz != 504)
1838 return FALSE;
1839
1840 /* pr_cursig */
1841 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1842
1843 /* pr_pid */
1844 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 32);
1845
1846 /* pr_reg */
1847 offset = 112;
1848 size = 384;
1849
1850 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1851 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1852 size, note->descpos + offset);
1853 }
1854
1855 static bfd_boolean
1856 ppc64_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1857 {
1858 if (note->descsz != 136)
1859 return FALSE;
1860
1861 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1862 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1863 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1864 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 40, 16);
1865 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1866 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 56, 80);
1867
1868 return TRUE;
1869 }
1870
1871 static char *
1872 ppc64_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type,
1873 ...)
1874 {
1875 switch (note_type)
1876 {
1877 default:
1878 return NULL;
1879
1880 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1881 {
1882 char data[136] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1883 va_list ap;
1884
1885 va_start (ap, note_type);
1886 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1887 strncpy (data + 40, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1888 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1889 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1890 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1891 -Wstringop-truncation:
1892 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1893 */
1894 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1895 #endif
1896 strncpy (data + 56, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1897 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1898 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1899 #endif
1900 va_end (ap);
1901 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1902 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1903 }
1904
1905 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1906 {
1907 char data[504];
1908 va_list ap;
1909 long pid;
1910 int cursig;
1911 const void *greg;
1912
1913 va_start (ap, note_type);
1914 memset (data, 0, 112);
1915 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1916 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 32);
1917 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1918 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1919 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1920 memcpy (data + 112, greg, 384);
1921 memset (data + 496, 0, 8);
1922 va_end (ap);
1923 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1924 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1925 }
1926 }
1927 }
1928
1929 /* Add extra PPC sections. */
1930
1931 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc64_elf_special_sections[] =
1932 {
1933 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, 0 },
1934 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1935 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1936 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1937 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".toc1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1938 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tocbss"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1939 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1940 };
1941
1942 enum _ppc64_sec_type {
1943 sec_normal = 0,
1944 sec_opd = 1,
1945 sec_toc = 2
1946 };
1947
1948 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data
1949 {
1950 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
1951
1952 union
1953 {
1954 /* An array with one entry for each opd function descriptor,
1955 and some spares since opd entries may be either 16 or 24 bytes. */
1956 #define OPD_NDX(OFF) ((OFF) >> 4)
1957 struct _opd_sec_data
1958 {
1959 /* Points to the function code section for local opd entries. */
1960 asection **func_sec;
1961
1962 /* After editing .opd, adjust references to opd local syms. */
1963 long *adjust;
1964 } opd;
1965
1966 /* An array for toc sections, indexed by offset/8. */
1967 struct _toc_sec_data
1968 {
1969 /* Specifies the relocation symbol index used at a given toc offset. */
1970 unsigned *symndx;
1971
1972 /* And the relocation addend. */
1973 bfd_vma *add;
1974 } toc;
1975 } u;
1976
1977 enum _ppc64_sec_type sec_type:2;
1978
1979 /* Flag set when small branches are detected. Used to
1980 select suitable defaults for the stub group size. */
1981 unsigned int has_14bit_branch:1;
1982
1983 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
1984 unsigned int has_pltcall:1;
1985
1986 /* Flag set when section has PLT/GOT/TOC relocations that can be
1987 optimised. */
1988 unsigned int has_optrel:1;
1989 };
1990
1991 #define ppc64_elf_section_data(sec) \
1992 ((struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
1993
1994 static bfd_boolean
1995 ppc64_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1996 {
1997 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
1998 {
1999 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *sdata;
2000 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
2001
2002 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2003 if (sdata == NULL)
2004 return FALSE;
2005 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2006 }
2007
2008 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2009 }
2010
2011 static struct _opd_sec_data *
2012 get_opd_info (asection * sec)
2013 {
2014 if (sec != NULL
2015 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) != NULL
2016 && ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd)
2017 return &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
2018 return NULL;
2019 }
2020 \f
2021 /* Parameters for the qsort hook. */
2022 static bfd_boolean synthetic_relocatable;
2023 static asection *synthetic_opd;
2024
2025 /* qsort comparison function for ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab. */
2026
2027 static int
2028 compare_symbols (const void *ap, const void *bp)
2029 {
2030 const asymbol *a = *(const asymbol **) ap;
2031 const asymbol *b = *(const asymbol **) bp;
2032
2033 /* Section symbols first. */
2034 if ((a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && !(b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2035 return -1;
2036 if (!(a->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) && (b->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM))
2037 return 1;
2038
2039 /* then .opd symbols. */
2040 if (synthetic_opd != NULL)
2041 {
2042 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") == 0
2043 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2044 return -1;
2045 if (strcmp (a->section->name, ".opd") != 0
2046 && strcmp (b->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2047 return 1;
2048 }
2049
2050 /* then other code symbols. */
2051 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2052 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2053 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2054 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2055 return -1;
2056
2057 if (((a->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2058 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2059 && ((b->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2060 == (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC)))
2061 return 1;
2062
2063 if (synthetic_relocatable)
2064 {
2065 if (a->section->id < b->section->id)
2066 return -1;
2067
2068 if (a->section->id > b->section->id)
2069 return 1;
2070 }
2071
2072 if (a->value + a->section->vma < b->value + b->section->vma)
2073 return -1;
2074
2075 if (a->value + a->section->vma > b->value + b->section->vma)
2076 return 1;
2077
2078 /* For syms with the same value, prefer strong dynamic global function
2079 syms over other syms. */
2080 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0)
2081 return -1;
2082
2083 if ((a->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_GLOBAL) != 0)
2084 return 1;
2085
2086 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0)
2087 return -1;
2088
2089 if ((a->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
2090 return 1;
2091
2092 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0)
2093 return -1;
2094
2095 if ((a->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_WEAK) == 0)
2096 return 1;
2097
2098 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0)
2099 return -1;
2100
2101 if ((a->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) == 0 && (b->flags & BSF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
2102 return 1;
2103
2104 return a > b;
2105 }
2106
2107 /* Search SYMS for a symbol of the given VALUE. */
2108
2109 static asymbol *
2110 sym_exists_at (asymbol **syms, long lo, long hi, unsigned int id, bfd_vma value)
2111 {
2112 long mid;
2113
2114 if (id == (unsigned) -1)
2115 {
2116 while (lo < hi)
2117 {
2118 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2119 if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma < value)
2120 lo = mid + 1;
2121 else if (syms[mid]->value + syms[mid]->section->vma > value)
2122 hi = mid;
2123 else
2124 return syms[mid];
2125 }
2126 }
2127 else
2128 {
2129 while (lo < hi)
2130 {
2131 mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2132 if (syms[mid]->section->id < id)
2133 lo = mid + 1;
2134 else if (syms[mid]->section->id > id)
2135 hi = mid;
2136 else if (syms[mid]->value < value)
2137 lo = mid + 1;
2138 else if (syms[mid]->value > value)
2139 hi = mid;
2140 else
2141 return syms[mid];
2142 }
2143 }
2144 return NULL;
2145 }
2146
2147 static bfd_boolean
2148 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
2149 {
2150 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
2151 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2152 && section->vma <= vma
2153 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
2154 }
2155
2156 /* Create synthetic symbols, effectively restoring "dot-symbol" function
2157 entry syms. Also generate @plt symbols for the glink branch table.
2158 Returns count of synthetic symbols in RET or -1 on error. */
2159
2160 static long
2161 ppc64_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
2162 long static_count, asymbol **static_syms,
2163 long dyn_count, asymbol **dyn_syms,
2164 asymbol **ret)
2165 {
2166 asymbol *s;
2167 size_t i, j, count;
2168 char *names;
2169 size_t symcount, codesecsym, codesecsymend, secsymend, opdsymend;
2170 asection *opd = NULL;
2171 bfd_boolean relocatable = (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0;
2172 asymbol **syms;
2173 int abi = abiversion (abfd);
2174
2175 *ret = NULL;
2176
2177 if (abi < 2)
2178 {
2179 opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".opd");
2180 if (opd == NULL && abi == 1)
2181 return 0;
2182 }
2183
2184 syms = NULL;
2185 codesecsym = 0;
2186 codesecsymend = 0;
2187 secsymend = 0;
2188 opdsymend = 0;
2189 symcount = 0;
2190 if (opd != NULL)
2191 {
2192 symcount = static_count;
2193 if (!relocatable)
2194 symcount += dyn_count;
2195 if (symcount == 0)
2196 return 0;
2197
2198 syms = bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2199 if (syms == NULL)
2200 return -1;
2201
2202 if (!relocatable && static_count != 0 && dyn_count != 0)
2203 {
2204 /* Use both symbol tables. */
2205 memcpy (syms, static_syms, static_count * sizeof (*syms));
2206 memcpy (syms + static_count, dyn_syms,
2207 (dyn_count + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2208 }
2209 else if (!relocatable && static_count == 0)
2210 memcpy (syms, dyn_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2211 else
2212 memcpy (syms, static_syms, (symcount + 1) * sizeof (*syms));
2213
2214 /* Trim uninteresting symbols. Interesting symbols are section,
2215 function, and notype symbols. */
2216 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < symcount; ++i)
2217 if ((syms[i]->flags & (BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL
2218 | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) == 0)
2219 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2220 symcount = j;
2221
2222 synthetic_relocatable = relocatable;
2223 synthetic_opd = opd;
2224 qsort (syms, symcount, sizeof (*syms), compare_symbols);
2225
2226 if (!relocatable && symcount > 1)
2227 {
2228 /* Trim duplicate syms, since we may have merged the normal
2229 and dynamic symbols. Actually, we only care about syms
2230 that have different values, so trim any with the same
2231 value. Don't consider ifunc and ifunc resolver symbols
2232 duplicates however, because GDB wants to know whether a
2233 text symbol is an ifunc resolver. */
2234 for (i = 1, j = 1; i < symcount; ++i)
2235 {
2236 const asymbol *s0 = syms[i - 1];
2237 const asymbol *s1 = syms[i];
2238
2239 if ((s0->value + s0->section->vma
2240 != s1->value + s1->section->vma)
2241 || ((s0->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)
2242 != (s1->flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION)))
2243 syms[j++] = syms[i];
2244 }
2245 symcount = j;
2246 }
2247
2248 i = 0;
2249 /* Note that here and in compare_symbols we can't compare opd and
2250 sym->section directly. With separate debug info files, the
2251 symbols will be extracted from the debug file while abfd passed
2252 to this function is the real binary. */
2253 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
2254 ++i;
2255 codesecsym = i;
2256
2257 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2258 if (((syms[i]->section->flags & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC
2259 | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL))
2260 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2261 || (syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2262 break;
2263 codesecsymend = i;
2264
2265 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2266 if ((syms[i]->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2267 break;
2268 secsymend = i;
2269
2270 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2271 if (strcmp (syms[i]->section->name, ".opd") != 0)
2272 break;
2273 opdsymend = i;
2274
2275 for (; i < symcount; ++i)
2276 if (((syms[i]->section->flags
2277 & (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
2278 != (SEC_CODE | SEC_ALLOC))
2279 break;
2280 symcount = i;
2281 }
2282 count = 0;
2283
2284 if (relocatable)
2285 {
2286 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2287 arelent *r;
2288 size_t size;
2289 size_t relcount;
2290
2291 if (opdsymend == secsymend)
2292 goto done;
2293
2294 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2295 relcount = (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) ? opd->reloc_count : 0;
2296 if (relcount == 0)
2297 goto done;
2298
2299 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, opd, static_syms, FALSE))
2300 {
2301 count = -1;
2302 goto done;
2303 }
2304
2305 size = 0;
2306 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2307 {
2308 asymbol *sym;
2309
2310 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2311 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2312 ++r;
2313
2314 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2315 break;
2316
2317 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2318 continue;
2319
2320 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2321 continue;
2322
2323 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2324 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2325 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2326 {
2327 ++count;
2328 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2329 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2330 }
2331 }
2332
2333 if (size == 0)
2334 goto done;
2335 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2336 if (s == NULL)
2337 {
2338 count = -1;
2339 goto done;
2340 }
2341
2342 names = (char *) (s + count);
2343
2344 for (i = secsymend, r = opd->relocation; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2345 {
2346 asymbol *sym;
2347
2348 while (r < opd->relocation + relcount
2349 && r->address < syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2350 ++r;
2351
2352 if (r == opd->relocation + relcount)
2353 break;
2354
2355 if (r->address != syms[i]->value + opd->vma)
2356 continue;
2357
2358 if (r->howto->type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
2359 continue;
2360
2361 sym = *r->sym_ptr_ptr;
2362 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount,
2363 sym->section->id, sym->value + r->addend))
2364 {
2365 size_t len;
2366
2367 *s = *syms[i];
2368 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2369 s->section = sym->section;
2370 s->value = sym->value + r->addend;
2371 s->name = names;
2372 *names++ = '.';
2373 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2374 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2375 names += len + 1;
2376 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2377 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2378 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2379 s++;
2380 }
2381 }
2382 }
2383 else
2384 {
2385 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
2386 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
2387 size_t size;
2388 size_t plt_count = 0;
2389 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0, resolv_vma = 0;
2390 asection *dynamic, *glink = NULL, *relplt = NULL;
2391 arelent *p;
2392
2393 if (opd != NULL && !bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, opd, &contents))
2394 {
2395 free_contents_and_exit_err:
2396 count = -1;
2397 free_contents_and_exit:
2398 if (contents)
2399 free (contents);
2400 goto done;
2401 }
2402
2403 size = 0;
2404 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2405 {
2406 bfd_vma ent;
2407
2408 /* Ignore bogus symbols. */
2409 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2410 continue;
2411
2412 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2413 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2414 {
2415 ++count;
2416 size += sizeof (asymbol);
2417 size += strlen (syms[i]->name) + 2;
2418 }
2419 }
2420
2421 /* Get start of .glink stubs from DT_PPC64_GLINK. */
2422 if (dyn_count != 0
2423 && (dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")) != NULL)
2424 {
2425 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
2426 size_t extdynsize;
2427 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
2428
2429 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
2430 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2431
2432 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
2433 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
2434
2435 extdyn = dynbuf;
2436 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
2437 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
2438 {
2439 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
2440 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
2441
2442 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
2443 break;
2444
2445 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC64_GLINK)
2446 {
2447 /* The first glink stub starts at DT_PPC64_GLINK plus 32.
2448 See comment in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections. */
2449 glink_vma = dyn.d_un.d_val + 8 * 4;
2450 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
2451 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
2452 glink stubs now reside. */
2453 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma,
2454 &glink_vma);
2455 break;
2456 }
2457 }
2458
2459 free (dynbuf);
2460 }
2461
2462 if (glink != NULL)
2463 {
2464 /* Determine __glink trampoline by reading the relative branch
2465 from the first glink stub. */
2466 bfd_byte buf[4];
2467 unsigned int off = 0;
2468
2469 while (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
2470 glink_vma + off - glink->vma, 4))
2471 {
2472 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
2473 insn ^= B_DOT;
2474 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
2475 {
2476 resolv_vma
2477 = glink_vma + off + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
2478 break;
2479 }
2480 off += 4;
2481 if (off > 4)
2482 break;
2483 }
2484
2485 if (resolv_vma)
2486 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2487
2488 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
2489 if (relplt != NULL)
2490 {
2491 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
2492 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dyn_syms, TRUE))
2493 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2494
2495 plt_count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
2496 size += plt_count * sizeof (asymbol);
2497
2498 p = relplt->relocation;
2499 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2500 {
2501 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
2502 if (p->addend != 0)
2503 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 16;
2504 }
2505 }
2506 }
2507
2508 if (size == 0)
2509 goto free_contents_and_exit;
2510 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
2511 if (s == NULL)
2512 goto free_contents_and_exit_err;
2513
2514 names = (char *) (s + count + plt_count + (resolv_vma != 0));
2515
2516 for (i = secsymend; i < opdsymend; ++i)
2517 {
2518 bfd_vma ent;
2519
2520 if (syms[i]->value > opd->size - 8)
2521 continue;
2522
2523 ent = bfd_get_64 (abfd, contents + syms[i]->value);
2524 if (!sym_exists_at (syms, opdsymend, symcount, -1, ent))
2525 {
2526 size_t lo, hi;
2527 size_t len;
2528 asection *sec = abfd->sections;
2529
2530 *s = *syms[i];
2531 lo = codesecsym;
2532 hi = codesecsymend;
2533 while (lo < hi)
2534 {
2535 size_t mid = (lo + hi) >> 1;
2536 if (syms[mid]->section->vma < ent)
2537 lo = mid + 1;
2538 else if (syms[mid]->section->vma > ent)
2539 hi = mid;
2540 else
2541 {
2542 sec = syms[mid]->section;
2543 break;
2544 }
2545 }
2546
2547 if (lo >= hi && lo > codesecsym)
2548 sec = syms[lo - 1]->section;
2549
2550 for (; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
2551 {
2552 if (sec->vma > ent)
2553 break;
2554 /* SEC_LOAD may not be set if SEC is from a separate debug
2555 info file. */
2556 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2557 break;
2558 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
2559 s->section = sec;
2560 }
2561 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2562 s->value = ent - s->section->vma;
2563 s->name = names;
2564 *names++ = '.';
2565 len = strlen (syms[i]->name);
2566 memcpy (names, syms[i]->name, len + 1);
2567 names += len + 1;
2568 /* Have udata.p point back to the original symbol this
2569 synthetic symbol was derived from. */
2570 s->udata.p = syms[i];
2571 s++;
2572 }
2573 }
2574 free (contents);
2575
2576 if (glink != NULL && relplt != NULL)
2577 {
2578 if (resolv_vma)
2579 {
2580 /* Add a symbol for the main glink trampoline. */
2581 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2582 s->the_bfd = abfd;
2583 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2584 s->section = glink;
2585 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2586 s->name = names;
2587 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve",
2588 sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2589 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2590 s++;
2591 count++;
2592 }
2593
2594 /* FIXME: It would be very much nicer to put sym@plt on the
2595 stub rather than on the glink branch table entry. The
2596 objdump disassembler would then use a sensible symbol
2597 name on plt calls. The difficulty in doing so is
2598 a) finding the stubs, and,
2599 b) matching stubs against plt entries, and,
2600 c) there can be multiple stubs for a given plt entry.
2601
2602 Solving (a) could be done by code scanning, but older
2603 ppc64 binaries used different stubs to current code.
2604 (b) is the tricky one since you need to known the toc
2605 pointer for at least one function that uses a pic stub to
2606 be able to calculate the plt address referenced.
2607 (c) means gdb would need to set multiple breakpoints (or
2608 find the glink branch itself) when setting breakpoints
2609 for pending shared library loads. */
2610 p = relplt->relocation;
2611 for (i = 0; i < plt_count; i++, p++)
2612 {
2613 size_t len;
2614
2615 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
2616 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
2617 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
2618 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
2619 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
2620 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2621 s->section = glink;
2622 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
2623 s->name = names;
2624 s->udata.p = NULL;
2625 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
2626 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
2627 names += len;
2628 if (p->addend != 0)
2629 {
2630 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
2631 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
2632 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
2633 names += strlen (names);
2634 }
2635 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
2636 names += sizeof ("@plt");
2637 s++;
2638 if (abi < 2)
2639 {
2640 glink_vma += 8;
2641 if (i >= 0x8000)
2642 glink_vma += 4;
2643 }
2644 else
2645 glink_vma += 4;
2646 }
2647 count += plt_count;
2648 }
2649 }
2650
2651 done:
2652 free (syms);
2653 return count;
2654 }
2655 \f
2656 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2657 functions above are used generally. Those named ppc64_elf_* are
2658 called by the main ELF linker code. They appear in this file more
2659 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2660 ppc64_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2661 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2662 called.
2663
2664 PowerPC64-ELF uses a similar scheme to PowerPC64-XCOFF in that
2665 functions have both a function code symbol and a function descriptor
2666 symbol. A call to foo in a relocatable object file looks like:
2667
2668 . .text
2669 . x:
2670 . bl .foo
2671 . nop
2672
2673 The function definition in another object file might be:
2674
2675 . .section .opd
2676 . foo: .quad .foo
2677 . .quad .TOC.@tocbase
2678 . .quad 0
2679 .
2680 . .text
2681 . .foo: blr
2682
2683 When the linker resolves the call during a static link, the branch
2684 unsurprisingly just goes to .foo and the .opd information is unused.
2685 If the function definition is in a shared library, things are a little
2686 different: The call goes via a plt call stub, the opd information gets
2687 copied to the plt, and the linker patches the nop.
2688
2689 . x:
2690 . bl .foo_stub
2691 . ld 2,40(1)
2692 .
2693 .
2694 . .foo_stub:
2695 . std 2,40(1) # in practice, the call stub
2696 . addis 11,2,Lfoo@toc@ha # is slightly optimized, but
2697 . addi 11,11,Lfoo@toc@l # this is the general idea
2698 . ld 12,0(11)
2699 . ld 2,8(11)
2700 . mtctr 12
2701 . ld 11,16(11)
2702 . bctr
2703 .
2704 . .section .plt
2705 . Lfoo: reloc (R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT, foo)
2706
2707 The "reloc ()" notation is supposed to indicate that the linker emits
2708 an R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT reloc against foo. The dynamic linker does the opd
2709 copying.
2710
2711 What are the difficulties here? Well, firstly, the relocations
2712 examined by the linker in check_relocs are against the function code
2713 sym .foo, while the dynamic relocation in the plt is emitted against
2714 the function descriptor symbol, foo. Somewhere along the line, we need
2715 to carefully copy dynamic link information from one symbol to the other.
2716 Secondly, the generic part of the elf linker will make .foo a dynamic
2717 symbol as is normal for most other backends. We need foo dynamic
2718 instead, at least for an application final link. However, when
2719 creating a shared library containing foo, we need to have both symbols
2720 dynamic so that references to .foo are satisfied during the early
2721 stages of linking. Otherwise the linker might decide to pull in a
2722 definition from some other object, eg. a static library.
2723
2724 Update: As of August 2004, we support a new convention. Function
2725 calls may use the function descriptor symbol, ie. "bl foo". This
2726 behaves exactly as "bl .foo". */
2727
2728 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2729 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2730 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2731
2732 static int
2733 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2734 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
2735 {
2736 switch (r_type)
2737 {
2738 default:
2739 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2740 address isn't fixed. DTPREL64 is excluded because the
2741 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2742 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC64_OPT_TLS is set. */
2743 return 1;
2744
2745 case R_PPC64_REL32:
2746 case R_PPC64_REL64:
2747 case R_PPC64_REL30:
2748 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
2749 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
2750 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
2751 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
2752 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
2753 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
2754 return 0;
2755
2756 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
2757 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
2758 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
2759 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
2760 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
2761 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
2762 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
2763 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
2764 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
2765 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
2766 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
2767 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
2768 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
2769 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
2770 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2771 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2772 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2773 }
2774 }
2775
2776 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2777 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2778 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2779 shared lib. With code that gcc generates, it's vital that this be
2780 enabled; In the PowerPC64 ABI, the address of a function is actually
2781 the address of a function descriptor, which resides in the .opd
2782 section. gcc uses the descriptor directly rather than going via the
2783 GOT as some other ABI's do, which means that initialized function
2784 pointers must reference the descriptor. Thus, a function pointer
2785 initialized to the address of a function in a shared library will
2786 either require a copy reloc, or a dynamic reloc. Using a copy reloc
2787 redefines the function descriptor symbol to point to the copy. This
2788 presents a problem as a plt entry for that function is also
2789 initialized from the function descriptor symbol and the copy reloc
2790 may not be initialized first. */
2791 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2792
2793 /* Section name for stubs is the associated section name plus this
2794 string. */
2795 #define STUB_SUFFIX ".stub"
2796
2797 /* Linker stubs.
2798 ppc_stub_long_branch:
2799 Used when a 14 bit branch (or even a 24 bit branch) can't reach its
2800 destination, but a 24 bit branch in a stub section will reach.
2801 . b dest
2802
2803 ppc_stub_plt_branch:
2804 Similar to the above, but a 24 bit branch in the stub section won't
2805 reach its destination.
2806 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2807 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r11)
2808 . mtctr %r12
2809 . bctr
2810
2811 ppc_stub_plt_call:
2812 Used to call a function in a shared library. If it so happens that
2813 the plt entry referenced crosses a 64k boundary, then an extra
2814 "addi %r11,%r11,xxx@toc@l" will be inserted before the "mtctr".
2815 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save starts with "std %r2,40(%r1)".
2816 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2817 . ld %r12,xxx+0@toc@l(%r11)
2818 . mtctr %r12
2819 . ld %r2,xxx+8@toc@l(%r11)
2820 . ld %r11,xxx+16@toc@l(%r11)
2821 . bctr
2822
2823 ppc_stub_long_branch and ppc_stub_plt_branch may also have additional
2824 code to adjust the value and save r2 to support multiple toc sections.
2825 A ppc_stub_long_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2826 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2827 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2828 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2829 . b dest
2830
2831 A ppc_stub_plt_branch with an r2 offset looks like:
2832 . std %r2,40(%r1)
2833 . addis %r11,%r2,xxx@toc@ha
2834 . ld %r12,xxx@toc@l(%r11)
2835 . addis %r2,%r2,off@ha
2836 . addi %r2,%r2,off@l
2837 . mtctr %r12
2838 . bctr
2839
2840 All of the above stubs are shown as their ELFv1 variants. ELFv2
2841 variants exist too, simpler for plt calls since a new toc pointer
2842 and static chain are not loaded by the stub. In addition, ELFv2
2843 has some more complex stubs to handle calls marked with NOTOC
2844 relocs from functions where r2 is not a valid toc pointer. These
2845 come in two flavours, the ones shown below, and _both variants that
2846 start with "std %r2,24(%r1)" to save r2 in the unlikely event that
2847 one call is from a function where r2 is used as the toc pointer but
2848 needs a toc adjusting stub for small-model multi-toc, and another
2849 call is from a function where r2 is not valid.
2850 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2851 . mflr %r12
2852 . bcl 20,31,1f
2853 . 1:
2854 . mflr %r11
2855 . mtlr %r12
2856 . addis %r12,%r11,dest-1b@ha
2857 . addi %r12,%r12,dest-1b@l
2858 . b dest
2859
2860 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2861 . mflr %r12
2862 . bcl 20,31,1f
2863 . 1:
2864 . mflr %r11
2865 . mtlr %r12
2866 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2867 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2868 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2869 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2870 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2871 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2872 . mtctr %r12
2873 . bctr
2874
2875 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2876 . mflr %r12
2877 . bcl 20,31,1f
2878 . 1:
2879 . mflr %r11
2880 . mtlr %r12
2881 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
2882 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
2883 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
2884 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
2885 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
2886 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2887 . mtctr %r12
2888 . bctr
2889
2890 There are also ELFv1 powerxx variants of these stubs.
2891 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
2892 . pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2893 . b dest
2894 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
2895 . lis %r11,(dest-1f)@highesta34
2896 . ori %r11,%r11,(dest-1f)@highera34
2897 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2898 . 1: pla %r12,dest@pcrel
2899 . add %r12,%r11,%r12
2900 . mtctr %r12
2901 . bctr
2902 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
2903 . lis %r11,(xxx-1f)@highesta34
2904 . ori %r11,%r11,(xxx-1f)@highera34
2905 . sldi %r11,%r11,34
2906 . 1: pla %r12,xxx@pcrel
2907 . ldx %r12,%r11,%r12
2908 . mtctr %r12
2909 . bctr
2910
2911 In cases where the high instructions would add zero, they are
2912 omitted and following instructions modified in some cases.
2913 For example, a powerxx ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc might simplify down
2914 to
2915 . pld %r12,xxx@pcrel
2916 . mtctr %r12
2917 . bctr
2918
2919 For a given stub group (a set of sections all using the same toc
2920 pointer value) there will be just one stub type used for any
2921 particular function symbol. For example, if printf is called from
2922 code with the tocsave optimization (ie. r2 saved in function
2923 prologue) and therefore calls use a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub,
2924 and from other code without the tocsave optimization requiring a
2925 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save linkage stub, a single stub of the latter
2926 type will be created. Calls with the tocsave optimization will
2927 enter this stub after the instruction saving r2. A similar
2928 situation exists when calls are marked with R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
2929 relocations. These require a ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub
2930 to call an external function like printf. If other calls to printf
2931 require a ppc_stub_plt_call linkage stub then a single
2932 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc linkage stub will be used for both types of
2933 call. If other calls to printf require a ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
2934 linkage stub then a single ppc_stub_plt_call_both linkage stub will
2935 be created and calls not requiring r2 to be saved will enter the
2936 stub after the r2 save instruction. There is an analogous
2937 hierarchy of long branch and plt branch stubs for local call
2938 linkage. */
2939
2940 enum ppc_stub_type
2941 {
2942 ppc_stub_none,
2943 ppc_stub_long_branch,
2944 ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off,
2945 ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc,
2946 ppc_stub_long_branch_both, /* r2off and notoc variants both needed. */
2947 ppc_stub_plt_branch,
2948 ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off,
2949 ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc,
2950 ppc_stub_plt_branch_both,
2951 ppc_stub_plt_call,
2952 ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save,
2953 ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc,
2954 ppc_stub_plt_call_both,
2955 ppc_stub_global_entry,
2956 ppc_stub_save_res
2957 };
2958
2959 /* Information on stub grouping. */
2960 struct map_stub
2961 {
2962 /* The stub section. */
2963 asection *stub_sec;
2964 /* This is the section to which stubs in the group will be attached. */
2965 asection *link_sec;
2966 /* Next group. */
2967 struct map_stub *next;
2968 /* Whether to emit a copy of register save/restore functions in this
2969 group. */
2970 int needs_save_res;
2971 /* Current offset within stubs after the insn restoring lr in a
2972 _notoc or _both stub using bcl for pc-relative addressing, or
2973 after the insn restoring lr in a __tls_get_addr_opt plt stub. */
2974 unsigned int lr_restore;
2975 /* Accumulated size of EH info emitted to describe return address
2976 if stubs modify lr. Does not include 17 byte FDE header. */
2977 unsigned int eh_size;
2978 /* Offset in glink_eh_frame to the start of EH info for this group. */
2979 unsigned int eh_base;
2980 };
2981
2982 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry
2983 {
2984 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
2985 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
2986
2987 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
2988
2989 /* Group information. */
2990 struct map_stub *group;
2991
2992 /* Offset within stub_sec of the beginning of this stub. */
2993 bfd_vma stub_offset;
2994
2995 /* Given the symbol's value and its section we can determine its final
2996 value when building the stubs (so the stub knows where to jump. */
2997 bfd_vma target_value;
2998 asection *target_section;
2999
3000 /* The symbol table entry, if any, that this was derived from. */
3001 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
3002 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
3003
3004 /* Symbol type. */
3005 unsigned char symtype;
3006
3007 /* Symbol st_other. */
3008 unsigned char other;
3009 };
3010
3011 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry
3012 {
3013 /* Base hash table entry structure. */
3014 struct bfd_hash_entry root;
3015
3016 /* Offset within branch lookup table. */
3017 unsigned int offset;
3018
3019 /* Generation marker. */
3020 unsigned int iter;
3021 };
3022
3023 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
3024 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
3025 {
3026 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
3027
3028 /* The input section of the reloc. */
3029 asection *sec;
3030
3031 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
3032 unsigned int count : 31;
3033
3034 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
3035 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
3036 };
3037
3038 struct ppc_link_hash_entry
3039 {
3040 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
3041
3042 union
3043 {
3044 /* A pointer to the most recently used stub hash entry against this
3045 symbol. */
3046 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_cache;
3047
3048 /* A pointer to the next symbol starting with a '.' */
3049 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *next_dot_sym;
3050 } u;
3051
3052 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
3053 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
3054
3055 /* Link between function code and descriptor symbols. */
3056 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *oh;
3057
3058 /* Flag function code and descriptor symbols. */
3059 unsigned int is_func:1;
3060 unsigned int is_func_descriptor:1;
3061 unsigned int fake:1;
3062
3063 /* Whether global opd/toc sym has been adjusted or not.
3064 After ppc64_elf_edit_opd/ppc64_elf_edit_toc has run, this flag
3065 should be set for all globals defined in any opd/toc section. */
3066 unsigned int adjust_done:1;
3067
3068 /* Set if this is an out-of-line register save/restore function,
3069 with non-standard calling convention. */
3070 unsigned int save_res:1;
3071
3072 /* Set if a duplicate symbol with non-zero localentry is detected,
3073 even when the duplicate symbol does not provide a definition. */
3074 unsigned int non_zero_localentry:1;
3075
3076 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT (or TOC).
3077 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
3078 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
3079 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
3080 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
3081 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
3082 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
3083 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
3084 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
3085 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
3086 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
3087 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
3088 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
3089 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
3090 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
3091 #define TLS_EXPLICIT 256 /* TOC section TLS reloc, not stored. */
3092 unsigned char tls_mask;
3093
3094 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
3095 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
3096 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
3097 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
3098 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
3099 };
3100
3101 /* ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3102
3103 struct ppc_link_hash_table
3104 {
3105 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
3106
3107 /* The stub hash table. */
3108 struct bfd_hash_table stub_hash_table;
3109
3110 /* Another hash table for plt_branch stubs. */
3111 struct bfd_hash_table branch_hash_table;
3112
3113 /* Hash table for function prologue tocsave. */
3114 htab_t tocsave_htab;
3115
3116 /* Various options and other info passed from the linker. */
3117 struct ppc64_elf_params *params;
3118
3119 /* The size of sec_info below. */
3120 unsigned int sec_info_arr_size;
3121
3122 /* Per-section array of extra section info. Done this way rather
3123 than as part of ppc64_elf_section_data so we have the info for
3124 non-ppc64 sections. */
3125 struct
3126 {
3127 /* Along with elf_gp, specifies the TOC pointer used by this section. */
3128 bfd_vma toc_off;
3129
3130 union
3131 {
3132 /* The section group that this section belongs to. */
3133 struct map_stub *group;
3134 /* A temp section list pointer. */
3135 asection *list;
3136 } u;
3137 } *sec_info;
3138
3139 /* Linked list of groups. */
3140 struct map_stub *group;
3141
3142 /* Temp used when calculating TOC pointers. */
3143 bfd_vma toc_curr;
3144 bfd *toc_bfd;
3145 asection *toc_first_sec;
3146
3147 /* Used when adding symbols. */
3148 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *dot_syms;
3149
3150 /* Shortcuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
3151 asection *glink;
3152 asection *global_entry;
3153 asection *sfpr;
3154 asection *pltlocal;
3155 asection *relpltlocal;
3156 asection *brlt;
3157 asection *relbrlt;
3158 asection *glink_eh_frame;
3159
3160 /* Shortcut to .__tls_get_addr and __tls_get_addr. */
3161 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
3162 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr_fd;
3163
3164 /* The size of reliplt used by got entry relocs. */
3165 bfd_size_type got_reli_size;
3166
3167 /* Statistics. */
3168 unsigned long stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry];
3169
3170 /* Number of stubs against global syms. */
3171 unsigned long stub_globals;
3172
3173 /* Set if we're linking code with function descriptors. */
3174 unsigned int opd_abi:1;
3175
3176 /* Support for multiple toc sections. */
3177 unsigned int do_multi_toc:1;
3178 unsigned int multi_toc_needed:1;
3179 unsigned int second_toc_pass:1;
3180 unsigned int do_toc_opt:1;
3181
3182 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
3183 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
3184
3185 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
3186 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
3187
3188 /* Set on error. */
3189 unsigned int stub_error:1;
3190
3191 /* Whether func_desc_adjust needs to be run over symbols. */
3192 unsigned int need_func_desc_adj:1;
3193
3194 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
3195 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
3196 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
3197 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
3198
3199 /* Whether plt calls for ELFv2 localentry:0 funcs have been optimized. */
3200 unsigned int has_plt_localentry0:1;
3201
3202 /* Whether calls are made via the PLT from NOTOC functions. */
3203 unsigned int notoc_plt:1;
3204
3205 /* Whether to use powerxx instructions in linkage stubs. */
3206 unsigned int powerxx_stubs:1;
3207
3208 /* Incremented every time we size stubs. */
3209 unsigned int stub_iteration;
3210
3211 /* Small local sym cache. */
3212 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
3213 };
3214
3215 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
3216 are used here. */
3217
3218 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
3219 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
3220
3221 /* Nonzero if this section has an old-style call to __tls_get_addr. */
3222 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
3223
3224 /* Nonzero if this section has any toc or got relocs. */
3225 #define has_toc_reloc sec_flg2
3226
3227 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to another section that uses
3228 the toc or got. */
3229 #define makes_toc_func_call sec_flg3
3230
3231 /* Recursion protection when determining above flag. */
3232 #define call_check_in_progress sec_flg4
3233 #define call_check_done sec_flg5
3234
3235 /* Get the ppc64 ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
3236
3237 #define ppc_hash_table(p) \
3238 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
3239 == PPC64_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
3240
3241 #define ppc_stub_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3242 ((struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) \
3243 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3244
3245 #define ppc_branch_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy) \
3246 ((struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) \
3247 bfd_hash_lookup ((table), (string), (create), (copy)))
3248
3249 /* Create an entry in the stub hash table. */
3250
3251 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3252 stub_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3253 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3254 const char *string)
3255 {
3256 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3257 subclass. */
3258 if (entry == NULL)
3259 {
3260 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry));
3261 if (entry == NULL)
3262 return entry;
3263 }
3264
3265 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3266 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3267 if (entry != NULL)
3268 {
3269 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *eh;
3270
3271 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3272 eh = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) entry;
3273 eh->stub_type = ppc_stub_none;
3274 eh->group = NULL;
3275 eh->stub_offset = 0;
3276 eh->target_value = 0;
3277 eh->target_section = NULL;
3278 eh->h = NULL;
3279 eh->plt_ent = NULL;
3280 eh->other = 0;
3281 }
3282
3283 return entry;
3284 }
3285
3286 /* Create an entry in the branch hash table. */
3287
3288 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3289 branch_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3290 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3291 const char *string)
3292 {
3293 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3294 subclass. */
3295 if (entry == NULL)
3296 {
3297 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry));
3298 if (entry == NULL)
3299 return entry;
3300 }
3301
3302 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3303 entry = bfd_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3304 if (entry != NULL)
3305 {
3306 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *eh;
3307
3308 /* Initialize the local fields. */
3309 eh = (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *) entry;
3310 eh->offset = 0;
3311 eh->iter = 0;
3312 }
3313
3314 return entry;
3315 }
3316
3317 /* Create an entry in a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3318
3319 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
3320 link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
3321 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
3322 const char *string)
3323 {
3324 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
3325 subclass. */
3326 if (entry == NULL)
3327 {
3328 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry));
3329 if (entry == NULL)
3330 return entry;
3331 }
3332
3333 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
3334 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
3335 if (entry != NULL)
3336 {
3337 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) entry;
3338
3339 memset (&eh->u.stub_cache, 0,
3340 (sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry)
3341 - offsetof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry, u.stub_cache)));
3342
3343 /* When making function calls, old ABI code references function entry
3344 points (dot symbols), while new ABI code references the function
3345 descriptor symbol. We need to make any combination of reference and
3346 definition work together, without breaking archive linking.
3347
3348 For a defined function "foo" and an undefined call to "bar":
3349 An old object defines "foo" and ".foo", references ".bar" (possibly
3350 "bar" too).
3351 A new object defines "foo" and references "bar".
3352
3353 A new object thus has no problem with its undefined symbols being
3354 satisfied by definitions in an old object. On the other hand, the
3355 old object won't have ".bar" satisfied by a new object.
3356
3357 Keep a list of newly added dot-symbols. */
3358
3359 if (string[0] == '.')
3360 {
3361 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3362
3363 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) table;
3364 eh->u.next_dot_sym = htab->dot_syms;
3365 htab->dot_syms = eh;
3366 }
3367 }
3368
3369 return entry;
3370 }
3371
3372 struct tocsave_entry
3373 {
3374 asection *sec;
3375 bfd_vma offset;
3376 };
3377
3378 static hashval_t
3379 tocsave_htab_hash (const void *p)
3380 {
3381 const struct tocsave_entry *e = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p;
3382 return ((bfd_vma) (intptr_t) e->sec ^ e->offset) >> 3;
3383 }
3384
3385 static int
3386 tocsave_htab_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3387 {
3388 const struct tocsave_entry *e1 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p1;
3389 const struct tocsave_entry *e2 = (const struct tocsave_entry *) p2;
3390 return e1->sec == e2->sec && e1->offset == e2->offset;
3391 }
3392
3393 /* Destroy a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3394
3395 static void
3396 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (bfd *obfd)
3397 {
3398 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3399
3400 htab = (struct ppc_link_hash_table *) obfd->link.hash;
3401 if (htab->tocsave_htab)
3402 htab_delete (htab->tocsave_htab);
3403 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->branch_hash_table);
3404 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3405 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (obfd);
3406 }
3407
3408 /* Create a ppc64 ELF linker hash table. */
3409
3410 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
3411 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
3412 {
3413 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3414 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_table);
3415
3416 htab = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
3417 if (htab == NULL)
3418 return NULL;
3419
3420 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&htab->elf, abfd, link_hash_newfunc,
3421 sizeof (struct ppc_link_hash_entry),
3422 PPC64_ELF_DATA))
3423 {
3424 free (htab);
3425 return NULL;
3426 }
3427
3428 /* Init the stub hash table too. */
3429 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_hash_newfunc,
3430 sizeof (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry)))
3431 {
3432 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3433 return NULL;
3434 }
3435
3436 /* And the branch hash table. */
3437 if (!bfd_hash_table_init (&htab->branch_hash_table, branch_hash_newfunc,
3438 sizeof (struct ppc_branch_hash_entry)))
3439 {
3440 bfd_hash_table_free (&htab->stub_hash_table);
3441 _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3442 return NULL;
3443 }
3444
3445 htab->tocsave_htab = htab_try_create (1024,
3446 tocsave_htab_hash,
3447 tocsave_htab_eq,
3448 NULL);
3449 if (htab->tocsave_htab == NULL)
3450 {
3451 ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free (abfd);
3452 return NULL;
3453 }
3454 htab->elf.root.hash_table_free = ppc64_elf_link_hash_table_free;
3455
3456 /* Initializing two fields of the union is just cosmetic. We really
3457 only care about glist, but when compiled on a 32-bit host the
3458 bfd_vma fields are larger. Setting the bfd_vma to zero makes
3459 debugger inspection of these fields look nicer. */
3460 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.refcount = 0;
3461 htab->elf.init_got_refcount.glist = NULL;
3462 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
3463 htab->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
3464 htab->elf.init_got_offset.offset = 0;
3465 htab->elf.init_got_offset.glist = NULL;
3466 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
3467 htab->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
3468
3469 return &htab->elf.root;
3470 }
3471
3472 /* Create sections for linker generated code. */
3473
3474 static bfd_boolean
3475 create_linkage_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3476 {
3477 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3478 flagword flags;
3479
3480 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3481
3482 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY
3483 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3484 if (htab->params->save_restore_funcs)
3485 {
3486 /* Create .sfpr for code to save and restore fp regs. */
3487 htab->sfpr = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".sfpr",
3488 flags);
3489 if (htab->sfpr == NULL
3490 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->sfpr, 2))
3491 return FALSE;
3492 }
3493
3494 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
3495 return TRUE;
3496
3497 /* Create .glink for lazy dynamic linking support. */
3498 htab->glink = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3499 flags);
3500 if (htab->glink == NULL
3501 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 3))
3502 return FALSE;
3503
3504 /* The part of .glink used by global entry stubs, separate so that
3505 it can be aligned appropriately without affecting htab->glink. */
3506 htab->global_entry = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".glink",
3507 flags);
3508 if (htab->global_entry == NULL
3509 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->global_entry, 2))
3510 return FALSE;
3511
3512 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
3513 {
3514 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3515 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3516 htab->glink_eh_frame = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj,
3517 ".eh_frame",
3518 flags);
3519 if (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
3520 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink_eh_frame, 2))
3521 return FALSE;
3522 }
3523
3524 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
3525 htab->elf.iplt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".iplt", flags);
3526 if (htab->elf.iplt == NULL
3527 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.iplt, 3))
3528 return FALSE;
3529
3530 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3531 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3532 htab->elf.irelplt
3533 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.iplt", flags);
3534 if (htab->elf.irelplt == NULL
3535 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.irelplt, 3))
3536 return FALSE;
3537
3538 /* Create branch lookup table for plt_branch stubs. */
3539 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
3540 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3541 htab->brlt = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3542 flags);
3543 if (htab->brlt == NULL
3544 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->brlt, 3))
3545 return FALSE;
3546
3547 /* Local plt entries, put in .branch_lt but a separate section for
3548 convenience. */
3549 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".branch_lt",
3550 flags);
3551 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
3552 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 3))
3553 return FALSE;
3554
3555 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
3556 return TRUE;
3557
3558 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
3559 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3560 htab->relbrlt
3561 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3562 if (htab->relbrlt == NULL
3563 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relbrlt, 3))
3564 return FALSE;
3565
3566 htab->relpltlocal
3567 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
3568 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
3569 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 3))
3570 return FALSE;
3571
3572 return TRUE;
3573 }
3574
3575 /* Satisfy the ELF linker by filling in some fields in our fake bfd. */
3576
3577 bfd_boolean
3578 ppc64_elf_init_stub_bfd (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3579 struct ppc64_elf_params *params)
3580 {
3581 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
3582
3583 elf_elfheader (params->stub_bfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = ELFCLASS64;
3584
3585 /* Always hook our dynamic sections into the first bfd, which is the
3586 linker created stub bfd. This ensures that the GOT header is at
3587 the start of the output TOC section. */
3588 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3589 htab->elf.dynobj = params->stub_bfd;
3590 htab->params = params;
3591
3592 return create_linkage_sections (htab->elf.dynobj, info);
3593 }
3594
3595 /* Build a name for an entry in the stub hash table. */
3596
3597 static char *
3598 ppc_stub_name (const asection *input_section,
3599 const asection *sym_sec,
3600 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3601 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
3602 {
3603 char *stub_name;
3604 ssize_t len;
3605
3606 /* rel->r_addend is actually 64 bit, but who uses more than +/- 2^31
3607 offsets from a sym as a branch target? In fact, we could
3608 probably assume the addend is always zero. */
3609 BFD_ASSERT (((int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff) == rel->r_addend);
3610
3611 if (h)
3612 {
3613 len = 8 + 1 + strlen (h->elf.root.root.string) + 1 + 8 + 1;
3614 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3615 if (stub_name == NULL)
3616 return stub_name;
3617
3618 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%s+%x",
3619 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3620 h->elf.root.root.string,
3621 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3622 }
3623 else
3624 {
3625 len = 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1 + 8 + 1;
3626 stub_name = bfd_malloc (len);
3627 if (stub_name == NULL)
3628 return stub_name;
3629
3630 len = sprintf (stub_name, "%08x.%x:%x+%x",
3631 input_section->id & 0xffffffff,
3632 sym_sec->id & 0xffffffff,
3633 (int) ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info) & 0xffffffff,
3634 (int) rel->r_addend & 0xffffffff);
3635 }
3636 if (len > 2 && stub_name[len - 2] == '+' && stub_name[len - 1] == '0')
3637 stub_name[len - 2] = 0;
3638 return stub_name;
3639 }
3640
3641 /* Look up an entry in the stub hash. Stub entries are cached because
3642 creating the stub name takes a bit of time. */
3643
3644 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3645 ppc_get_stub_entry (const asection *input_section,
3646 const asection *sym_sec,
3647 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h,
3648 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
3649 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3650 {
3651 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3652 struct map_stub *group;
3653
3654 /* If this input section is part of a group of sections sharing one
3655 stub section, then use the id of the first section in the group.
3656 Stub names need to include a section id, as there may well be
3657 more than one stub used to reach say, printf, and we need to
3658 distinguish between them. */
3659 group = htab->sec_info[input_section->id].u.group;
3660 if (group == NULL)
3661 return NULL;
3662
3663 if (h != NULL && h->u.stub_cache != NULL
3664 && h->u.stub_cache->h == h
3665 && h->u.stub_cache->group == group)
3666 {
3667 stub_entry = h->u.stub_cache;
3668 }
3669 else
3670 {
3671 char *stub_name;
3672
3673 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (group->link_sec, sym_sec, h, rel);
3674 if (stub_name == NULL)
3675 return NULL;
3676
3677 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
3678 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
3679 if (h != NULL)
3680 h->u.stub_cache = stub_entry;
3681
3682 free (stub_name);
3683 }
3684
3685 return stub_entry;
3686 }
3687
3688 /* Add a new stub entry to the stub hash. Not all fields of the new
3689 stub entry are initialised. */
3690
3691 static struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *
3692 ppc_add_stub (const char *stub_name,
3693 asection *section,
3694 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3695 {
3696 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3697 struct map_stub *group;
3698 asection *link_sec;
3699 asection *stub_sec;
3700 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
3701
3702 group = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group;
3703 link_sec = group->link_sec;
3704 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
3705 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3706 {
3707 size_t namelen;
3708 bfd_size_type len;
3709 char *s_name;
3710
3711 namelen = strlen (link_sec->name);
3712 len = namelen + sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX);
3713 s_name = bfd_alloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, len);
3714 if (s_name == NULL)
3715 return NULL;
3716
3717 memcpy (s_name, link_sec->name, namelen);
3718 memcpy (s_name + namelen, STUB_SUFFIX, sizeof (STUB_SUFFIX));
3719 stub_sec = (*htab->params->add_stub_section) (s_name, link_sec);
3720 if (stub_sec == NULL)
3721 return NULL;
3722 group->stub_sec = stub_sec;
3723 }
3724
3725 /* Enter this entry into the linker stub hash table. */
3726 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table, stub_name,
3727 TRUE, FALSE);
3728 if (stub_entry == NULL)
3729 {
3730 /* xgettext:c-format */
3731 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: cannot create stub entry %s"),
3732 section->owner, stub_name);
3733 return NULL;
3734 }
3735
3736 stub_entry->group = group;
3737 stub_entry->stub_offset = 0;
3738 return stub_entry;
3739 }
3740
3741 /* Create .got and .rela.got sections in ABFD, and .got in dynobj if
3742 not already done. */
3743
3744 static bfd_boolean
3745 create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3746 {
3747 asection *got, *relgot;
3748 flagword flags;
3749 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
3750
3751 if (!is_ppc64_elf (abfd))
3752 return FALSE;
3753 if (htab == NULL)
3754 return FALSE;
3755
3756 if (!htab->elf.sgot
3757 && !_bfd_elf_create_got_section (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3758 return FALSE;
3759
3760 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3761 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3762
3763 got = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3764 if (!got
3765 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (got, 3))
3766 return FALSE;
3767
3768 relgot = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.got",
3769 flags | SEC_READONLY);
3770 if (!relgot
3771 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (relgot, 3))
3772 return FALSE;
3773
3774 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got = got;
3775 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->relgot = relgot;
3776 return TRUE;
3777 }
3778
3779 /* Follow indirect and warning symbol links. */
3780
3781 static inline struct bfd_link_hash_entry *
3782 follow_link (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h)
3783 {
3784 while (h->type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3785 || h->type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3786 h = h->u.i.link;
3787 return h;
3788 }
3789
3790 static inline struct elf_link_hash_entry *
3791 elf_follow_link (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3792 {
3793 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->root);
3794 }
3795
3796 static inline struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3797 ppc_follow_link (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h)
3798 {
3799 return (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) follow_link (&h->elf.root);
3800 }
3801
3802 /* Merge PLT info on FROM with that on TO. */
3803
3804 static void
3805 move_plt_plist (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *from,
3806 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *to)
3807 {
3808 if (from->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3809 {
3810 if (to->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
3811 {
3812 struct plt_entry **entp;
3813 struct plt_entry *ent;
3814
3815 for (entp = &from->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3816 {
3817 struct plt_entry *dent;
3818
3819 for (dent = to->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3820 if (dent->addend == ent->addend)
3821 {
3822 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
3823 *entp = ent->next;
3824 break;
3825 }
3826 if (dent == NULL)
3827 entp = &ent->next;
3828 }
3829 *entp = to->elf.plt.plist;
3830 }
3831
3832 to->elf.plt.plist = from->elf.plt.plist;
3833 from->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
3834 }
3835 }
3836
3837 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
3838
3839 static void
3840 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3841 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
3842 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
3843 {
3844 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
3845
3846 edir = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) dir;
3847 eind = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) ind;
3848
3849 edir->is_func |= eind->is_func;
3850 edir->is_func_descriptor |= eind->is_func_descriptor;
3851 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
3852 if (eind->oh != NULL)
3853 edir->oh = ppc_follow_link (eind->oh);
3854
3855 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
3856 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
3857 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
3858 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
3859 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
3860 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
3861 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
3862
3863 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, don't copy
3864 dyn_relocs, plt/got info, or dynindx. We used to copy dyn_relocs
3865 in order to simplify readonly_dynrelocs and save a field in the
3866 symbol hash entry, but that means dyn_relocs can't be used in any
3867 tests about a specific symbol, or affect other symbol flags which
3868 are then tested. */
3869 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3870 return;
3871
3872 /* Copy over any dynamic relocs we may have on the indirect sym. */
3873 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3874 {
3875 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
3876 {
3877 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
3878 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3879
3880 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
3881 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
3882 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
3883 {
3884 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
3885
3886 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
3887 if (q->sec == p->sec)
3888 {
3889 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
3890 q->count += p->count;
3891 *pp = p->next;
3892 break;
3893 }
3894 if (q == NULL)
3895 pp = &p->next;
3896 }
3897 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
3898 }
3899
3900 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
3901 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
3902 }
3903
3904 /* Copy over got entries that we may have already seen to the
3905 symbol which just became indirect. */
3906 if (eind->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3907 {
3908 if (edir->elf.got.glist != NULL)
3909 {
3910 struct got_entry **entp;
3911 struct got_entry *ent;
3912
3913 for (entp = &eind->elf.got.glist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
3914 {
3915 struct got_entry *dent;
3916
3917 for (dent = edir->elf.got.glist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
3918 if (dent->addend == ent->addend
3919 && dent->owner == ent->owner
3920 && dent->tls_type == ent->tls_type)
3921 {
3922 dent->got.refcount += ent->got.refcount;
3923 *entp = ent->next;
3924 break;
3925 }
3926 if (dent == NULL)
3927 entp = &ent->next;
3928 }
3929 *entp = edir->elf.got.glist;
3930 }
3931
3932 edir->elf.got.glist = eind->elf.got.glist;
3933 eind->elf.got.glist = NULL;
3934 }
3935
3936 /* And plt entries. */
3937 move_plt_plist (eind, edir);
3938
3939 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
3940 {
3941 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
3942 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
3943 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
3944 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
3945 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
3946 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
3947 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
3948 }
3949 }
3950
3951 /* Find the function descriptor hash entry from the given function code
3952 hash entry FH. Link the entries via their OH fields. */
3953
3954 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3955 lookup_fdh (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh, struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab)
3956 {
3957 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = fh->oh;
3958
3959 if (fdh == NULL)
3960 {
3961 const char *fd_name = fh->elf.root.root.string + 1;
3962
3963 fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
3964 elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, fd_name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
3965 if (fdh == NULL)
3966 return fdh;
3967
3968 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
3969 fdh->oh = fh;
3970 fh->is_func = 1;
3971 fh->oh = fdh;
3972 }
3973
3974 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
3975 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
3976 fdh->oh = fh;
3977 return fdh;
3978 }
3979
3980 /* Make a fake function descriptor sym for the undefined code sym FH. */
3981
3982 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
3983 make_fdh (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3984 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
3985 {
3986 bfd *abfd = fh->elf.root.u.undef.abfd;
3987 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
3988 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
3989 flagword flags = (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
3990 ? BSF_WEAK
3991 : BSF_GLOBAL);
3992
3993 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, abfd,
3994 fh->elf.root.root.string + 1,
3995 flags, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
3996 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh))
3997 return NULL;
3998
3999 fdh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4000 fdh->elf.non_elf = 0;
4001 fdh->fake = 1;
4002 fdh->is_func_descriptor = 1;
4003 fdh->oh = fh;
4004 fh->is_func = 1;
4005 fh->oh = fdh;
4006 return fdh;
4007 }
4008
4009 /* Fix function descriptor symbols defined in .opd sections to be
4010 function type. */
4011
4012 static bfd_boolean
4013 ppc64_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *ibfd,
4014 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4015 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4016 const char **name,
4017 flagword *flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4018 asection **sec,
4019 bfd_vma *value)
4020 {
4021 if (*sec != NULL
4022 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".opd") == 0)
4023 {
4024 asection *code_sec;
4025
4026 if (!(ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4027 || ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC))
4028 isym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (ELF_ST_BIND (isym->st_info), STT_FUNC);
4029
4030 /* If the symbol is a function defined in .opd, and the function
4031 code is in a discarded group, let it appear to be undefined. */
4032 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4033 && (*sec)->reloc_count != 0
4034 && opd_entry_value (*sec, *value, &code_sec, NULL,
4035 FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1
4036 && discarded_section (code_sec))
4037 {
4038 *sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4039 isym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
4040 }
4041 }
4042 else if (*sec != NULL
4043 && strcmp ((*sec)->name, ".toc") == 0
4044 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_OBJECT)
4045 {
4046 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4047 if (htab != NULL)
4048 htab->params->object_in_toc = 1;
4049 }
4050
4051 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4052 {
4053 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4054 set_abiversion (ibfd, 2);
4055 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 1)
4056 {
4057 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol '%s' has invalid st_other"
4058 " for ABI version 1"), *name);
4059 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4060 return FALSE;
4061 }
4062 }
4063
4064 return TRUE;
4065 }
4066
4067 /* Merge non-visibility st_other attributes: local entry point. */
4068
4069 static void
4070 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4071 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4072 bfd_boolean definition,
4073 bfd_boolean dynamic)
4074 {
4075 if (definition && (!dynamic || !h->def_regular))
4076 h->other = ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1))
4077 | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other));
4078 }
4079
4080 /* Hook called on merging a symbol. We use this to clear "fake" since
4081 we now have a real symbol. */
4082
4083 static bfd_boolean
4084 ppc64_elf_merge_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4085 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
4086 asection **psec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4087 bfd_boolean newdef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4088 bfd_boolean olddef ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4089 bfd *oldbfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4090 const asection *oldsec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4091 {
4092 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->fake = 0;
4093 if ((STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & isym->st_other) != 0)
4094 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->non_zero_localentry = 1;
4095 return TRUE;
4096 }
4097
4098 /* This function makes an old ABI object reference to ".bar" cause the
4099 inclusion of a new ABI object archive that defines "bar".
4100 NAME is a symbol defined in an archive. Return a symbol in the hash
4101 table that might be satisfied by the archive symbols. */
4102
4103 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
4104 ppc64_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (bfd *abfd,
4105 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4106 const char *name)
4107 {
4108 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4109 char *dot_name;
4110 size_t len;
4111
4112 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, name);
4113 if (h != NULL
4114 /* Don't return this sym if it is a fake function descriptor
4115 created by add_symbol_adjust. */
4116 && !((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->fake)
4117 return h;
4118
4119 if (name[0] == '.')
4120 return h;
4121
4122 len = strlen (name);
4123 dot_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
4124 if (dot_name == NULL)
4125 return (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) -1;
4126 dot_name[0] = '.';
4127 memcpy (dot_name + 1, name, len + 1);
4128 h = _bfd_elf_archive_symbol_lookup (abfd, info, dot_name);
4129 bfd_release (abfd, dot_name);
4130 return h;
4131 }
4132
4133 /* This function satisfies all old ABI object references to ".bar" if a
4134 new ABI object defines "bar". Well, at least, undefined dot symbols
4135 are made weak. This stops later archive searches from including an
4136 object if we already have a function descriptor definition. It also
4137 prevents the linker complaining about undefined symbols.
4138 We also check and correct mismatched symbol visibility here. The
4139 most restrictive visibility of the function descriptor and the
4140 function entry symbol is used. */
4141
4142 static bfd_boolean
4143 add_symbol_adjust (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4144 {
4145 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4146 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
4147
4148 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4149 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.root.u.i.link;
4150
4151 if (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
4152 return TRUE;
4153
4154 if (eh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.')
4155 abort ();
4156
4157 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4158 if (htab == NULL)
4159 return FALSE;
4160
4161 fdh = lookup_fdh (eh, htab);
4162 if (fdh == NULL
4163 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
4164 && (eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
4165 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4166 && eh->elf.ref_regular)
4167 {
4168 /* Make an undefined function descriptor sym, in order to
4169 pull in an --as-needed shared lib. Archives are handled
4170 elsewhere. */
4171 fdh = make_fdh (info, eh);
4172 if (fdh == NULL)
4173 return FALSE;
4174 }
4175
4176 if (fdh != NULL)
4177 {
4178 unsigned entry_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) - 1;
4179 unsigned descr_vis = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (fdh->elf.other) - 1;
4180
4181 /* Make both descriptor and entry symbol have the most
4182 constraining visibility of either symbol. */
4183 if (entry_vis < descr_vis)
4184 fdh->elf.other += entry_vis - descr_vis;
4185 else if (entry_vis > descr_vis)
4186 eh->elf.other += descr_vis - entry_vis;
4187
4188 /* Propagate reference flags from entry symbol to function
4189 descriptor symbol. */
4190 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_regular;
4191 fdh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic |= eh->elf.root.non_ir_ref_dynamic;
4192 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= eh->elf.ref_regular;
4193 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
4194
4195 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
4196 && fdh->elf.dynindx == -1
4197 && fdh->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden
4198 && (bfd_link_dll (info)
4199 || fdh->elf.def_dynamic
4200 || fdh->elf.ref_dynamic)
4201 && (eh->elf.ref_regular
4202 || eh->elf.def_regular))
4203 {
4204 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
4205 return FALSE;
4206 }
4207 }
4208
4209 return TRUE;
4210 }
4211
4212 /* Set up opd section info and abiversion for IBFD, and process list
4213 of dot-symbols we made in link_hash_newfunc. */
4214
4215 static bfd_boolean
4216 ppc64_elf_before_check_relocs (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4217 {
4218 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4219 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **p, *eh;
4220 asection *opd = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
4221
4222 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0)
4223 {
4224 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type == sec_normal);
4225 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->sec_type = sec_opd;
4226
4227 if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4228 set_abiversion (ibfd, 1);
4229 else if (abiversion (ibfd) >= 2)
4230 {
4231 /* xgettext:c-format */
4232 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB .opd not allowed in ABI version %d"),
4233 ibfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4234 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4235 return FALSE;
4236 }
4237 }
4238
4239 if (is_ppc64_elf (info->output_bfd))
4240 {
4241 /* For input files without an explicit abiversion in e_flags
4242 we should have flagged any with symbol st_other bits set
4243 as ELFv1 and above flagged those with .opd as ELFv2.
4244 Set the output abiversion if not yet set, and for any input
4245 still ambiguous, take its abiversion from the output.
4246 Differences in ABI are reported later. */
4247 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 0)
4248 set_abiversion (info->output_bfd, abiversion (ibfd));
4249 else if (abiversion (ibfd) == 0)
4250 set_abiversion (ibfd, abiversion (info->output_bfd));
4251 }
4252
4253 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4254 if (htab == NULL)
4255 return TRUE;
4256
4257 if (opd != NULL && opd->size != 0
4258 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) == 0
4259 && (opd->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0
4260 && opd->reloc_count != 0
4261 && !bfd_is_abs_section (opd->output_section)
4262 && info->gc_sections)
4263 {
4264 /* Garbage collection needs some extra help with .opd sections.
4265 We don't want to necessarily keep everything referenced by
4266 relocs in .opd, as that would keep all functions. Instead,
4267 if we reference an .opd symbol (a function descriptor), we
4268 want to keep the function code symbol's section. This is
4269 easy for global symbols, but for local syms we need to keep
4270 information about the associated function section. */
4271 bfd_size_type amt;
4272 asection **opd_sym_map;
4273 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4274 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, *rel_end, *rel;
4275
4276 amt = OPD_NDX (opd->size) * sizeof (*opd_sym_map);
4277 opd_sym_map = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, amt);
4278 if (opd_sym_map == NULL)
4279 return FALSE;
4280 ppc64_elf_section_data (opd)->u.opd.func_sec = opd_sym_map;
4281 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, opd, NULL, NULL,
4282 info->keep_memory);
4283 if (relocs == NULL)
4284 return FALSE;
4285 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4286 rel_end = relocs + opd->reloc_count - 1;
4287 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4288 {
4289 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4290 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4291
4292 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
4293 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC
4294 && r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4295 {
4296 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4297 asection *s;
4298
4299 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ibfd, r_symndx);
4300 if (isym == NULL)
4301 {
4302 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4303 free (relocs);
4304 return FALSE;
4305 }
4306
4307 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, isym->st_shndx);
4308 if (s != NULL && s != opd)
4309 opd_sym_map[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = s;
4310 }
4311 }
4312 if (elf_section_data (opd)->relocs != relocs)
4313 free (relocs);
4314 }
4315
4316 p = &htab->dot_syms;
4317 while ((eh = *p) != NULL)
4318 {
4319 *p = NULL;
4320 if (&eh->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
4321 ;
4322 else if (htab->elf.hgot == NULL
4323 && strcmp (eh->elf.root.root.string, ".TOC.") == 0)
4324 htab->elf.hgot = &eh->elf;
4325 else if (abiversion (ibfd) <= 1)
4326 {
4327 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 1;
4328 if (!add_symbol_adjust (eh, info))
4329 return FALSE;
4330 }
4331 p = &eh->u.next_dot_sym;
4332 }
4333 return TRUE;
4334 }
4335
4336 /* Undo hash table changes when an --as-needed input file is determined
4337 not to be needed. */
4338
4339 static bfd_boolean
4340 ppc64_elf_notice_as_needed (bfd *ibfd,
4341 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4342 enum notice_asneeded_action act)
4343 {
4344 if (act == notice_not_needed)
4345 {
4346 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4347
4348 if (htab == NULL)
4349 return FALSE;
4350
4351 htab->dot_syms = NULL;
4352 }
4353 return _bfd_elf_notice_as_needed (ibfd, info, act);
4354 }
4355
4356 /* If --just-symbols against a final linked binary, then assume we need
4357 toc adjusting stubs when calling functions defined there. */
4358
4359 static void
4360 ppc64_elf_link_just_syms (asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4361 {
4362 if ((sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
4363 && (sec->owner->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0
4364 && is_ppc64_elf (sec->owner))
4365 {
4366 if (abiversion (sec->owner) >= 2
4367 || bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".opd") != NULL)
4368 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4369 }
4370 _bfd_elf_link_just_syms (sec, info);
4371 }
4372
4373 static struct plt_entry **
4374 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
4375 unsigned long r_symndx, bfd_vma r_addend, int tls_type)
4376 {
4377 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (abfd);
4378 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4379 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
4380
4381 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4382 {
4383 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4384
4385 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_ents)
4386 + sizeof (*local_plt)
4387 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
4388 local_got_ents = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
4389 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
4390 return NULL;
4391 elf_local_got_ents (abfd) = local_got_ents;
4392 }
4393
4394 if ((tls_type & (NON_GOT | TLS_EXPLICIT)) == 0)
4395 {
4396 struct got_entry *ent;
4397
4398 for (ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4399 if (ent->addend == r_addend
4400 && ent->owner == abfd
4401 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4402 break;
4403 if (ent == NULL)
4404 {
4405 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4406 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4407 if (ent == NULL)
4408 return FALSE;
4409 ent->next = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
4410 ent->addend = r_addend;
4411 ent->owner = abfd;
4412 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4413 ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4414 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4415 local_got_ents[r_symndx] = ent;
4416 }
4417 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4418 }
4419
4420 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4421 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4422 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
4423
4424 return local_plt + r_symndx;
4425 }
4426
4427 static bfd_boolean
4428 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist, bfd_vma addend)
4429 {
4430 struct plt_entry *ent;
4431
4432 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4433 if (ent->addend == addend)
4434 break;
4435 if (ent == NULL)
4436 {
4437 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4438 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4439 if (ent == NULL)
4440 return FALSE;
4441 ent->next = *plist;
4442 ent->addend = addend;
4443 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
4444 *plist = ent;
4445 }
4446 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
4447 return TRUE;
4448 }
4449
4450 static bfd_boolean
4451 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4452 {
4453 return (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
4454 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
4455 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
4456 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
4457 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
4458 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR24
4459 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14
4460 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
4461 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
4462 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
4463 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC);
4464 }
4465
4466 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
4467
4468 static bfd_boolean
4469 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
4470 {
4471 return (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
4472 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
4473 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
4474 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS
4475 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
4476 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC
4477 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ
4478 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC);
4479 }
4480
4481 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
4482 calculate needed space in the global offset table, procedure
4483 linkage table, and dynamic reloc sections. */
4484
4485 static bfd_boolean
4486 ppc64_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4487 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
4488 {
4489 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
4490 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4491 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4492 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
4493 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
4494 asection *sreloc;
4495 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga, *dottga;
4496 bfd_boolean is_opd;
4497
4498 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
4499 return TRUE;
4500
4501 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
4502 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
4503 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
4504 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
4505 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
4506 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
4507 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
4508 return TRUE;
4509
4510 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (abfd));
4511
4512 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
4513 if (htab == NULL)
4514 return FALSE;
4515
4516 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4517 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4518 dottga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
4519 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4520 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4521 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
4522 sreloc = NULL;
4523 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type == sec_opd;
4524 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
4525 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
4526 {
4527 unsigned long r_symndx;
4528 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4529 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
4530 int tls_type;
4531 struct _ppc64_elf_section_data *ppc64_sec;
4532 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
4533
4534 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4535 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4536 h = NULL;
4537 else
4538 {
4539 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4540 h = elf_follow_link (h);
4541
4542 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
4543 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4544 }
4545
4546 tls_type = 0;
4547 ifunc = NULL;
4548 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4549 switch (r_type)
4550 {
4551 case R_PPC64_D34:
4552 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
4553 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
4554 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
4555 case R_PPC64_D28:
4556 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
4557 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
4558 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
4559 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4560 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
4561 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
4562 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
4563 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
4564 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4565 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4566 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
4567 htab->powerxx_stubs = 1;
4568 break;
4569 default:
4570 break;
4571 }
4572
4573 switch (r_type)
4574 {
4575 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4576 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4577 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4578 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4579 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4580 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4581 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4582 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4583 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4584 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4585 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4586 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4587 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4588 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4589 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4590 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4591 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4592 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4593 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_optrel = 1;
4594 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel = 1;
4595 break;
4596 default:
4597 break;
4598 }
4599
4600 if (h != NULL)
4601 {
4602 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4603 {
4604 h->needs_plt = 1;
4605 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
4606 }
4607 }
4608 else
4609 {
4610 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4611 abfd, r_symndx);
4612 if (isym == NULL)
4613 return FALSE;
4614
4615 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4616 {
4617 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4618 rel->r_addend,
4619 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
4620 if (ifunc == NULL)
4621 return FALSE;
4622 }
4623 }
4624
4625 switch (r_type)
4626 {
4627 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
4628 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
4629 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
4630 its parameter symbol. */
4631 if (h != NULL)
4632 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
4633 else
4634 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4635 rel->r_addend,
4636 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4637 return FALSE;
4638 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4639 break;
4640
4641 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
4642 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4643 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4644 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4645 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
4646 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4647 goto dogottls;
4648
4649 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
4650 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4651 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4652 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4653 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
4654 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4655 goto dogottls;
4656
4657 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
4658 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
4659 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4660 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4661 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
4662 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4663 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4664 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4665 goto dogottls;
4666
4667 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
4668 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4669 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
4670 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
4671 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
4672 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4673 dogottls:
4674 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4675 goto dogot;
4676
4677 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
4678 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
4679 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
4680 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
4681 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
4682 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
4683 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
4684 dogot:
4685 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
4686 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4687 if (r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16
4688 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16
4689 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS
4690 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS
4691 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16
4692 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT16_DS)
4693 {
4694 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4695 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4696 }
4697
4698 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->got == NULL
4699 && !create_got_section (abfd, info))
4700 return FALSE;
4701
4702 if (h != NULL)
4703 {
4704 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4705 struct got_entry *ent;
4706
4707 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
4708 for (ent = eh->elf.got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4709 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
4710 && ent->owner == abfd
4711 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
4712 break;
4713 if (ent == NULL)
4714 {
4715 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
4716 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4717 if (ent == NULL)
4718 return FALSE;
4719 ent->next = eh->elf.got.glist;
4720 ent->addend = rel->r_addend;
4721 ent->owner = abfd;
4722 ent->tls_type = tls_type;
4723 ent->is_indirect = FALSE;
4724 ent->got.refcount = 0;
4725 eh->elf.got.glist = ent;
4726 }
4727 ent->got.refcount += 1;
4728 eh->tls_mask |= tls_type;
4729 }
4730 else
4731 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
4732 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4733 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4734 return FALSE;
4735
4736 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
4737 an ifunc. */
4738 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1)
4739 {
4740 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, rel->r_addend))
4741 return FALSE;
4742 }
4743 break;
4744
4745 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
4746 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
4747 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
4748 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
4749 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
4750 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
4751 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
4752 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
4753 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
4754 plt_list = ifunc;
4755 if (h != NULL)
4756 {
4757 h->needs_plt = 1;
4758 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4759 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4760 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_func = 1;
4761 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
4762 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4763 }
4764 if (plt_list == NULL)
4765 plt_list = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4766 rel->r_addend,
4767 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
4768 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4769 return FALSE;
4770 break;
4771
4772 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
4773 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
4774 section relative. */
4775 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
4776 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
4777 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
4778 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
4779 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
4780 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
4781 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
4782 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
4783 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
4784 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
4785 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
4786 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
4787 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
4788 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
4789 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
4790 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
4791 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
4792 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
4793 break;
4794
4795 /* Nor do these. */
4796 case R_PPC64_REL16:
4797 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
4798 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
4799 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
4800 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
4801 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
4802 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
4803 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
4804 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
4805 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
4806 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
4807 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
4808 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
4809 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
4810 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
4811 break;
4812
4813 /* Not supported as a dynamic relocation. */
4814 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
4815 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4816 {
4817 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
4818 ppc_howto_init ();
4819 /* xgettext:c-format */
4820 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%H: %s reloc unsupported "
4821 "in shared libraries and PIEs\n"),
4822 abfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
4823 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
4824 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4825 return FALSE;
4826 }
4827 break;
4828
4829 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
4830 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
4831 htab->do_multi_toc = 1;
4832 ppc64_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_small_toc_reloc = 1;
4833 /* Fall through. */
4834 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
4835 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
4836 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
4837 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
4838 sec->has_toc_reloc = 1;
4839 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
4840 {
4841 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
4842 h->non_got_ref = 1;
4843 /* Strongly prefer a copy reloc over a dynamic reloc.
4844 glibc ld.so as of 2019-08 will error out if one of
4845 these relocations is emitted. */
4846 h->needs_copy = 1;
4847 goto dodyn;
4848 }
4849 break;
4850
4851 /* Marker reloc. */
4852 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
4853 break;
4854
4855 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
4856 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
4857 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4858 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
4859 return FALSE;
4860 break;
4861
4862 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
4863 used. Record for later use during GC. */
4864 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
4865 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
4866 return FALSE;
4867 break;
4868
4869 case R_PPC64_REL14:
4870 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
4871 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
4872 {
4873 asection *dest = NULL;
4874
4875 /* Heuristic: If jumping outside our section, chances are
4876 we are going to need a stub. */
4877 if (h != NULL)
4878 {
4879 /* If the sym is weak it may be overridden later, so
4880 don't assume we know where a weak sym lives. */
4881 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
4882 dest = h->root.u.def.section;
4883 }
4884 else
4885 {
4886 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4887
4888 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
4889 abfd, r_symndx);
4890 if (isym == NULL)
4891 return FALSE;
4892
4893 dest = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4894 }
4895
4896 if (dest != sec)
4897 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_14bit_branch = 1;
4898 }
4899 goto rel24;
4900
4901 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
4902 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
4903 ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall = 1;
4904 /* Fall through. */
4905
4906 case R_PPC64_REL24:
4907 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
4908 rel24:
4909 plt_list = ifunc;
4910 if (h != NULL)
4911 {
4912 h->needs_plt = 1;
4913 if (h->root.root.string[0] == '.'
4914 && h->root.root.string[1] != '\0')
4915 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_func = 1;
4916
4917 if (h == tga || h == dottga)
4918 {
4919 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4920 if (rel != relocs
4921 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSGD
4922 || ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
4923 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with
4924 a marker reloc. */
4925 ;
4926 else
4927 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
4928 sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
4929 }
4930 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
4931 }
4932
4933 /* We may need a .plt entry if the function this reloc
4934 refers to is in a shared lib. */
4935 if (plt_list
4936 && !update_plt_info (abfd, plt_list, rel->r_addend))
4937 return FALSE;
4938 break;
4939
4940 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
4941 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
4942 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
4943 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
4944 goto dodyn;
4945
4946 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
4947 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
4948 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
4949 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
4950 goto dotlstoc;
4951
4952 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
4953 if (rel + 1 < rel_end
4954 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
4955 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
4956 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
4957 else
4958 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
4959 goto dotlstoc;
4960
4961 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
4962 tls_type = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
4963 if (rel != relocs
4964 && rel[-1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64)
4965 && rel[-1].r_offset == rel->r_offset - 8)
4966 /* This is the second reloc of a dtpmod, dtprel pair.
4967 Don't mark with TLS_DTPREL. */
4968 goto dodyn;
4969
4970 dotlstoc:
4971 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
4972 if (h != NULL)
4973 {
4974 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
4975 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
4976 eh->tls_mask |= tls_type & 0xff;
4977 }
4978 else
4979 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
4980 rel->r_addend, tls_type))
4981 return FALSE;
4982
4983 ppc64_sec = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec);
4984 if (ppc64_sec->sec_type != sec_toc)
4985 {
4986 bfd_size_type amt;
4987
4988 /* One extra to simplify get_tls_mask. */
4989 amt = sec->size * sizeof (unsigned) / 8 + sizeof (unsigned);
4990 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4991 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx == NULL)
4992 return FALSE;
4993 amt = sec->size * sizeof (bfd_vma) / 8;
4994 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4995 if (ppc64_sec->u.toc.add == NULL)
4996 return FALSE;
4997 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_sec->sec_type == sec_normal);
4998 ppc64_sec->sec_type = sec_toc;
4999 }
5000 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset % 8 == 0);
5001 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8] = r_symndx;
5002 ppc64_sec->u.toc.add[rel->r_offset / 8] = rel->r_addend;
5003
5004 /* Mark the second slot of a GD or LD entry.
5005 -1 to indicate GD and -2 to indicate LD. */
5006 if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
5007 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -1;
5008 else if (tls_type == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5009 ppc64_sec->u.toc.symndx[rel->r_offset / 8 + 1] = -2;
5010 goto dodyn;
5011
5012 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
5013 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
5014 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
5015 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
5016 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
5017 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
5018 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
5019 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
5020 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
5021 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
5022 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
5023 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
5024 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
5025 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5026 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
5027 goto dodyn;
5028
5029 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
5030 if (is_opd
5031 && rel + 1 < rel_end
5032 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5033 {
5034 if (h != NULL)
5035 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_func = 1;
5036 }
5037 /* Fall through. */
5038
5039 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
5040 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
5041 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
5042 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
5043 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
5044 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
5045 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
5046 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
5047 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
5048 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
5049 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
5050 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
5051 case R_PPC64_D34:
5052 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
5053 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
5054 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
5055 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
5056 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
5057 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
5058 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
5059 case R_PPC64_D28:
5060 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info) && abiversion (abfd) != 1
5061 && rel->r_addend == 0)
5062 {
5063 /* We may need a .plt entry if this reloc refers to a
5064 function in a shared lib. */
5065 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, 0))
5066 return FALSE;
5067 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
5068 }
5069 /* Fall through. */
5070
5071 case R_PPC64_REL30:
5072 case R_PPC64_REL32:
5073 case R_PPC64_REL64:
5074 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
5075 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
5076 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
5077 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
5078 case R_PPC64_TOC:
5079 if (h != NULL && bfd_link_executable (info))
5080 /* We may need a copy reloc. */
5081 h->non_got_ref = 1;
5082
5083 /* Don't propagate .opd relocs. */
5084 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
5085 break;
5086
5087 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
5088 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
5089 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
5090 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
5091 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
5092 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
5093 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
5094 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
5095 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
5096 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
5097 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
5098 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
5099 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
5100 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
5101 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
5102 symbol local.
5103
5104 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
5105 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
5106 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
5107 symbol. */
5108 dodyn:
5109 if ((h != NULL
5110 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
5111 || !h->def_regular))
5112 || (h != NULL
5113 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
5114 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
5115 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
5116 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5117 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5118 && ifunc != NULL))
5119 {
5120 /* We must copy these reloc types into the output file.
5121 Create a reloc section in dynobj and make room for
5122 this reloc. */
5123 if (sreloc == NULL)
5124 {
5125 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
5126 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 3, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
5127
5128 if (sreloc == NULL)
5129 return FALSE;
5130 }
5131
5132 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
5133 relocations we need for this symbol. */
5134 if (h != NULL)
5135 {
5136 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5137 struct elf_dyn_relocs **head;
5138
5139 head = &((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs;
5140 p = *head;
5141 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
5142 {
5143 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5144 if (p == NULL)
5145 return FALSE;
5146 p->next = *head;
5147 *head = p;
5148 p->sec = sec;
5149 p->count = 0;
5150 p->pc_count = 0;
5151 }
5152 p->count += 1;
5153 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
5154 p->pc_count += 1;
5155 }
5156 else
5157 {
5158 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
5159 We really need local syms available to do this
5160 easily. Oh well. */
5161 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5162 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **head;
5163 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
5164 asection *s;
5165 void *vpp;
5166 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
5167
5168 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
5169 abfd, r_symndx);
5170 if (isym == NULL)
5171 return FALSE;
5172
5173 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
5174 if (s == NULL)
5175 s = sec;
5176
5177 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
5178 head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
5179 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
5180 p = *head;
5181 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5182 p = p->next;
5183 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
5184 {
5185 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
5186 if (p == NULL)
5187 return FALSE;
5188 p->next = *head;
5189 *head = p;
5190 p->sec = sec;
5191 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
5192 p->count = 0;
5193 }
5194 p->count += 1;
5195 }
5196 }
5197 break;
5198
5199 default:
5200 break;
5201 }
5202 }
5203
5204 return TRUE;
5205 }
5206
5207 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
5208 object file when linking. */
5209
5210 static bfd_boolean
5211 ppc64_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5212 {
5213 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
5214 unsigned long iflags, oflags;
5215
5216 if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
5217 return TRUE;
5218
5219 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc64_elf (obfd))
5220 return TRUE;
5221
5222 if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
5223 return FALSE;
5224
5225 iflags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
5226 oflags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
5227
5228 if (iflags & ~EF_PPC64_ABI)
5229 {
5230 _bfd_error_handler
5231 /* xgettext:c-format */
5232 (_("%pB uses unknown e_flags 0x%lx"), ibfd, iflags);
5233 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5234 return FALSE;
5235 }
5236 else if (iflags != oflags && iflags != 0)
5237 {
5238 _bfd_error_handler
5239 /* xgettext:c-format */
5240 (_("%pB: ABI version %ld is not compatible with ABI version %ld output"),
5241 ibfd, iflags, oflags);
5242 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5243 return FALSE;
5244 }
5245
5246 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
5247 return FALSE;
5248
5249 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
5250 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
5251 }
5252
5253 static bfd_boolean
5254 ppc64_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
5255 {
5256 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
5257 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
5258
5259 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags != 0)
5260 {
5261 FILE *file = ptr;
5262
5263 fprintf (file, _("private flags = 0x%lx:"),
5264 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
5265
5266 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI) != 0)
5267 fprintf (file, _(" [abiv%ld]"),
5268 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC64_ABI);
5269 fputc ('\n', file);
5270 }
5271
5272 return TRUE;
5273 }
5274
5275 /* OFFSET in OPD_SEC specifies a function descriptor. Return the address
5276 of the code entry point, and its section, which must be in the same
5277 object as OPD_SEC. Returns (bfd_vma) -1 on error. */
5278
5279 static bfd_vma
5280 opd_entry_value (asection *opd_sec,
5281 bfd_vma offset,
5282 asection **code_sec,
5283 bfd_vma *code_off,
5284 bfd_boolean in_code_sec)
5285 {
5286 bfd *opd_bfd = opd_sec->owner;
5287 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
5288 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi, *look;
5289 bfd_vma val;
5290
5291 /* No relocs implies we are linking a --just-symbols object, or looking
5292 at a final linked executable with addr2line or somesuch. */
5293 if (opd_sec->reloc_count == 0)
5294 {
5295 bfd_byte *contents = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents;
5296
5297 if (contents == NULL)
5298 {
5299 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (opd_bfd, opd_sec, &contents))
5300 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5301 ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.contents = contents;
5302 }
5303
5304 /* PR 17512: file: 64b9dfbb. */
5305 if (offset + 7 >= opd_sec->size || offset + 7 < offset)
5306 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5307
5308 val = bfd_get_64 (opd_bfd, contents + offset);
5309 if (code_sec != NULL)
5310 {
5311 asection *sec, *likely = NULL;
5312
5313 if (in_code_sec)
5314 {
5315 sec = *code_sec;
5316 if (sec->vma <= val
5317 && val < sec->vma + sec->size)
5318 likely = sec;
5319 else
5320 val = -1;
5321 }
5322 else
5323 for (sec = opd_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
5324 if (sec->vma <= val
5325 && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5326 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5327 likely = sec;
5328 if (likely != NULL)
5329 {
5330 *code_sec = likely;
5331 if (code_off != NULL)
5332 *code_off = val - likely->vma;
5333 }
5334 }
5335 return val;
5336 }
5337
5338 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc64_elf (opd_bfd));
5339
5340 relocs = ppc64_elf_tdata (opd_bfd)->opd.relocs;
5341 if (relocs == NULL)
5342 relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (opd_bfd, opd_sec, NULL, NULL, TRUE);
5343 /* PR 17512: file: df8e1fd6. */
5344 if (relocs == NULL)
5345 return (bfd_vma) -1;
5346
5347 /* Go find the opd reloc at the sym address. */
5348 lo = relocs;
5349 hi = lo + opd_sec->reloc_count - 1; /* ignore last reloc */
5350 val = (bfd_vma) -1;
5351 while (lo < hi)
5352 {
5353 look = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
5354 if (look->r_offset < offset)
5355 lo = look + 1;
5356 else if (look->r_offset > offset)
5357 hi = look;
5358 else
5359 {
5360 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (opd_bfd);
5361
5362 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (look->r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
5363 && ELF64_R_TYPE ((look + 1)->r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
5364 {
5365 unsigned long symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (look->r_info);
5366 asection *sec = NULL;
5367
5368 if (symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info
5369 && elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd) != NULL)
5370 {
5371 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5372 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rh;
5373
5374 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (opd_bfd);
5375 rh = sym_hashes[symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
5376 if (rh != NULL)
5377 {
5378 rh = elf_follow_link (rh);
5379 if (rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5380 && rh->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5381 break;
5382 if (rh->root.u.def.section->owner == opd_bfd)
5383 {
5384 val = rh->root.u.def.value;
5385 sec = rh->root.u.def.section;
5386 }
5387 }
5388 }
5389
5390 if (sec == NULL)
5391 {
5392 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5393
5394 if (symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
5395 {
5396 sym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
5397 if (sym == NULL)
5398 {
5399 size_t symcnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5400 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5401 symcnt, 0,
5402 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5403 if (sym == NULL)
5404 break;
5405 symtab_hdr->contents = (bfd_byte *) sym;
5406 }
5407 sym += symndx;
5408 }
5409 else
5410 {
5411 sym = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (opd_bfd, symtab_hdr,
5412 1, symndx,
5413 NULL, NULL, NULL);
5414 if (sym == NULL)
5415 break;
5416 }
5417 sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (opd_bfd, sym->st_shndx);
5418 if (sec == NULL)
5419 break;
5420 BFD_ASSERT ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) == 0);
5421 val = sym->st_value;
5422 }
5423
5424 val += look->r_addend;
5425 if (code_off != NULL)
5426 *code_off = val;
5427 if (code_sec != NULL)
5428 {
5429 if (in_code_sec && *code_sec != sec)
5430 return -1;
5431 else
5432 *code_sec = sec;
5433 }
5434 if (sec->output_section != NULL)
5435 val += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5436 }
5437 break;
5438 }
5439 }
5440
5441 return val;
5442 }
5443
5444 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
5445 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
5446 otherwise return zero. */
5447
5448 static bfd_size_type
5449 ppc64_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
5450 bfd_vma *code_off)
5451 {
5452 bfd_size_type size;
5453
5454 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
5455 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0)
5456 return 0;
5457
5458 size = 0;
5459 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
5460 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5461
5462 if (strcmp (sym->section->name, ".opd") == 0)
5463 {
5464 struct _opd_sec_data *opd = get_opd_info (sym->section);
5465 bfd_vma symval = sym->value;
5466
5467 if (opd != NULL
5468 && opd->adjust != NULL
5469 && elf_section_data (sym->section)->relocs != NULL)
5470 {
5471 /* opd_entry_value will use cached relocs that have been
5472 adjusted, but with raw symbols. That means both local
5473 and global symbols need adjusting. */
5474 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (symval)];
5475 if (adjust == -1)
5476 return 0;
5477 symval += adjust;
5478 }
5479
5480 if (opd_entry_value (sym->section, symval,
5481 &sec, code_off, TRUE) == (bfd_vma) -1)
5482 return 0;
5483 /* An old ABI binary with dot-syms has a size of 24 on the .opd
5484 symbol. This size has nothing to do with the code size of the
5485 function, which is what we're supposed to return, but the
5486 code size isn't available without looking up the dot-sym.
5487 However, doing that would be a waste of time particularly
5488 since elf_find_function will look at the dot-sym anyway.
5489 Now, elf_find_function will keep the largest size of any
5490 function sym found at the code address of interest, so return
5491 1 here to avoid it incorrectly caching a larger function size
5492 for a small function. This does mean we return the wrong
5493 size for a new-ABI function of size 24, but all that does is
5494 disable caching for such functions. */
5495 if (size == 24)
5496 size = 1;
5497 }
5498 else
5499 {
5500 if (sym->section != sec)
5501 return 0;
5502 *code_off = sym->value;
5503 }
5504 if (size == 0)
5505 size = 1;
5506 return size;
5507 }
5508
5509 /* Return true if symbol is a strong function defined in an ELFv2
5510 object with st_other localentry bits of zero, ie. its local entry
5511 point coincides with its global entry point. */
5512
5513 static bfd_boolean
5514 is_elfv2_localentry0 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5515 {
5516 return (h != NULL
5517 && h->type == STT_FUNC
5518 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5519 && (STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK & h->other) == 0
5520 && !((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->non_zero_localentry
5521 && is_ppc64_elf (h->root.u.def.section->owner)
5522 && abiversion (h->root.u.def.section->owner) >= 2);
5523 }
5524
5525 /* Return true if symbol is defined in a regular object file. */
5526
5527 static bfd_boolean
5528 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5529 {
5530 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5531 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5532 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
5533 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
5534 }
5535
5536 /* If FDH is a function descriptor symbol, return the associated code
5537 entry symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5538
5539 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5540 defined_code_entry (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh)
5541 {
5542 if (fdh->is_func_descriptor)
5543 {
5544 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (fdh->oh);
5545 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5546 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5547 return fh;
5548 }
5549 return NULL;
5550 }
5551
5552 /* If FH is a function code entry symbol, return the associated
5553 function descriptor symbol if it is defined. Return NULL otherwise. */
5554
5555 static struct ppc_link_hash_entry *
5556 defined_func_desc (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh)
5557 {
5558 if (fh->oh != NULL
5559 && fh->oh->is_func_descriptor)
5560 {
5561 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = ppc_follow_link (fh->oh);
5562 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5563 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5564 return fdh;
5565 }
5566 return NULL;
5567 }
5568
5569 static bfd_boolean func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
5570
5571 /* Garbage collect sections, after first dealing with dot-symbols. */
5572
5573 static bfd_boolean
5574 ppc64_elf_gc_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5575 {
5576 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5577
5578 if (htab != NULL && htab->need_func_desc_adj)
5579 {
5580 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
5581 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
5582 }
5583 return bfd_elf_gc_sections (abfd, info);
5584 }
5585
5586 /* Mark all our entry sym sections, both opd and code section. */
5587
5588 static void
5589 ppc64_elf_gc_keep (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5590 {
5591 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5592 struct bfd_sym_chain *sym;
5593
5594 if (htab == NULL)
5595 return;
5596
5597 for (sym = info->gc_sym_list; sym != NULL; sym = sym->next)
5598 {
5599 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh;
5600 asection *sec;
5601
5602 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
5603 elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym->name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5604 if (eh == NULL)
5605 continue;
5606 if (eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
5607 && eh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5608 continue;
5609
5610 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5611 if (fh != NULL)
5612 {
5613 sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5614 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5615 }
5616 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5617 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5618 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5619 &sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5620 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5621
5622 sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5623 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5624 }
5625 }
5626
5627 /* Mark sections containing dynamically referenced symbols. When
5628 building shared libraries, we must assume that any visible symbol is
5629 referenced. */
5630
5631 static bfd_boolean
5632 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_dynamic_ref (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5633 {
5634 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
5635 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5636 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
5637 struct bfd_elf_dynamic_list *d = info->dynamic_list;
5638
5639 /* Dynamic linking info is on the func descriptor sym. */
5640 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5641 if (fdh != NULL)
5642 eh = fdh;
5643
5644 if ((eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5645 || eh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5646 && ((eh->elf.ref_dynamic && !eh->elf.forced_local)
5647 || ((eh->elf.def_regular || ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (&eh->elf))
5648 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_INTERNAL
5649 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (eh->elf.other) != STV_HIDDEN
5650 && (!bfd_link_executable (info)
5651 || info->gc_keep_exported
5652 || info->export_dynamic
5653 || (eh->elf.dynamic
5654 && d != NULL
5655 && (*d->match) (&d->head, NULL,
5656 eh->elf.root.root.string)))
5657 && (eh->elf.versioned >= versioned
5658 || !bfd_hide_sym_by_version (info->version_info,
5659 eh->elf.root.root.string)))))
5660 {
5661 asection *code_sec;
5662 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
5663
5664 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5665
5666 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5667 function code sym section to be marked. */
5668 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5669 if (fh != NULL)
5670 {
5671 code_sec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5672 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5673 }
5674 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5675 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5676 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5677 &code_sec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5678 code_sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5679 }
5680
5681 return TRUE;
5682 }
5683
5684 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
5685 relocation. */
5686
5687 static asection *
5688 ppc64_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
5689 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5690 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
5691 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5692 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
5693 {
5694 asection *rsec;
5695
5696 /* Syms return NULL if we're marking .opd, so we avoid marking all
5697 function sections, as all functions are referenced in .opd. */
5698 rsec = NULL;
5699 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
5700 return rsec;
5701
5702 if (h != NULL)
5703 {
5704 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
5705 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh, *fh, *fdh;
5706
5707 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
5708 switch (r_type)
5709 {
5710 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5711 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
5712 break;
5713
5714 default:
5715 switch (h->root.type)
5716 {
5717 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
5718 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
5719 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
5720 fdh = defined_func_desc (eh);
5721 if (fdh != NULL)
5722 {
5723 /* -mcall-aixdesc code references the dot-symbol on
5724 a call reloc. Mark the function descriptor too
5725 against garbage collection. */
5726 fdh->elf.mark = 1;
5727 if (fdh->elf.is_weakalias)
5728 weakdef (&fdh->elf)->mark = 1;
5729 eh = fdh;
5730 }
5731
5732 /* Function descriptor syms cause the associated
5733 function code sym section to be marked. */
5734 fh = defined_code_entry (eh);
5735 if (fh != NULL)
5736 {
5737 /* They also mark their opd section. */
5738 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5739
5740 rsec = fh->elf.root.u.def.section;
5741 }
5742 else if (get_opd_info (eh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
5743 && opd_entry_value (eh->elf.root.u.def.section,
5744 eh->elf.root.u.def.value,
5745 &rsec, NULL, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
5746 eh->elf.root.u.def.section->gc_mark = 1;
5747 else
5748 rsec = h->root.u.def.section;
5749 break;
5750
5751 case bfd_link_hash_common:
5752 rsec = h->root.u.c.p->section;
5753 break;
5754
5755 default:
5756 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
5757 }
5758 }
5759 }
5760 else
5761 {
5762 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
5763
5764 rsec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
5765 opd = get_opd_info (rsec);
5766 if (opd != NULL && opd->func_sec != NULL)
5767 {
5768 rsec->gc_mark = 1;
5769
5770 rsec = opd->func_sec[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value + rel->r_addend)];
5771 }
5772 }
5773
5774 return rsec;
5775 }
5776
5777 /* The maximum size of .sfpr. */
5778 #define SFPR_MAX (218*4)
5779
5780 struct sfpr_def_parms
5781 {
5782 const char name[12];
5783 unsigned char lo, hi;
5784 bfd_byte *(*write_ent) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5785 bfd_byte *(*write_tail) (bfd *, bfd_byte *, int);
5786 };
5787
5788 /* Auto-generate _save*, _rest* functions in .sfpr.
5789 If STUB_SEC is non-null, define alias symbols in STUB_SEC
5790 instead. */
5791
5792 static bfd_boolean
5793 sfpr_define (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5794 const struct sfpr_def_parms *parm,
5795 asection *stub_sec)
5796 {
5797 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
5798 unsigned int i;
5799 size_t len = strlen (parm->name);
5800 bfd_boolean writing = FALSE;
5801 char sym[16];
5802
5803 if (htab == NULL)
5804 return FALSE;
5805
5806 memcpy (sym, parm->name, len);
5807 sym[len + 2] = 0;
5808
5809 for (i = parm->lo; i <= parm->hi; i++)
5810 {
5811 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
5812
5813 sym[len + 0] = i / 10 + '0';
5814 sym[len + 1] = i % 10 + '0';
5815 h = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
5816 elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, sym, writing, TRUE, TRUE);
5817 if (stub_sec != NULL)
5818 {
5819 if (h != NULL
5820 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5821 && h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
5822 {
5823 struct elf_link_hash_entry *s;
5824 char buf[32];
5825 sprintf (buf, "%08x.%s", stub_sec->id & 0xffffffff, sym);
5826 s = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, buf, TRUE, TRUE, FALSE);
5827 if (s == NULL)
5828 return FALSE;
5829 if (s->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5830 || (s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined
5831 && s->root.u.def.section == stub_sec))
5832 {
5833 s->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5834 s->root.u.def.section = stub_sec;
5835 s->root.u.def.value = (stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
5836 + h->elf.root.u.def.value);
5837 s->ref_regular = 1;
5838 s->def_regular = 1;
5839 s->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5840 s->forced_local = 1;
5841 s->non_elf = 0;
5842 s->root.linker_def = 1;
5843 }
5844 }
5845 continue;
5846 }
5847 if (h != NULL)
5848 {
5849 h->save_res = 1;
5850 if (!h->elf.def_regular)
5851 {
5852 h->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5853 h->elf.root.u.def.section = htab->sfpr;
5854 h->elf.root.u.def.value = htab->sfpr->size;
5855 h->elf.type = STT_FUNC;
5856 h->elf.def_regular = 1;
5857 h->elf.non_elf = 0;
5858 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->elf, TRUE);
5859 writing = TRUE;
5860 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5861 {
5862 htab->sfpr->contents
5863 = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, SFPR_MAX);
5864 if (htab->sfpr->contents == NULL)
5865 return FALSE;
5866 }
5867 }
5868 }
5869 if (writing)
5870 {
5871 bfd_byte *p = htab->sfpr->contents + htab->sfpr->size;
5872 if (i != parm->hi)
5873 p = (*parm->write_ent) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5874 else
5875 p = (*parm->write_tail) (htab->elf.dynobj, p, i);
5876 htab->sfpr->size = p - htab->sfpr->contents;
5877 }
5878 }
5879
5880 return TRUE;
5881 }
5882
5883 static bfd_byte *
5884 savegpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5885 {
5886 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5887 return p + 4;
5888 }
5889
5890 static bfd_byte *
5891 savegpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5892 {
5893 p = savegpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5894 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5895 p = p + 4;
5896 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5897 return p + 4;
5898 }
5899
5900 static bfd_byte *
5901 restgpr0 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5902 {
5903 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5904 return p + 4;
5905 }
5906
5907 static bfd_byte *
5908 restgpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5909 {
5910 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5911 p = p + 4;
5912 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, r);
5913 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
5914 p = p + 4;
5915 if (r == 29)
5916 {
5917 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 30);
5918 p = restgpr0 (abfd, p, 31);
5919 }
5920 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5921 return p + 4;
5922 }
5923
5924 static bfd_byte *
5925 savegpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5926 {
5927 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5928 return p + 4;
5929 }
5930
5931 static bfd_byte *
5932 savegpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5933 {
5934 p = savegpr1 (abfd, p, r);
5935 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5936 return p + 4;
5937 }
5938
5939 static bfd_byte *
5940 restgpr1 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5941 {
5942 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R12 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5943 return p + 4;
5944 }
5945
5946 static bfd_byte *
5947 restgpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5948 {
5949 p = restgpr1 (abfd, p, r);
5950 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5951 return p + 4;
5952 }
5953
5954 static bfd_byte *
5955 savefpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5956 {
5957 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5958 return p + 4;
5959 }
5960
5961 static bfd_byte *
5962 savefpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5963 {
5964 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
5965 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5966 p = p + 4;
5967 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5968 return p + 4;
5969 }
5970
5971 static bfd_byte *
5972 restfpr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5973 {
5974 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LFD_FR0_0R1 + (r << 21) + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 8, p);
5975 return p + 4;
5976 }
5977
5978 static bfd_byte *
5979 restfpr0_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5980 {
5981 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R0_0R1 + STK_LR, p);
5982 p = p + 4;
5983 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
5984 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R0, p);
5985 p = p + 4;
5986 if (r == 29)
5987 {
5988 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 30);
5989 p = restfpr (abfd, p, 31);
5990 }
5991 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
5992 return p + 4;
5993 }
5994
5995 static bfd_byte *
5996 savefpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
5997 {
5998 p = savefpr (abfd, p, r);
5999 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6000 return p + 4;
6001 }
6002
6003 static bfd_byte *
6004 restfpr1_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6005 {
6006 p = restfpr (abfd, p, r);
6007 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6008 return p + 4;
6009 }
6010
6011 static bfd_byte *
6012 savevr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6013 {
6014 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6015 p = p + 4;
6016 bfd_put_32 (abfd, STVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6017 return p + 4;
6018 }
6019
6020 static bfd_byte *
6021 savevr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6022 {
6023 p = savevr (abfd, p, r);
6024 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6025 return p + 4;
6026 }
6027
6028 static bfd_byte *
6029 restvr (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6030 {
6031 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + (1 << 16) - (32 - r) * 16, p);
6032 p = p + 4;
6033 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LVX_VR0_R12_R0 + (r << 21), p);
6034 return p + 4;
6035 }
6036
6037 static bfd_byte *
6038 restvr_tail (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, int r)
6039 {
6040 p = restvr (abfd, p, r);
6041 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BLR, p);
6042 return p + 4;
6043 }
6044
6045 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to transfer dynamic linking
6046 information on function code symbol entries to their corresponding
6047 function descriptor symbol entries. */
6048
6049 static bfd_boolean
6050 func_desc_adjust (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
6051 {
6052 struct bfd_link_info *info;
6053 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6054 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh;
6055 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
6056 bfd_boolean force_local;
6057
6058 fh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6059 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6060 return TRUE;
6061
6062 if (!fh->is_func)
6063 return TRUE;
6064
6065 if (fh->elf.root.root.string[0] != '.'
6066 || fh->elf.root.root.string[1] == '\0')
6067 return TRUE;
6068
6069 info = inf;
6070 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6071 if (htab == NULL)
6072 return FALSE;
6073
6074 /* Find the corresponding function descriptor symbol. */
6075 fdh = lookup_fdh (fh, htab);
6076
6077 /* Resolve undefined references to dot-symbols as the value
6078 in the function descriptor, if we have one in a regular object.
6079 This is to satisfy cases like ".quad .foo". Calls to functions
6080 in dynamic objects are handled elsewhere. */
6081 if ((fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6082 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6083 && (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6084 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6085 && get_opd_info (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section) != NULL
6086 && opd_entry_value (fdh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6087 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value,
6088 &fh->elf.root.u.def.section,
6089 &fh->elf.root.u.def.value, FALSE) != (bfd_vma) -1)
6090 {
6091 fh->elf.root.type = fdh->elf.root.type;
6092 fh->elf.forced_local = 1;
6093 fh->elf.def_regular = fdh->elf.def_regular;
6094 fh->elf.def_dynamic = fdh->elf.def_dynamic;
6095 }
6096
6097 if (!fh->elf.dynamic)
6098 {
6099 struct plt_entry *ent;
6100
6101 for (ent = fh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6102 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6103 break;
6104 if (ent == NULL)
6105 return TRUE;
6106 }
6107
6108 /* Create a descriptor as undefined if necessary. */
6109 if (fdh == NULL
6110 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
6111 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6112 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
6113 {
6114 fdh = make_fdh (info, fh);
6115 if (fdh == NULL)
6116 return FALSE;
6117 }
6118
6119 /* We can't support overriding of symbols on a fake descriptor. */
6120 if (fdh != NULL
6121 && fdh->fake
6122 && (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6123 || fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
6124 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fdh->elf, TRUE);
6125
6126 /* Transfer dynamic linking information to the function descriptor. */
6127 if (fdh != NULL)
6128 {
6129 fdh->elf.ref_regular |= fh->elf.ref_regular;
6130 fdh->elf.ref_dynamic |= fh->elf.ref_dynamic;
6131 fdh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= fh->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
6132 fdh->elf.non_got_ref |= fh->elf.non_got_ref;
6133 fdh->elf.dynamic |= fh->elf.dynamic;
6134 fdh->elf.needs_plt |= (fh->elf.needs_plt
6135 || fh->elf.type == STT_FUNC
6136 || fh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
6137 move_plt_plist (fh, fdh);
6138
6139 if (!fdh->elf.forced_local
6140 && fh->elf.dynindx != -1)
6141 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, &fdh->elf))
6142 return FALSE;
6143 }
6144
6145 /* Now that the info is on the function descriptor, clear the
6146 function code sym info. Any function code syms for which we
6147 don't have a definition in a regular file, we force local.
6148 This prevents a shared library from exporting syms that have
6149 been imported from another library. Function code syms that
6150 are really in the library we must leave global to prevent the
6151 linker dragging in a definition from a static library. */
6152 force_local = (!fh->elf.def_regular
6153 || fdh == NULL
6154 || !fdh->elf.def_regular
6155 || fdh->elf.forced_local);
6156 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6157
6158 return TRUE;
6159 }
6160
6161 static const struct sfpr_def_parms save_res_funcs[] =
6162 {
6163 { "_savegpr0_", 14, 31, savegpr0, savegpr0_tail },
6164 { "_restgpr0_", 14, 29, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6165 { "_restgpr0_", 30, 31, restgpr0, restgpr0_tail },
6166 { "_savegpr1_", 14, 31, savegpr1, savegpr1_tail },
6167 { "_restgpr1_", 14, 31, restgpr1, restgpr1_tail },
6168 { "_savefpr_", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr0_tail },
6169 { "_restfpr_", 14, 29, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6170 { "_restfpr_", 30, 31, restfpr, restfpr0_tail },
6171 { "._savef", 14, 31, savefpr, savefpr1_tail },
6172 { "._restf", 14, 31, restfpr, restfpr1_tail },
6173 { "_savevr_", 20, 31, savevr, savevr_tail },
6174 { "_restvr_", 20, 31, restvr, restvr_tail }
6175 };
6176
6177 /* Called near the start of bfd_elf_size_dynamic_sections. We use
6178 this hook to a) provide some gcc support functions, and b) transfer
6179 dynamic linking information gathered so far on function code symbol
6180 entries, to their corresponding function descriptor symbol entries. */
6181
6182 static bfd_boolean
6183 ppc64_elf_func_desc_adjust (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6184 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6185 {
6186 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6187
6188 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6189 if (htab == NULL)
6190 return FALSE;
6191
6192 /* Provide any missing _save* and _rest* functions. */
6193 if (htab->sfpr != NULL)
6194 {
6195 unsigned int i;
6196
6197 htab->sfpr->size = 0;
6198 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
6199 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], NULL))
6200 return FALSE;
6201 if (htab->sfpr->size == 0)
6202 htab->sfpr->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6203 }
6204
6205 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
6206 return TRUE;
6207
6208 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6209 {
6210 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, htab->elf.hgot, TRUE);
6211 /* Make .TOC. defined so as to prevent it being made dynamic.
6212 The wrong value here is fixed later in ppc64_elf_set_toc. */
6213 if (!htab->elf.hgot->def_regular
6214 || htab->elf.hgot->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined)
6215 {
6216 htab->elf.hgot->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6217 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = 0;
6218 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6219 htab->elf.hgot->def_regular = 1;
6220 htab->elf.hgot->root.linker_def = 1;
6221 }
6222 htab->elf.hgot->type = STT_OBJECT;
6223 htab->elf.hgot->other
6224 = (htab->elf.hgot->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
6225 }
6226
6227 if (htab->need_func_desc_adj)
6228 {
6229 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, func_desc_adjust, info);
6230 htab->need_func_desc_adj = 0;
6231 }
6232
6233 return TRUE;
6234 }
6235
6236 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
6237
6238 static asection *
6239 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6240 {
6241 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6242 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6243
6244 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6245 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
6246 {
6247 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
6248
6249 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6250 return p->sec;
6251 }
6252 return NULL;
6253 }
6254
6255 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
6256 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
6257 size_dynamic_sections. */
6258
6259 static bfd_boolean
6260 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6261 {
6262 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6263
6264 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6265 do
6266 {
6267 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
6268 return TRUE;
6269 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) eh->elf.u.alias;
6270 }
6271 while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
6272
6273 return FALSE;
6274 }
6275
6276 /* Return whether EH has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
6277
6278 static bfd_boolean
6279 pc_dynrelocs (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh)
6280 {
6281 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6282
6283 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
6284 if (p->pc_count != 0)
6285 return TRUE;
6286 return FALSE;
6287 }
6288
6289 /* Return true if a global entry stub will be created for H. Valid
6290 for ELFv2 before plt entries have been allocated. */
6291
6292 static bfd_boolean
6293 global_entry_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6294 {
6295 struct plt_entry *pent;
6296
6297 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6298 || h->def_regular)
6299 return FALSE;
6300
6301 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
6302 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0
6303 && pent->addend == 0)
6304 return TRUE;
6305
6306 return FALSE;
6307 }
6308
6309 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6310 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6311 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6312 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6313 understand. */
6314
6315 static bfd_boolean
6316 ppc64_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6317 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6318 {
6319 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6320 asection *s, *srel;
6321
6322 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
6323 if (htab == NULL)
6324 return FALSE;
6325
6326 /* Deal with function syms. */
6327 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
6328 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6329 || h->needs_plt)
6330 {
6331 bfd_boolean local = (((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->save_res
6332 || SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
6333 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
6334 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
6335 function symbol is local and not an ifunc. We keep dynamic
6336 relocs for ifuncs when local rather than always emitting a
6337 plt call stub for them and defining the symbol on the call
6338 stub. We can't do that for ELFv1 anyway (a function symbol
6339 is defined on a descriptor, not code) and it can be faster at
6340 run-time due to not needing to bounce through a stub. The
6341 dyn_relocs for ifuncs will be applied even in a static
6342 executable. */
6343 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
6344 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6345 && local)
6346 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6347
6348 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
6349 won't need a .plt entry. */
6350 struct plt_entry *ent;
6351 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
6352 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
6353 break;
6354 if (ent == NULL
6355 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
6356 && local
6357 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
6358 || (((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask
6359 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
6360 {
6361 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6362 h->needs_plt = 0;
6363 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6364 }
6365 else if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) >= 2)
6366 {
6367 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
6368 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
6369 executable on a global entry stub. A dynamic reloc can
6370 be used instead. The reason we prefer a few more dynamic
6371 relocs is that calling via a global entry stub costs a
6372 few more instructions, and pointer_equality_needed causes
6373 extra work in ld.so when resolving these symbols. */
6374 if (global_entry_stub (h))
6375 {
6376 if (!readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6377 {
6378 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6379 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
6380 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6381 if (!h->needs_plt)
6382 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6383 }
6384 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
6385 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
6386 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
6387 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6388 }
6389
6390 /* ELFv2 function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
6391 return TRUE;
6392 }
6393 else if (!h->needs_plt
6394 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6395 {
6396 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol isn't an
6397 ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
6398 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6399 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
6400 return TRUE;
6401 }
6402 }
6403 else
6404 h->plt.plist = NULL;
6405
6406 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6407 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6408 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
6409 if (h->is_weakalias)
6410 {
6411 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
6412 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6413 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
6414 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
6415 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
6416 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
6417 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6418 return TRUE;
6419 }
6420
6421 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
6422 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
6423 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
6424 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
6425 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
6426 return TRUE;
6427
6428 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
6429 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
6430 if (!h->non_got_ref)
6431 return TRUE;
6432
6433 /* Don't generate a copy reloc for symbols defined in the executable. */
6434 if (!h->def_dynamic || !h->ref_regular || h->def_regular
6435
6436 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, don't generate them either. */
6437 || info->nocopyreloc
6438
6439 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
6440 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc. */
6441 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
6442 && !h->needs_copy
6443 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
6444
6445 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
6446 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
6447 definition for the variable. Text relocations are preferable
6448 to an incorrect program. */
6449 || h->protected_def)
6450 return TRUE;
6451
6452 if (h->plt.plist != NULL)
6453 {
6454 /* We should never get here, but unfortunately there are versions
6455 of gcc out there that improperly (for this ABI) put initialized
6456 function pointers, vtable refs and suchlike in read-only
6457 sections. Allow them to proceed, but warn that this might
6458 break at runtime. */
6459 info->callbacks->einfo
6460 (_("%P: copy reloc against `%pT' requires lazy plt linking; "
6461 "avoid setting LD_BIND_NOW=1 or upgrade gcc\n"),
6462 h->root.root.string);
6463 }
6464
6465 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6466 is not a function. */
6467
6468 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
6469 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
6470 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
6471 object will contain position independent code, so all references
6472 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
6473 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
6474 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
6475 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
6476 same memory location for the variable. */
6477 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
6478 {
6479 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
6480 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
6481 }
6482 else
6483 {
6484 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
6485 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
6486 }
6487 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
6488 {
6489 /* We must generate a R_PPC64_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
6490 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
6491 and into the runtime process image. */
6492 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
6493 h->needs_copy = 1;
6494 }
6495
6496 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
6497 ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
6498 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
6499 }
6500
6501 /* If given a function descriptor symbol, hide both the function code
6502 sym and the descriptor. */
6503 static void
6504 ppc64_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6505 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6506 bfd_boolean force_local)
6507 {
6508 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6509 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
6510
6511 if (ppc_hash_table (info) == NULL)
6512 return;
6513
6514 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6515 if (eh->is_func_descriptor)
6516 {
6517 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = eh->oh;
6518
6519 if (fh == NULL)
6520 {
6521 const char *p, *q;
6522 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
6523 char save;
6524
6525 /* We aren't supposed to use alloca in BFD because on
6526 systems which do not have alloca the version in libiberty
6527 calls xmalloc, which might cause the program to crash
6528 when it runs out of memory. This function doesn't have a
6529 return status, so there's no way to gracefully return an
6530 error. So cheat. We know that string[-1] can be safely
6531 accessed; It's either a string in an ELF string table,
6532 or allocated in an objalloc structure. */
6533
6534 p = eh->elf.root.root.string - 1;
6535 save = *p;
6536 *(char *) p = '.';
6537 fh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
6538 elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
6539 *(char *) p = save;
6540
6541 /* Unfortunately, if it so happens that the string we were
6542 looking for was allocated immediately before this string,
6543 then we overwrote the string terminator. That's the only
6544 reason the lookup should fail. */
6545 if (fh == NULL)
6546 {
6547 q = eh->elf.root.root.string + strlen (eh->elf.root.root.string);
6548 while (q >= eh->elf.root.root.string && *q == *p)
6549 --q, --p;
6550 if (q < eh->elf.root.root.string && *p == '.')
6551 fh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
6552 elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, p, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
6553 }
6554 if (fh != NULL)
6555 {
6556 eh->oh = fh;
6557 fh->oh = eh;
6558 }
6559 }
6560 if (fh != NULL)
6561 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &fh->elf, force_local);
6562 }
6563 }
6564
6565 static bfd_boolean
6566 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
6567 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
6568 asection **symsecp,
6569 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6570 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6571 unsigned long r_symndx,
6572 bfd *ibfd)
6573 {
6574 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
6575
6576 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6577 {
6578 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
6579 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6580
6581 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6582 h = elf_follow_link (h);
6583
6584 if (hp != NULL)
6585 *hp = h;
6586
6587 if (symp != NULL)
6588 *symp = NULL;
6589
6590 if (symsecp != NULL)
6591 {
6592 asection *symsec = NULL;
6593 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6594 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6595 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
6596 *symsecp = symsec;
6597 }
6598
6599 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6600 {
6601 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6602
6603 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6604 *tls_maskp = &eh->tls_mask;
6605 }
6606 }
6607 else
6608 {
6609 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6610 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
6611
6612 if (locsyms == NULL)
6613 {
6614 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6615 if (locsyms == NULL)
6616 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
6617 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
6618 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
6619 if (locsyms == NULL)
6620 return FALSE;
6621 *locsymsp = locsyms;
6622 }
6623 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
6624
6625 if (hp != NULL)
6626 *hp = NULL;
6627
6628 if (symp != NULL)
6629 *symp = sym;
6630
6631 if (symsecp != NULL)
6632 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
6633
6634 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
6635 {
6636 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
6637 unsigned char *tls_mask;
6638
6639 tls_mask = NULL;
6640 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
6641 if (lgot_ents != NULL)
6642 {
6643 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6644 (lgot_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6645 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
6646 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6647 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
6648 }
6649 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
6650 }
6651 }
6652 return TRUE;
6653 }
6654
6655 /* Returns TLS_MASKP for the given REL symbol. Function return is 0 on
6656 error, 2 on a toc GD type suitable for optimization, 3 on a toc LD
6657 type suitable for optimization, and 1 otherwise. */
6658
6659 static int
6660 get_tls_mask (unsigned char **tls_maskp,
6661 unsigned long *toc_symndx,
6662 bfd_vma *toc_addend,
6663 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
6664 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6665 bfd *ibfd)
6666 {
6667 unsigned long r_symndx;
6668 int next_r;
6669 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6670 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6671 asection *sec;
6672 bfd_vma off;
6673
6674 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6675 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6676 return 0;
6677
6678 if ((*tls_maskp != NULL
6679 && (**tls_maskp & TLS_TLS) != 0
6680 && **tls_maskp != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
6681 || sec == NULL
6682 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec) == NULL
6683 || ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->sec_type != sec_toc)
6684 return 1;
6685
6686 /* Look inside a TOC section too. */
6687 if (h != NULL)
6688 {
6689 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
6690 off = h->root.u.def.value;
6691 }
6692 else
6693 off = sym->st_value;
6694 off += rel->r_addend;
6695 BFD_ASSERT (off % 8 == 0);
6696 r_symndx = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8];
6697 next_r = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.symndx[off / 8 + 1];
6698 if (toc_symndx != NULL)
6699 *toc_symndx = r_symndx;
6700 if (toc_addend != NULL)
6701 *toc_addend = ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.toc.add[off / 8];
6702 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sec, tls_maskp, locsymsp, r_symndx, ibfd))
6703 return 0;
6704 if ((h == NULL || is_static_defined (h))
6705 && (next_r == -1 || next_r == -2))
6706 return 1 - next_r;
6707 return 1;
6708 }
6709
6710 /* Find (or create) an entry in the tocsave hash table. */
6711
6712 static struct tocsave_entry *
6713 tocsave_find (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
6714 enum insert_option insert,
6715 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6716 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irela,
6717 bfd *ibfd)
6718 {
6719 unsigned long r_indx;
6720 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6721 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
6722 struct tocsave_entry ent, *p;
6723 hashval_t hash;
6724 struct tocsave_entry **slot;
6725
6726 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
6727 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &ent.sec, NULL, local_syms, r_indx, ibfd))
6728 return NULL;
6729 if (ent.sec == NULL || ent.sec->output_section == NULL)
6730 {
6731 _bfd_error_handler
6732 (_("%pB: undefined symbol on R_PPC64_TOCSAVE relocation"), ibfd);
6733 return NULL;
6734 }
6735
6736 if (h != NULL)
6737 ent.offset = h->root.u.def.value;
6738 else
6739 ent.offset = sym->st_value;
6740 ent.offset += irela->r_addend;
6741
6742 hash = tocsave_htab_hash (&ent);
6743 slot = ((struct tocsave_entry **)
6744 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab->tocsave_htab, &ent, hash, insert));
6745 if (slot == NULL)
6746 return NULL;
6747
6748 if (*slot == NULL)
6749 {
6750 p = (struct tocsave_entry *) bfd_alloc (ibfd, sizeof (*p));
6751 if (p == NULL)
6752 return NULL;
6753 *p = ent;
6754 *slot = p;
6755 }
6756 return *slot;
6757 }
6758
6759 /* Adjust all global syms defined in opd sections. In gcc generated
6760 code for the old ABI, these will already have been done. */
6761
6762 static bfd_boolean
6763 adjust_opd_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6764 {
6765 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
6766 asection *sym_sec;
6767 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
6768
6769 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6770 return TRUE;
6771
6772 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
6773 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6774 return TRUE;
6775
6776 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
6777 if (eh->adjust_done)
6778 return TRUE;
6779
6780 sym_sec = eh->elf.root.u.def.section;
6781 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
6782 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
6783 {
6784 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (eh->elf.root.u.def.value)];
6785 if (adjust == -1)
6786 {
6787 /* This entry has been deleted. */
6788 asection *dsec = ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section;
6789 if (dsec == NULL)
6790 {
6791 for (dsec = sym_sec->owner->sections; dsec; dsec = dsec->next)
6792 if (discarded_section (dsec))
6793 {
6794 ppc64_elf_tdata (sym_sec->owner)->deleted_section = dsec;
6795 break;
6796 }
6797 }
6798 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
6799 eh->elf.root.u.def.section = dsec;
6800 }
6801 else
6802 eh->elf.root.u.def.value += adjust;
6803 eh->adjust_done = 1;
6804 }
6805 return TRUE;
6806 }
6807
6808 /* Handles decrementing dynamic reloc counts for the reloc specified by
6809 R_INFO in section SEC. If LOCAL_SYMS is NULL, then H and SYM
6810 have already been determined. */
6811
6812 static bfd_boolean
6813 dec_dynrel_count (bfd_vma r_info,
6814 asection *sec,
6815 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6816 Elf_Internal_Sym **local_syms,
6817 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6818 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
6819 {
6820 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
6821 asection *sym_sec = NULL;
6822
6823 /* Can this reloc be dynamic? This switch, and later tests here
6824 should be kept in sync with the code in check_relocs. */
6825 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (r_info);
6826 switch (r_type)
6827 {
6828 default:
6829 return TRUE;
6830
6831 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
6832 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
6833 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
6834 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
6835 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
6836 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
6837 if (h == NULL)
6838 return TRUE;
6839 break;
6840
6841 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
6842 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
6843 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
6844 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
6845 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
6846 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
6847 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
6848 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
6849 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
6850 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
6851 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
6852 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
6853 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
6854 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
6855 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
6856 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
6857 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
6858 case R_PPC64_REL30:
6859 case R_PPC64_REL32:
6860 case R_PPC64_REL64:
6861 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
6862 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
6863 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
6864 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
6865 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
6866 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
6867 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
6868 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
6869 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
6870 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
6871 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
6872 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
6873 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
6874 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
6875 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
6876 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
6877 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
6878 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
6879 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
6880 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
6881 case R_PPC64_TOC:
6882 case R_PPC64_D34:
6883 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
6884 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
6885 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
6886 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
6887 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
6888 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
6889 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
6890 case R_PPC64_D28:
6891 break;
6892 }
6893
6894 if (local_syms != NULL)
6895 {
6896 unsigned long r_symndx;
6897 bfd *ibfd = sec->owner;
6898
6899 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (r_info);
6900 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, local_syms, r_symndx, ibfd))
6901 return FALSE;
6902 }
6903
6904 if ((h != NULL
6905 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6906 || !h->def_regular))
6907 || (h != NULL
6908 && !bfd_link_executable (info)
6909 && !SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h))
6910 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
6911 && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
6912 || (!bfd_link_pic (info)
6913 && (h != NULL
6914 ? h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6915 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)))
6916 ;
6917 else
6918 return TRUE;
6919
6920 if (h != NULL)
6921 {
6922 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
6923 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
6924 pp = &((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->dyn_relocs;
6925
6926 /* elf_gc_sweep may have already removed all dyn relocs associated
6927 with local syms for a given section. Also, symbol flags are
6928 changed by elf_gc_sweep_symbol, confusing the test above. Don't
6929 report a dynreloc miscount. */
6930 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
6931 return TRUE;
6932
6933 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
6934 {
6935 if (p->sec == sec)
6936 {
6937 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
6938 p->pc_count -= 1;
6939 p->count -= 1;
6940 if (p->count == 0)
6941 *pp = p->next;
6942 return TRUE;
6943 }
6944 pp = &p->next;
6945 }
6946 }
6947 else
6948 {
6949 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
6950 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **pp;
6951 void *vpp;
6952 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
6953
6954 if (local_syms == NULL)
6955 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
6956 if (sym_sec == NULL)
6957 sym_sec = sec;
6958
6959 vpp = &elf_section_data (sym_sec)->local_dynrel;
6960 pp = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
6961
6962 if (*pp == NULL && info->gc_sections)
6963 return TRUE;
6964
6965 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
6966 while ((p = *pp) != NULL)
6967 {
6968 if (p->sec == sec && p->ifunc == is_ifunc)
6969 {
6970 p->count -= 1;
6971 if (p->count == 0)
6972 *pp = p->next;
6973 return TRUE;
6974 }
6975 pp = &p->next;
6976 }
6977 }
6978
6979 /* xgettext:c-format */
6980 _bfd_error_handler (_("dynreloc miscount for %pB, section %pA"),
6981 sec->owner, sec);
6982 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6983 return FALSE;
6984 }
6985
6986 /* Remove unused Official Procedure Descriptor entries. Currently we
6987 only remove those associated with functions in discarded link-once
6988 sections, or weakly defined functions that have been overridden. It
6989 would be possible to remove many more entries for statically linked
6990 applications. */
6991
6992 bfd_boolean
6993 ppc64_elf_edit_opd (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6994 {
6995 bfd *ibfd;
6996 bfd_boolean some_edited = FALSE;
6997 asection *need_pad = NULL;
6998 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
6999
7000 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7001 if (htab == NULL)
7002 return FALSE;
7003
7004 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7005 {
7006 asection *sec;
7007 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7008 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7009 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7010 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
7011 bfd_boolean need_edit, add_aux_fields, broken;
7012 bfd_size_type cnt_16b = 0;
7013
7014 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7015 continue;
7016
7017 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".opd");
7018 if (sec == NULL || sec->size == 0)
7019 continue;
7020
7021 if (sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS)
7022 continue;
7023
7024 if (sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7025 continue;
7026
7027 /* Look through the section relocs. */
7028 if ((sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0 || sec->reloc_count == 0)
7029 continue;
7030
7031 local_syms = NULL;
7032 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7033
7034 /* Read the relocations. */
7035 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7036 info->keep_memory);
7037 if (relstart == NULL)
7038 return FALSE;
7039
7040 /* First run through the relocs to check they are sane, and to
7041 determine whether we need to edit this opd section. */
7042 need_edit = FALSE;
7043 broken = FALSE;
7044 need_pad = sec;
7045 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7046 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7047 {
7048 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7049 unsigned long r_symndx;
7050 asection *sym_sec;
7051 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7052 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7053 bfd_vma offset;
7054
7055 /* .opd contains an array of 16 or 24 byte entries. We're
7056 only interested in the reloc pointing to a function entry
7057 point. */
7058 offset = rel->r_offset;
7059 if (rel + 1 == relend
7060 || rel[1].r_offset != offset + 8)
7061 {
7062 /* If someone messes with .opd alignment then after a
7063 "ld -r" we might have padding in the middle of .opd.
7064 Also, there's nothing to prevent someone putting
7065 something silly in .opd with the assembler. No .opd
7066 optimization for them! */
7067 broken_opd:
7068 _bfd_error_handler
7069 (_("%pB: .opd is not a regular array of opd entries"), ibfd);
7070 broken = TRUE;
7071 break;
7072 }
7073
7074 if ((r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info)) != R_PPC64_ADDR64
7075 || (r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE ((rel + 1)->r_info)) != R_PPC64_TOC)
7076 {
7077 _bfd_error_handler
7078 /* xgettext:c-format */
7079 (_("%pB: unexpected reloc type %u in .opd section"),
7080 ibfd, r_type);
7081 broken = TRUE;
7082 break;
7083 }
7084
7085 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7086 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7087 r_symndx, ibfd))
7088 goto error_ret;
7089
7090 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec->owner == NULL)
7091 {
7092 const char *sym_name;
7093 if (h != NULL)
7094 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7095 else
7096 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym,
7097 sym_sec);
7098
7099 _bfd_error_handler
7100 /* xgettext:c-format */
7101 (_("%pB: undefined sym `%s' in .opd section"),
7102 ibfd, sym_name);
7103 broken = TRUE;
7104 break;
7105 }
7106
7107 /* opd entries are always for functions defined in the
7108 current input bfd. If the symbol isn't defined in the
7109 input bfd, then we won't be using the function in this
7110 bfd; It must be defined in a linkonce section in another
7111 bfd, or is weak. It's also possible that we are
7112 discarding the function due to a linker script /DISCARD/,
7113 which we test for via the output_section. */
7114 if (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7115 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr)
7116 need_edit = TRUE;
7117
7118 rel += 2;
7119 if (rel + 1 == relend
7120 || (rel + 2 < relend
7121 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7122 ++rel;
7123
7124 if (rel == relend)
7125 {
7126 if (sec->size == offset + 24)
7127 {
7128 need_pad = NULL;
7129 break;
7130 }
7131 if (sec->size == offset + 16)
7132 {
7133 cnt_16b++;
7134 break;
7135 }
7136 goto broken_opd;
7137 }
7138 else if (rel + 1 < relend
7139 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[0].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
7140 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC)
7141 {
7142 if (rel[0].r_offset == offset + 16)
7143 cnt_16b++;
7144 else if (rel[0].r_offset != offset + 24)
7145 goto broken_opd;
7146 }
7147 else
7148 goto broken_opd;
7149 }
7150
7151 add_aux_fields = htab->params->non_overlapping_opd && cnt_16b > 0;
7152
7153 if (!broken && (need_edit || add_aux_fields))
7154 {
7155 Elf_Internal_Rela *write_rel;
7156 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7157 bfd_byte *rptr, *wptr;
7158 bfd_byte *new_contents;
7159 bfd_size_type amt;
7160
7161 new_contents = NULL;
7162 amt = OPD_NDX (sec->size) * sizeof (long);
7163 opd = &ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->u.opd;
7164 opd->adjust = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner, amt);
7165 if (opd->adjust == NULL)
7166 return FALSE;
7167
7168 /* This seems a waste of time as input .opd sections are all
7169 zeros as generated by gcc, but I suppose there's no reason
7170 this will always be so. We might start putting something in
7171 the third word of .opd entries. */
7172 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7173 {
7174 bfd_byte *loc;
7175 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, sec, &loc))
7176 {
7177 if (loc != NULL)
7178 free (loc);
7179 error_ret:
7180 if (local_syms != NULL
7181 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7182 free (local_syms);
7183 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7184 free (relstart);
7185 return FALSE;
7186 }
7187 sec->contents = loc;
7188 sec->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7189 }
7190
7191 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
7192
7193 new_contents = sec->contents;
7194 if (add_aux_fields)
7195 {
7196 new_contents = bfd_malloc (sec->size + cnt_16b * 8);
7197 if (new_contents == NULL)
7198 return FALSE;
7199 need_pad = NULL;
7200 }
7201 wptr = new_contents;
7202 rptr = sec->contents;
7203 write_rel = relstart;
7204 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7205 {
7206 unsigned long r_symndx;
7207 asection *sym_sec;
7208 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7209 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = NULL;
7210 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7211 long opd_ent_size;
7212 Elf_Internal_Rela *next_rel;
7213 bfd_boolean skip;
7214
7215 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7216 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7217 r_symndx, ibfd))
7218 goto error_ret;
7219
7220 next_rel = rel + 2;
7221 if (next_rel + 1 == relend
7222 || (next_rel + 2 < relend
7223 && ELF64_R_TYPE (next_rel[2].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOC))
7224 ++next_rel;
7225
7226 /* See if the .opd entry is full 24 byte or
7227 16 byte (with fd_aux entry overlapped with next
7228 fd_func). */
7229 opd_ent_size = 24;
7230 if (next_rel == relend)
7231 {
7232 if (sec->size == rel->r_offset + 16)
7233 opd_ent_size = 16;
7234 }
7235 else if (next_rel->r_offset == rel->r_offset + 16)
7236 opd_ent_size = 16;
7237
7238 if (h != NULL
7239 && h->root.root.string[0] == '.')
7240 {
7241 fdh = ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->oh;
7242 if (fdh != NULL)
7243 {
7244 fdh = ppc_follow_link (fdh);
7245 if (fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
7246 && fdh->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7247 fdh = NULL;
7248 }
7249 }
7250
7251 skip = (sym_sec->owner != ibfd
7252 || sym_sec->output_section == bfd_abs_section_ptr);
7253 if (skip)
7254 {
7255 if (fdh != NULL && sym_sec->owner == ibfd)
7256 {
7257 /* Arrange for the function descriptor sym
7258 to be dropped. */
7259 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = 0;
7260 fdh->elf.root.u.def.section = sym_sec;
7261 }
7262 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = -1;
7263
7264 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS || bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7265 rel = next_rel;
7266 else
7267 while (1)
7268 {
7269 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
7270 NULL, h, sym))
7271 goto error_ret;
7272
7273 if (++rel == next_rel)
7274 break;
7275
7276 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7277 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
7278 r_symndx, ibfd))
7279 goto error_ret;
7280 }
7281 }
7282 else
7283 {
7284 /* We'll be keeping this opd entry. */
7285 long adjust;
7286
7287 if (fdh != NULL)
7288 {
7289 /* Redefine the function descriptor symbol to
7290 this location in the opd section. It is
7291 necessary to update the value here rather
7292 than using an array of adjustments as we do
7293 for local symbols, because various places
7294 in the generic ELF code use the value
7295 stored in u.def.value. */
7296 fdh->elf.root.u.def.value = wptr - new_contents;
7297 fdh->adjust_done = 1;
7298 }
7299
7300 /* Local syms are a bit tricky. We could
7301 tweak them as they can be cached, but
7302 we'd need to look through the local syms
7303 for the function descriptor sym which we
7304 don't have at the moment. So keep an
7305 array of adjustments. */
7306 adjust = (wptr - new_contents) - (rptr - sec->contents);
7307 opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (rel->r_offset)] = adjust;
7308
7309 if (wptr != rptr)
7310 memcpy (wptr, rptr, opd_ent_size);
7311 wptr += opd_ent_size;
7312 if (add_aux_fields && opd_ent_size == 16)
7313 {
7314 memset (wptr, '\0', 8);
7315 wptr += 8;
7316 }
7317
7318 /* We need to adjust any reloc offsets to point to the
7319 new opd entries. */
7320 for ( ; rel != next_rel; ++rel)
7321 {
7322 rel->r_offset += adjust;
7323 if (write_rel != rel)
7324 memcpy (write_rel, rel, sizeof (*rel));
7325 ++write_rel;
7326 }
7327 }
7328
7329 rptr += opd_ent_size;
7330 }
7331
7332 sec->size = wptr - new_contents;
7333 sec->reloc_count = write_rel - relstart;
7334 if (add_aux_fields)
7335 {
7336 free (sec->contents);
7337 sec->contents = new_contents;
7338 }
7339
7340 /* Fudge the header size too, as this is used later in
7341 elf_bfd_final_link if we are emitting relocs. */
7342 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (sec);
7343 rel_hdr->sh_size = sec->reloc_count * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
7344 some_edited = TRUE;
7345 }
7346 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7347 free (relstart);
7348
7349 if (local_syms != NULL
7350 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7351 {
7352 if (!info->keep_memory)
7353 free (local_syms);
7354 else
7355 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7356 }
7357 }
7358
7359 if (some_edited)
7360 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_opd_syms, NULL);
7361
7362 /* If we are doing a final link and the last .opd entry is just 16 byte
7363 long, add a 8 byte padding after it. */
7364 if (need_pad != NULL && !bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7365 {
7366 bfd_byte *p;
7367
7368 if ((need_pad->flags & SEC_IN_MEMORY) == 0)
7369 {
7370 BFD_ASSERT (need_pad->size > 0);
7371
7372 p = bfd_malloc (need_pad->size + 8);
7373 if (p == NULL)
7374 return FALSE;
7375
7376 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (need_pad->owner, need_pad,
7377 p, 0, need_pad->size))
7378 return FALSE;
7379
7380 need_pad->contents = p;
7381 need_pad->flags |= (SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
7382 }
7383 else
7384 {
7385 p = bfd_realloc (need_pad->contents, need_pad->size + 8);
7386 if (p == NULL)
7387 return FALSE;
7388
7389 need_pad->contents = p;
7390 }
7391
7392 memset (need_pad->contents + need_pad->size, 0, 8);
7393 need_pad->size += 8;
7394 }
7395
7396 return TRUE;
7397 }
7398
7399 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
7400 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
7401
7402 bfd_boolean
7403 ppc64_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7404 {
7405 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7406 bfd *ibfd;
7407 asection *sec;
7408 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
7409
7410 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7411 if (htab == NULL)
7412 return FALSE;
7413
7414 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
7415 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
7416 between the call and its destination. */
7417 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
7418 {
7419 limit = -htab->params->group_size;
7420 if (limit == 1)
7421 limit = 0x1e00000;
7422 }
7423 else
7424 {
7425 limit = htab->params->group_size;
7426 if (limit == 1)
7427 limit = 0x1c00000;
7428 }
7429
7430 low_vma = -1;
7431 high_vma = 0;
7432 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7433 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
7434 {
7435 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
7436 low_vma = sec->vma;
7437 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
7438 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
7439 }
7440
7441 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
7442 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
7443 is local. */
7444 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
7445 {
7446 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
7447 return TRUE;
7448 }
7449
7450 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
7451 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
7452 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
7453 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
7454 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
7455 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
7456 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
7457 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
7458 particular R_PPC64_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
7459 call, for each of the R_PPC64_PLTSEQ and R_PPC64_PLT16* insns in
7460 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
7461 together except their symbol. */
7462
7463 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7464 {
7465 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7466 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
7467
7468 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
7469 continue;
7470
7471 local_syms = NULL;
7472 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7473
7474 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7475 if (ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_pltcall
7476 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7477 {
7478 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7479
7480 /* Read the relocations. */
7481 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7482 info->keep_memory);
7483 if (relstart == NULL)
7484 return FALSE;
7485
7486 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7487 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
7488 {
7489 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7490 unsigned long r_symndx;
7491 asection *sym_sec;
7492 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7493 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7494 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
7495
7496 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7497 if (r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
7498 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
7499 continue;
7500
7501 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7502 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
7503 r_symndx, ibfd))
7504 {
7505 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7506 free (relstart);
7507 if (local_syms != NULL
7508 && symtab_hdr->contents != (bfd_byte *) local_syms)
7509 free (local_syms);
7510 return FALSE;
7511 }
7512
7513 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7514 {
7515 bfd_vma from, to;
7516 if (h != NULL)
7517 to = h->root.u.def.value;
7518 else
7519 to = sym->st_value;
7520 to += (rel->r_addend
7521 + sym_sec->output_offset
7522 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
7523 from = (rel->r_offset
7524 + sec->output_offset
7525 + sec->output_section->vma);
7526 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit
7527 && !(r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC
7528 && (((h ? h->other : sym->st_other)
7529 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
7530 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
7531 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
7532 }
7533 }
7534 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7535 free (relstart);
7536 }
7537
7538 if (local_syms != NULL
7539 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
7540 {
7541 if (!info->keep_memory)
7542 free (local_syms);
7543 else
7544 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
7545 }
7546 }
7547
7548 return TRUE;
7549 }
7550
7551 /* Set htab->tls_get_addr and call the generic ELF tls_setup function. */
7552
7553 asection *
7554 ppc64_elf_tls_setup (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7555 {
7556 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7557
7558 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7559 if (htab == NULL)
7560 return NULL;
7561
7562 if (abiversion (info->output_bfd) == 1)
7563 htab->opd_abi = 1;
7564
7565 if (htab->params->no_multi_toc)
7566 htab->do_multi_toc = 0;
7567 else if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
7568 htab->params->no_multi_toc = 1;
7569
7570 /* Default to --no-plt-localentry, as this option can cause problems
7571 with symbol interposition. For example, glibc libpthread.so and
7572 libc.so duplicate many pthread symbols, with a fallback
7573 implementation in libc.so. In some cases the fallback does more
7574 work than the pthread implementation. __pthread_condattr_destroy
7575 is one such symbol: the libpthread.so implementation is
7576 localentry:0 while the libc.so implementation is localentry:8.
7577 An app that "cleverly" uses dlopen to only load necessary
7578 libraries at runtime may omit loading libpthread.so when not
7579 running multi-threaded, which then results in the libc.so
7580 fallback symbols being used and ld.so complaining. Now there
7581 are workarounds in ld (see non_zero_localentry) to detect the
7582 pthread situation, but that may not be the only case where
7583 --plt-localentry can cause trouble. */
7584 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0 < 0)
7585 htab->params->plt_localentry0 = 0;
7586 if (htab->params->plt_localentry0
7587 && elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "GLIBC_2.26",
7588 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE) == NULL)
7589 _bfd_error_handler
7590 (_("warning: --plt-localentry is especially dangerous without "
7591 "ld.so support to detect ABI violations"));
7592
7593 htab->tls_get_addr = ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
7594 elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr",
7595 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE));
7596 /* Move dynamic linking info to the function descriptor sym. */
7597 if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7598 func_desc_adjust (&htab->tls_get_addr->elf, info);
7599 htab->tls_get_addr_fd = ((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *)
7600 elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
7601 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE));
7602 if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
7603 {
7604 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *opt_fd, *tga, *tga_fd;
7605
7606 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, ".__tls_get_addr_opt",
7607 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7608 if (opt != NULL)
7609 func_desc_adjust (opt, info);
7610 opt_fd = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
7611 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
7612 if (opt_fd != NULL
7613 && (opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7614 || opt_fd->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
7615 {
7616 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
7617 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
7618 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
7619 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
7620 tga_fd = &htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf;
7621 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7622 && tga_fd != NULL
7623 && (tga_fd->type == STT_FUNC
7624 || tga_fd->needs_plt)
7625 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga_fd)
7626 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga_fd)))
7627 {
7628 struct plt_entry *ent;
7629
7630 for (ent = tga_fd->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
7631 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7632 break;
7633 if (ent != NULL)
7634 {
7635 tga_fd->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7636 tga_fd->root.u.i.link = &opt_fd->root;
7637 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt_fd, tga_fd);
7638 opt_fd->mark = 1;
7639 if (opt_fd->dynindx != -1)
7640 {
7641 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
7642 opt_fd->dynindx = -1;
7643 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
7644 opt_fd->dynstr_index);
7645 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt_fd))
7646 return NULL;
7647 }
7648 htab->tls_get_addr_fd
7649 = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) opt_fd;
7650 tga = &htab->tls_get_addr->elf;
7651 if (opt != NULL && tga != NULL)
7652 {
7653 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
7654 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
7655 ppc64_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
7656 opt->mark = 1;
7657 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, opt,
7658 tga->forced_local);
7659 htab->tls_get_addr = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) opt;
7660 }
7661 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->oh = htab->tls_get_addr;
7662 htab->tls_get_addr_fd->is_func_descriptor = 1;
7663 if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
7664 {
7665 htab->tls_get_addr->oh = htab->tls_get_addr_fd;
7666 htab->tls_get_addr->is_func = 1;
7667 }
7668 }
7669 }
7670 }
7671 else if (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt < 0)
7672 htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt = 0;
7673 }
7674 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (info->output_bfd, info);
7675 }
7676
7677 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
7678 HASH1 or HASH2. */
7679
7680 static bfd_boolean
7681 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
7682 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7683 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash1,
7684 const struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash2)
7685 {
7686 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
7687 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7688 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7689
7690 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7691 {
7692 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
7693 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7694
7695 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
7696 h = elf_follow_link (h);
7697 if (h == &hash1->elf || h == &hash2->elf)
7698 return TRUE;
7699 }
7700 return FALSE;
7701 }
7702
7703 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
7704 opportunities. The linker has been hacked (see ppc64elf.em) to do
7705 a preliminary section layout so that we know the TLS segment
7706 offsets. We can't optimize earlier because some optimizations need
7707 to know the tp offset, and we need to optimize before allocating
7708 dynamic relocations. */
7709
7710 bfd_boolean
7711 ppc64_elf_tls_optimize (struct bfd_link_info *info)
7712 {
7713 bfd *ibfd;
7714 asection *sec;
7715 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
7716 unsigned char *toc_ref;
7717 int pass;
7718
7719 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
7720 return TRUE;
7721
7722 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
7723 if (htab == NULL)
7724 return FALSE;
7725
7726 /* Make two passes over the relocs. On the first pass, mark toc
7727 entries involved with tls relocs, and check that tls relocs
7728 involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed followed by
7729 such a call. If they are not, we can't do any tls optimization.
7730 On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to notify
7731 relocate_section that optimization can be done, and adjust got
7732 and plt refcounts. */
7733 toc_ref = NULL;
7734 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
7735 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
7736 {
7737 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = NULL;
7738 asection *toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
7739
7740 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7741 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
7742 {
7743 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
7744 bfd_boolean found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7745
7746 /* Read the relocations. */
7747 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7748 info->keep_memory);
7749 if (relstart == NULL)
7750 {
7751 free (toc_ref);
7752 return FALSE;
7753 }
7754
7755 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
7756 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
7757 {
7758 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
7759 unsigned long r_symndx;
7760 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7761 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7762 asection *sym_sec;
7763 unsigned char *tls_mask;
7764 unsigned int tls_set, tls_clear, tls_type = 0;
7765 bfd_vma value;
7766 bfd_boolean ok_tprel, is_local;
7767 long toc_ref_index = 0;
7768 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
7769 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
7770
7771 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7772 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_mask, &locsyms,
7773 r_symndx, ibfd))
7774 {
7775 err_free_rel:
7776 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
7777 free (relstart);
7778 if (toc_ref != NULL)
7779 free (toc_ref);
7780 if (locsyms != NULL
7781 && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents
7782 != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
7783 free (locsyms);
7784 return ret;
7785 }
7786
7787 if (h != NULL)
7788 {
7789 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7790 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7791 value = h->root.u.def.value;
7792 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
7793 value = 0;
7794 else
7795 {
7796 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7797 continue;
7798 }
7799 }
7800 else
7801 /* Symbols referenced by TLS relocs must be of type
7802 STT_TLS. So no need for .opd local sym adjust. */
7803 value = sym->st_value;
7804
7805 ok_tprel = FALSE;
7806 is_local = FALSE;
7807 if (h == NULL
7808 || !h->def_dynamic)
7809 {
7810 is_local = TRUE;
7811 if (h != NULL
7812 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
7813 ok_tprel = TRUE;
7814 else if (sym_sec != NULL
7815 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
7816 {
7817 value += sym_sec->output_offset;
7818 value += sym_sec->output_section->vma;
7819 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
7820 /* Note that even though the prefix insns
7821 allow a 1<<33 offset we use the same test
7822 as for addis;addi. There may be a mix of
7823 pcrel and non-pcrel code and the decision
7824 to optimise is per symbol, not per TLS
7825 sequence. */
7826 ok_tprel = value + 0x80008000ULL < 1ULL << 32;
7827 }
7828 }
7829
7830 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7831 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
7832 without marker relocs, then check that each
7833 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
7834 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
7835 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
7836 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
7837 if (pass == 0
7838 && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
7839 && h != NULL
7840 && (h == &htab->tls_get_addr->elf
7841 || h == &htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf)
7842 && !found_tls_get_addr_arg
7843 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
7844 {
7845 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
7846 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
7847 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
7848 ret = TRUE;
7849 goto err_free_rel;
7850 }
7851
7852 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 0;
7853 switch (r_type)
7854 {
7855 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
7856 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7857 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
7858 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
7859 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7860 /* Fall through. */
7861
7862 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7863 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7864 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
7865 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
7866 that turns out to be the case. */
7867 if (!is_local)
7868 continue;
7869
7870 /* LD -> LE */
7871 tls_set = 0;
7872 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
7873 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7874 break;
7875
7876 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
7877 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7878 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
7879 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
7880 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7881 /* Fall through. */
7882
7883 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7884 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7885 if (ok_tprel)
7886 /* GD -> LE */
7887 tls_set = 0;
7888 else
7889 /* GD -> IE */
7890 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
7891 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
7892 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7893 break;
7894
7895 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
7896 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
7897 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
7898 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7899 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7900 if (ok_tprel)
7901 {
7902 /* IE -> LE */
7903 tls_set = 0;
7904 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
7905 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7906 break;
7907 }
7908 continue;
7909
7910 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
7911 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
7912 if (rel + 1 < relend
7913 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7914 {
7915 if (pass != 0
7916 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
7917 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ)
7918 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)
7919 != R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC))
7920 {
7921 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
7922 if (!get_sym_h (&h, NULL, NULL, NULL, &locsyms,
7923 r_symndx, ibfd))
7924 goto err_free_rel;
7925 if (h != NULL)
7926 {
7927 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
7928
7929 for (ent = h->plt.plist;
7930 ent != NULL;
7931 ent = ent->next)
7932 if (ent->addend == rel[1].r_addend)
7933 break;
7934
7935 if (ent != NULL
7936 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
7937 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
7938 }
7939 }
7940 continue;
7941 }
7942 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
7943 /* Fall through. */
7944
7945 case R_PPC64_TLS:
7946 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
7947 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
7948 if (sym_sec == NULL || sym_sec != toc)
7949 continue;
7950
7951 /* Mark this toc entry as referenced by a TLS
7952 code sequence. We can do that now in the
7953 case of R_PPC64_TLS, and after checking for
7954 tls_get_addr for the TOC16 relocs. */
7955 if (toc_ref == NULL)
7956 toc_ref
7957 = bfd_zmalloc (toc->output_section->rawsize / 8);
7958 if (toc_ref == NULL)
7959 goto err_free_rel;
7960
7961 if (h != NULL)
7962 value = h->root.u.def.value;
7963 else
7964 value = sym->st_value;
7965 value += rel->r_addend;
7966 if (value % 8 != 0)
7967 continue;
7968 BFD_ASSERT (value < toc->size
7969 && toc->output_offset % 8 == 0);
7970 toc_ref_index = (value + toc->output_offset) / 8;
7971 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
7972 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
7973 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD)
7974 {
7975 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
7976 continue;
7977 }
7978
7979 if (pass != 0 && toc_ref[toc_ref_index] == 0)
7980 continue;
7981
7982 tls_set = 0;
7983 tls_clear = 0;
7984 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
7985 break;
7986
7987 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
7988 if (pass == 0
7989 || sec != toc
7990 || toc_ref == NULL
7991 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
7992 continue;
7993 if (ok_tprel)
7994 {
7995 /* IE -> LE */
7996 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
7997 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
7998 break;
7999 }
8000 continue;
8001
8002 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
8003 if (pass == 0
8004 || sec != toc
8005 || toc_ref == NULL
8006 || !toc_ref[(rel->r_offset + toc->output_offset) / 8])
8007 continue;
8008 if (rel + 1 < relend
8009 && (rel[1].r_info
8010 == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64))
8011 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
8012 {
8013 if (ok_tprel)
8014 /* GD -> LE */
8015 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD;
8016 else
8017 /* GD -> IE */
8018 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD | TLS_GDIE;
8019 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
8020 }
8021 else
8022 {
8023 if (!is_local)
8024 continue;
8025
8026 /* LD -> LE */
8027 tls_set = TLS_EXPLICIT;
8028 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
8029 }
8030 break;
8031
8032 default:
8033 continue;
8034 }
8035
8036 if (pass == 0)
8037 {
8038 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
8039 || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
8040 continue;
8041
8042 if (rel + 1 < relend
8043 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
8044 htab->tls_get_addr,
8045 htab->tls_get_addr_fd))
8046 {
8047 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
8048 {
8049 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
8050 unsigned char *toc_tls;
8051 int retval;
8052
8053 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, NULL, NULL,
8054 &locsyms,
8055 rel, ibfd);
8056 if (retval == 0)
8057 goto err_free_rel;
8058 if (toc_tls != NULL)
8059 {
8060 if ((*toc_tls & TLS_TLS) != 0
8061 && ((*toc_tls & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0))
8062 found_tls_get_addr_arg = 1;
8063 if (retval > 1)
8064 toc_ref[toc_ref_index] = 1;
8065 }
8066 }
8067 continue;
8068 }
8069
8070 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
8071 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
8072 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
8073 the entire optimization. */
8074 /* xgettext:c-format */
8075 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
8076 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
8077 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
8078 ret = TRUE;
8079 goto err_free_rel;
8080 }
8081
8082 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
8083 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
8084 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
8085 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
8086 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
8087 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
8088 Disable optimization in this case. */
8089 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
8090 && (tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0
8091 && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
8092 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
8093 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
8094 continue;
8095
8096 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
8097 {
8098 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
8099
8100 if (htab->tls_get_addr != NULL)
8101 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr->elf.plt.plist;
8102 ent != NULL;
8103 ent = ent->next)
8104 if (ent->addend == 0)
8105 break;
8106
8107 if (ent == NULL && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL)
8108 for (ent = htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist;
8109 ent != NULL;
8110 ent = ent->next)
8111 if (ent->addend == 0)
8112 break;
8113
8114 if (ent != NULL
8115 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
8116 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
8117 }
8118
8119 if (tls_clear == 0)
8120 continue;
8121
8122 if ((tls_set & TLS_EXPLICIT) == 0)
8123 {
8124 struct got_entry *ent;
8125
8126 /* Adjust got entry for this reloc. */
8127 if (h != NULL)
8128 ent = h->got.glist;
8129 else
8130 ent = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd)[r_symndx];
8131
8132 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
8133 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
8134 && ent->owner == ibfd
8135 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
8136 break;
8137 if (ent == NULL)
8138 abort ();
8139
8140 if (tls_set == 0)
8141 {
8142 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
8143 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
8144 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
8145 }
8146 }
8147 else
8148 {
8149 /* If we got rid of a DTPMOD/DTPREL reloc pair then
8150 we'll lose one or two dyn relocs. */
8151 if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, sec, info,
8152 NULL, h, sym))
8153 return FALSE;
8154
8155 if (tls_set == (TLS_EXPLICIT | TLS_GD))
8156 {
8157 if (!dec_dynrel_count ((rel + 1)->r_info, sec, info,
8158 NULL, h, sym))
8159 return FALSE;
8160 }
8161 }
8162
8163 *tls_mask |= tls_set & 0xff;
8164 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
8165 }
8166
8167 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8168 free (relstart);
8169 }
8170
8171 if (locsyms != NULL
8172 && (elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents != (unsigned char *) locsyms))
8173 {
8174 if (!info->keep_memory)
8175 free (locsyms);
8176 else
8177 elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd).contents = (unsigned char *) locsyms;
8178 }
8179 }
8180
8181 if (toc_ref != NULL)
8182 free (toc_ref);
8183 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
8184 return TRUE;
8185 }
8186
8187 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_edit_toc to adjust
8188 the values of any global symbols in a toc section that has been
8189 edited. Globals in toc sections should be a rarity, so this function
8190 sets a flag if any are found in toc sections other than the one just
8191 edited, so that further hash table traversals can be avoided. */
8192
8193 struct adjust_toc_info
8194 {
8195 asection *toc;
8196 unsigned long *skip;
8197 bfd_boolean global_toc_syms;
8198 };
8199
8200 enum toc_skip_enum { ref_from_discarded = 1, can_optimize = 2 };
8201
8202 static bfd_boolean
8203 adjust_toc_syms (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8204 {
8205 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
8206 struct adjust_toc_info *toc_inf = (struct adjust_toc_info *) inf;
8207 unsigned long i;
8208
8209 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
8210 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8211 return TRUE;
8212
8213 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
8214 if (eh->adjust_done)
8215 return TRUE;
8216
8217 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.section == toc_inf->toc)
8218 {
8219 if (eh->elf.root.u.def.value > toc_inf->toc->rawsize)
8220 i = toc_inf->toc->rawsize >> 3;
8221 else
8222 i = eh->elf.root.u.def.value >> 3;
8223
8224 if ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
8225 {
8226 _bfd_error_handler
8227 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"), eh->elf.root.root.string);
8228 do
8229 ++i;
8230 while ((toc_inf->skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0);
8231 eh->elf.root.u.def.value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
8232 }
8233
8234 eh->elf.root.u.def.value -= toc_inf->skip[i];
8235 eh->adjust_done = 1;
8236 }
8237 else if (strcmp (eh->elf.root.u.def.section->name, ".toc") == 0)
8238 toc_inf->global_toc_syms = TRUE;
8239
8240 return TRUE;
8241 }
8242
8243 /* Return TRUE iff INSN with a relocation of R_TYPE is one we expect
8244 on a _LO variety toc/got reloc. */
8245
8246 static bfd_boolean
8247 ok_lo_toc_insn (unsigned int insn, enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
8248 {
8249 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */
8250 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
8251 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
8252 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
8253 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
8254 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
8255 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
8256 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
8257 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
8258 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
8259 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
8260 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
8261 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
8262 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
8263 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
8264 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq,lfq */
8265 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lxsd,lxssp,lfdp */
8266 /* Exclude lfqu by testing reloc. If relocs are ever
8267 defined for the reduced D field in psq_lu then those
8268 will need testing too. */
8269 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8270 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,lwa */
8271 && (insn & 1) == 0)
8272 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 60u << 26 /* stfq */
8273 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* lxv,stx{v,sd,ssp},stfdp */
8274 /* Exclude stfqu. psq_stu as above for psq_lu. */
8275 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC16_LO && r_type != R_PPC64_GOT16_LO)
8276 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stq */
8277 && (insn & 1) == 0));
8278 }
8279
8280 /* PCREL_OPT in one instance flags to the linker that a pair of insns:
8281 pld ra,symbol@got@pcrel
8282 load/store rt,off(ra)
8283 or
8284 pla ra,symbol@pcrel
8285 load/store rt,off(ra)
8286 may be translated to
8287 pload/pstore rt,symbol+off@pcrel
8288 nop.
8289 This function returns true if the optimization is possible, placing
8290 the prefix insn in *PINSN1, a NOP in *PINSN2 and the offset in *POFF.
8291
8292 On entry to this function, the linker has already determined that
8293 the pld can be replaced with pla: *PINSN1 is that pla insn,
8294 while *PINSN2 is the second instruction. */
8295
8296 static bfd_boolean
8297 xlate_pcrel_opt (uint64_t *pinsn1, uint64_t *pinsn2, bfd_signed_vma *poff)
8298 {
8299 uint64_t insn1 = *pinsn1;
8300 uint64_t insn2 = *pinsn2;
8301 bfd_signed_vma off;
8302
8303 if ((insn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
8304 {
8305 /* Check that regs match. */
8306 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8307 return FALSE;
8308
8309 /* P8LS or PMLS form, non-pcrel. */
8310 if ((insn2 & (-1ULL << 50) & ~(1ULL << 56)) != (1ULL << 58))
8311 return FALSE;
8312
8313 *pinsn1 = (insn2 & ~(31 << 16) & ~0x3ffff0000ffffULL) | (1ULL << 52);
8314 *pinsn2 = PNOP;
8315 off = ((insn2 >> 16) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) | (insn2 & 0xffff);
8316 *poff = (off ^ 0x200000000ULL) - 0x200000000ULL;
8317 return TRUE;
8318 }
8319
8320 insn2 >>= 32;
8321
8322 /* Check that regs match. */
8323 if (((insn2 >> 16) & 31) != ((insn1 >> 21) & 31))
8324 return FALSE;
8325
8326 switch ((insn2 >> 26) & 63)
8327 {
8328 default:
8329 return FALSE;
8330
8331 case 32: /* lwz */
8332 case 34: /* lbz */
8333 case 36: /* stw */
8334 case 38: /* stb */
8335 case 40: /* lhz */
8336 case 42: /* lha */
8337 case 44: /* sth */
8338 case 48: /* lfs */
8339 case 50: /* lfd */
8340 case 52: /* stfs */
8341 case 54: /* stfd */
8342 /* These are the PMLS cases, where we just need to tack a prefix
8343 on the insn. */
8344 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
8345 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8346 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8347 break;
8348
8349 case 58: /* lwa, ld */
8350 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8351 return FALSE;
8352 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8353 | (insn2 & 2 ? 41ULL << 26 : 57ULL << 26)
8354 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8355 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8356 break;
8357
8358 case 57: /* lxsd, lxssp */
8359 if ((insn2 & 3) < 2)
8360 return FALSE;
8361 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8362 | ((40ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8363 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8364 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8365 break;
8366
8367 case 61: /* stxsd, stxssp, lxv, stxv */
8368 if ((insn2 & 3) == 0)
8369 return FALSE;
8370 else if ((insn2 & 3) >= 2)
8371 {
8372 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8373 | ((44ULL | (insn2 & 3)) << 26)
8374 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8375 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8376 }
8377 else
8378 {
8379 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8380 | ((50ULL | (insn2 & 4) | ((insn2 & 8) >> 3)) << 26)
8381 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8382 off = insn2 & 0xfff0;
8383 }
8384 break;
8385
8386 case 56: /* lq */
8387 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8388 | (insn2 & ((63ULL << 26) | (31ULL << 21))));
8389 off = insn2 & 0xffff;
8390 break;
8391
8392 case 62: /* std, stq */
8393 if ((insn2 & 1) != 0)
8394 return FALSE;
8395 insn1 = ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52)
8396 | ((insn2 & 2) == 0 ? 61ULL << 26 : 60ULL << 26)
8397 | (insn2 & (31ULL << 21)));
8398 off = insn2 & 0xfffc;
8399 break;
8400 }
8401
8402 *pinsn1 = insn1;
8403 *pinsn2 = (uint64_t) NOP << 32;
8404 *poff = (off ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8405 return TRUE;
8406 }
8407
8408 /* Examine all relocs referencing .toc sections in order to remove
8409 unused .toc entries. */
8410
8411 bfd_boolean
8412 ppc64_elf_edit_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
8413 {
8414 bfd *ibfd;
8415 struct adjust_toc_info toc_inf;
8416 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
8417
8418 htab->do_toc_opt = 1;
8419 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = TRUE;
8420 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
8421 {
8422 asection *toc, *sec;
8423 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8424 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
8425 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *toc_relocs;
8426 unsigned long *skip, *drop;
8427 unsigned char *used;
8428 unsigned char *keep, last, some_unused;
8429
8430 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
8431 continue;
8432
8433 toc = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".toc");
8434 if (toc == NULL
8435 || toc->size == 0
8436 || toc->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_JUST_SYMS
8437 || discarded_section (toc))
8438 continue;
8439
8440 toc_relocs = NULL;
8441 local_syms = NULL;
8442 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
8443
8444 /* Look at sections dropped from the final link. */
8445 skip = NULL;
8446 relstart = NULL;
8447 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8448 {
8449 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8450 || !discarded_section (sec)
8451 || get_opd_info (sec)
8452 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8453 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8454 continue;
8455
8456 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
8457 if (relstart == NULL)
8458 goto error_ret;
8459
8460 /* Run through the relocs to see which toc entries might be
8461 unused. */
8462 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8463 {
8464 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8465 unsigned long r_symndx;
8466 asection *sym_sec;
8467 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8468 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8469 bfd_vma val;
8470
8471 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8472 switch (r_type)
8473 {
8474 default:
8475 continue;
8476
8477 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8478 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8479 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8480 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8481 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8482 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8483 break;
8484 }
8485
8486 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8487 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8488 r_symndx, ibfd))
8489 goto error_ret;
8490
8491 if (sym_sec != toc)
8492 continue;
8493
8494 if (h != NULL)
8495 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8496 else
8497 val = sym->st_value;
8498 val += rel->r_addend;
8499
8500 if (val >= toc->size)
8501 continue;
8502
8503 /* Anything in the toc ought to be aligned to 8 bytes.
8504 If not, don't mark as unused. */
8505 if (val & 7)
8506 continue;
8507
8508 if (skip == NULL)
8509 {
8510 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8511 if (skip == NULL)
8512 goto error_ret;
8513 }
8514
8515 skip[val >> 3] = ref_from_discarded;
8516 }
8517
8518 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8519 free (relstart);
8520 }
8521
8522 /* For largetoc loads of address constants, we can convert
8523 . addis rx,2,addr@got@ha
8524 . ld ry,addr@got@l(rx)
8525 to
8526 . addis rx,2,addr@toc@ha
8527 . addi ry,rx,addr@toc@l
8528 when addr is within 2G of the toc pointer. This then means
8529 that the word storing "addr" in the toc is no longer needed. */
8530
8531 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_small_toc_reloc
8532 && toc->output_section->rawsize < (bfd_vma) 1 << 31
8533 && toc->reloc_count != 0)
8534 {
8535 /* Read toc relocs. */
8536 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8537 info->keep_memory);
8538 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8539 goto error_ret;
8540
8541 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8542 {
8543 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8544 unsigned long r_symndx;
8545 asection *sym_sec;
8546 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8547 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8548 bfd_vma val, addr;
8549
8550 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8551 if (r_type != R_PPC64_ADDR64)
8552 continue;
8553
8554 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8555 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8556 r_symndx, ibfd))
8557 goto error_ret;
8558
8559 if (sym_sec == NULL
8560 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
8561 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
8562 continue;
8563
8564 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8565 continue;
8566
8567 if (h != NULL)
8568 {
8569 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8570 continue;
8571 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8572 }
8573 else
8574 {
8575 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
8576 continue;
8577 val = sym->st_value;
8578 }
8579 val += rel->r_addend;
8580 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
8581
8582 /* We don't yet know the exact toc pointer value, but we
8583 know it will be somewhere in the toc section. Don't
8584 optimize if the difference from any possible toc
8585 pointer is outside [ff..f80008000, 7fff7fff]. */
8586 addr = toc->output_section->vma + TOC_BASE_OFF;
8587 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8588 continue;
8589
8590 addr = toc->output_section->vma + toc->output_section->rawsize;
8591 if (val - addr + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000 >= (bfd_vma) 1 << 32)
8592 continue;
8593
8594 if (skip == NULL)
8595 {
8596 skip = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*skip) * (toc->size + 15) / 8);
8597 if (skip == NULL)
8598 goto error_ret;
8599 }
8600
8601 skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8602 |= can_optimize | ((rel - toc_relocs) << 2);
8603 }
8604 }
8605
8606 if (skip == NULL)
8607 continue;
8608
8609 used = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (*used) * (toc->size + 7) / 8);
8610 if (used == NULL)
8611 {
8612 error_ret:
8613 if (local_syms != NULL
8614 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8615 free (local_syms);
8616 if (sec != NULL
8617 && relstart != NULL
8618 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8619 free (relstart);
8620 if (toc_relocs != NULL
8621 && elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8622 free (toc_relocs);
8623 if (skip != NULL)
8624 free (skip);
8625 return FALSE;
8626 }
8627
8628 /* Now check all kept sections that might reference the toc.
8629 Check the toc itself last. */
8630 for (sec = (ibfd->sections == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8631 : ibfd->sections);
8632 sec != NULL;
8633 sec = (sec == toc ? NULL
8634 : sec->next == NULL ? toc
8635 : sec->next == toc && toc->next ? toc->next
8636 : sec->next))
8637 {
8638 int repeat;
8639
8640 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8641 || discarded_section (sec)
8642 || get_opd_info (sec)
8643 || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8644 || (sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
8645 continue;
8646
8647 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8648 info->keep_memory);
8649 if (relstart == NULL)
8650 {
8651 free (used);
8652 goto error_ret;
8653 }
8654
8655 /* Mark toc entries referenced as used. */
8656 do
8657 {
8658 repeat = 0;
8659 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8660 {
8661 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8662 unsigned long r_symndx;
8663 asection *sym_sec;
8664 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8665 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8666 bfd_vma val;
8667
8668 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8669 switch (r_type)
8670 {
8671 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8672 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8673 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8674 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8675 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8676 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8677 /* In case we're taking addresses of toc entries. */
8678 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
8679 break;
8680
8681 default:
8682 continue;
8683 }
8684
8685 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8686 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8687 r_symndx, ibfd))
8688 {
8689 free (used);
8690 goto error_ret;
8691 }
8692
8693 if (sym_sec != toc)
8694 continue;
8695
8696 if (h != NULL)
8697 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8698 else
8699 val = sym->st_value;
8700 val += rel->r_addend;
8701
8702 if (val >= toc->size)
8703 continue;
8704
8705 if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
8706 {
8707 bfd_vma off;
8708 unsigned char opc;
8709
8710 switch (r_type)
8711 {
8712 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8713 break;
8714
8715 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8716 off = rel->r_offset;
8717 off += (bfd_big_endian (ibfd) ? -2 : 3);
8718 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, &opc,
8719 off, 1))
8720 {
8721 free (used);
8722 goto error_ret;
8723 }
8724 if ((opc & (0x3f << 2)) == (58u << 2))
8725 break;
8726 /* Fall through. */
8727
8728 default:
8729 /* Wrong sort of reloc, or not a ld. We may
8730 as well clear ref_from_discarded too. */
8731 skip[val >> 3] = 0;
8732 }
8733 }
8734
8735 if (sec != toc)
8736 used[val >> 3] = 1;
8737 /* For the toc section, we only mark as used if this
8738 entry itself isn't unused. */
8739 else if ((used[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8740 || !(skip[rel->r_offset >> 3] & ref_from_discarded))
8741 && !used[val >> 3])
8742 {
8743 /* Do all the relocs again, to catch reference
8744 chains. */
8745 repeat = 1;
8746 used[val >> 3] = 1;
8747 }
8748 }
8749 }
8750 while (repeat);
8751
8752 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8753 free (relstart);
8754 }
8755
8756 /* Merge the used and skip arrays. Assume that TOC
8757 doublewords not appearing as either used or unused belong
8758 to an entry more than one doubleword in size. */
8759 for (drop = skip, keep = used, last = 0, some_unused = 0;
8760 drop < skip + (toc->size + 7) / 8;
8761 ++drop, ++keep)
8762 {
8763 if (*keep)
8764 {
8765 *drop &= ~ref_from_discarded;
8766 if ((*drop & can_optimize) != 0)
8767 some_unused = 1;
8768 last = 0;
8769 }
8770 else if ((*drop & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
8771 {
8772 some_unused = 1;
8773 last = ref_from_discarded;
8774 }
8775 else
8776 *drop = last;
8777 }
8778
8779 free (used);
8780
8781 if (some_unused)
8782 {
8783 bfd_byte *contents, *src;
8784 unsigned long off;
8785 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8786 bfd_boolean local_toc_syms = FALSE;
8787
8788 /* Shuffle the toc contents, and at the same time convert the
8789 skip array from booleans into offsets. */
8790 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (ibfd, toc, &contents))
8791 goto error_ret;
8792
8793 elf_section_data (toc)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
8794
8795 for (src = contents, off = 0, drop = skip;
8796 src < contents + toc->size;
8797 src += 8, ++drop)
8798 {
8799 if ((*drop & (can_optimize | ref_from_discarded)) != 0)
8800 off += 8;
8801 else if (off != 0)
8802 {
8803 *drop = off;
8804 memcpy (src - off, src, 8);
8805 }
8806 }
8807 *drop = off;
8808 toc->rawsize = toc->size;
8809 toc->size = src - contents - off;
8810
8811 /* Adjust addends for relocs against the toc section sym,
8812 and optimize any accesses we can. */
8813 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
8814 {
8815 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
8816 || discarded_section (sec))
8817 continue;
8818
8819 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
8820 info->keep_memory);
8821 if (relstart == NULL)
8822 goto error_ret;
8823
8824 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
8825 {
8826 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
8827 unsigned long r_symndx;
8828 asection *sym_sec;
8829 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8830 bfd_vma val;
8831
8832 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
8833 switch (r_type)
8834 {
8835 default:
8836 continue;
8837
8838 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
8839 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
8840 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
8841 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8842 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
8843 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8844 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
8845 break;
8846 }
8847
8848 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
8849 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
8850 r_symndx, ibfd))
8851 goto error_ret;
8852
8853 if (sym_sec != toc)
8854 continue;
8855
8856 if (h != NULL)
8857 val = h->root.u.def.value;
8858 else
8859 {
8860 val = sym->st_value;
8861 if (val != 0)
8862 local_toc_syms = TRUE;
8863 }
8864
8865 val += rel->r_addend;
8866
8867 if (val > toc->rawsize)
8868 val = toc->rawsize;
8869 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & ref_from_discarded) != 0)
8870 continue;
8871 else if ((skip[val >> 3] & can_optimize) != 0)
8872 {
8873 Elf_Internal_Rela *tocrel
8874 = toc_relocs + (skip[val >> 3] >> 2);
8875 unsigned long tsym = ELF64_R_SYM (tocrel->r_info);
8876
8877 switch (r_type)
8878 {
8879 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
8880 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
8881 break;
8882
8883 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
8884 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (tsym, R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT);
8885 break;
8886
8887 default:
8888 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
8889 ppc_howto_init ();
8890 info->callbacks->einfo
8891 /* xgettext:c-format */
8892 (_("%H: %s references "
8893 "optimized away TOC entry\n"),
8894 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset,
8895 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
8896 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8897 goto error_ret;
8898 }
8899 rel->r_addend = tocrel->r_addend;
8900 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
8901 continue;
8902 }
8903
8904 if (h != NULL || sym->st_value != 0)
8905 continue;
8906
8907 rel->r_addend -= skip[val >> 3];
8908 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = relstart;
8909 }
8910
8911 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
8912 free (relstart);
8913 }
8914
8915 /* We shouldn't have local or global symbols defined in the TOC,
8916 but handle them anyway. */
8917 if (local_syms != NULL)
8918 for (sym = local_syms;
8919 sym < local_syms + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8920 ++sym)
8921 if (sym->st_value != 0
8922 && bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx) == toc)
8923 {
8924 unsigned long i;
8925
8926 if (sym->st_value > toc->rawsize)
8927 i = toc->rawsize >> 3;
8928 else
8929 i = sym->st_value >> 3;
8930
8931 if ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) != 0)
8932 {
8933 if (local_toc_syms)
8934 _bfd_error_handler
8935 (_("%s defined on removed toc entry"),
8936 bfd_elf_sym_name (ibfd, symtab_hdr, sym, NULL));
8937 do
8938 ++i;
8939 while ((skip[i] & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)));
8940 sym->st_value = (bfd_vma) i << 3;
8941 }
8942
8943 sym->st_value -= skip[i];
8944 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
8945 }
8946
8947 /* Adjust any global syms defined in this toc input section. */
8948 if (toc_inf.global_toc_syms)
8949 {
8950 toc_inf.toc = toc;
8951 toc_inf.skip = skip;
8952 toc_inf.global_toc_syms = FALSE;
8953 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), adjust_toc_syms,
8954 &toc_inf);
8955 }
8956
8957 if (toc->reloc_count != 0)
8958 {
8959 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
8960 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
8961 bfd_size_type sz;
8962
8963 /* Remove unused toc relocs, and adjust those we keep. */
8964 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8965 toc_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, toc, NULL, NULL,
8966 info->keep_memory);
8967 if (toc_relocs == NULL)
8968 goto error_ret;
8969
8970 wrel = toc_relocs;
8971 for (rel = toc_relocs; rel < toc_relocs + toc->reloc_count; ++rel)
8972 if ((skip[rel->r_offset >> 3]
8973 & (ref_from_discarded | can_optimize)) == 0)
8974 {
8975 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset - skip[rel->r_offset >> 3];
8976 wrel->r_info = rel->r_info;
8977 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8978 ++wrel;
8979 }
8980 else if (!dec_dynrel_count (rel->r_info, toc, info,
8981 &local_syms, NULL, NULL))
8982 goto error_ret;
8983
8984 elf_section_data (toc)->relocs = toc_relocs;
8985 toc->reloc_count = wrel - toc_relocs;
8986 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (toc);
8987 sz = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
8988 rel_hdr->sh_size = toc->reloc_count * sz;
8989 }
8990 }
8991 else if (toc_relocs != NULL
8992 && elf_section_data (toc)->relocs != toc_relocs)
8993 free (toc_relocs);
8994
8995 if (local_syms != NULL
8996 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
8997 {
8998 if (!info->keep_memory)
8999 free (local_syms);
9000 else
9001 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9002 }
9003 free (skip);
9004 }
9005
9006 /* Look for cases where we can change an indirect GOT access to
9007 a GOT relative or PC relative access, possibly reducing the
9008 number of GOT entries. */
9009 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9010 {
9011 asection *sec;
9012 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9013 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
9014 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
9015 bfd_vma got;
9016
9017 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9018 continue;
9019
9020 if (!ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_optrel)
9021 continue;
9022
9023 sec = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9024 got = 0;
9025 if (sec != NULL)
9026 got = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
9027
9028 local_syms = NULL;
9029 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9030
9031 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9032 {
9033 if (sec->reloc_count == 0
9034 || !ppc64_elf_section_data (sec)->has_optrel
9035 || discarded_section (sec))
9036 continue;
9037
9038 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
9039 info->keep_memory);
9040 if (relstart == NULL)
9041 {
9042 got_error_ret:
9043 if (local_syms != NULL
9044 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9045 free (local_syms);
9046 if (sec != NULL
9047 && relstart != NULL
9048 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9049 free (relstart);
9050 return FALSE;
9051 }
9052
9053 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + sec->reloc_count; ++rel)
9054 {
9055 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
9056 unsigned long r_symndx;
9057 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9058 asection *sym_sec;
9059 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9060 struct got_entry *ent;
9061 bfd_vma val, pc;
9062 unsigned char buf[8];
9063 unsigned int insn;
9064 enum {no_check, check_lo, check_ha} insn_check;
9065
9066 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9067 switch (r_type)
9068 {
9069 default:
9070 insn_check = no_check;
9071 break;
9072
9073 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
9074 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
9075 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
9076 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
9077 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
9078 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9079 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
9080 insn_check = check_ha;
9081 break;
9082
9083 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
9084 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
9085 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
9086 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
9087 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
9088 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
9089 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
9090 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9091 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
9092 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
9093 insn_check = check_lo;
9094 break;
9095 }
9096
9097 if (insn_check != no_check)
9098 {
9099 bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
9100
9101 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf, off, 4))
9102 goto got_error_ret;
9103
9104 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9105 if (insn_check == check_lo
9106 ? !ok_lo_toc_insn (insn, r_type)
9107 : ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9108 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9109 {
9110 char str[12];
9111
9112 ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->unexpected_toc_insn = 1;
9113 sprintf (str, "%#08x", insn);
9114 info->callbacks->einfo
9115 /* xgettext:c-format */
9116 (_("%H: got/toc optimization is not supported for"
9117 " %s instruction\n"),
9118 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset & ~3, str);
9119 continue;
9120 }
9121 }
9122
9123 switch (r_type)
9124 {
9125 /* Note that we don't delete GOT entries for
9126 R_PPC64_GOT16_DS since we'd need a lot more
9127 analysis. For starters, the preliminary layout is
9128 before the GOT, PLT, dynamic sections and stubs are
9129 laid out. Then we'd need to allow for changes in
9130 distance between sections caused by alignment. */
9131 default:
9132 continue;
9133
9134 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9135 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9136 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9137 break;
9138 }
9139
9140 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9141 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9142 r_symndx, ibfd))
9143 goto got_error_ret;
9144
9145 if (sym_sec == NULL
9146 || sym_sec->output_section == NULL
9147 || discarded_section (sym_sec))
9148 continue;
9149
9150 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
9151 continue;
9152
9153 if (h != NULL)
9154 val = h->root.u.def.value;
9155 else
9156 val = sym->st_value;
9157 val += rel->r_addend;
9158 val += sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset;
9159
9160 /* Fudge factor to allow for the fact that the preliminary layout
9161 isn't exact. Reduce limits by this factor. */
9162 #define LIMIT_ADJUST(LIMIT) ((LIMIT) - (LIMIT) / 16)
9163
9164 switch (r_type)
9165 {
9166 default:
9167 continue;
9168
9169 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
9170 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9171 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9172 continue;
9173
9174 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9175 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9176 goto got_error_ret;
9177 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9178 if (((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
9179 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */))
9180 continue;
9181 break;
9182
9183 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
9184 if (val - got + LIMIT_ADJUST (0x80008000ULL)
9185 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (0x100000000ULL))
9186 continue;
9187 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9188 rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
9189 goto got_error_ret;
9190 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9191 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26 | 0x3)) != 58u << 26 /* ld */)
9192 continue;
9193 break;
9194
9195 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
9196 pc = rel->r_offset;
9197 pc += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
9198 if (val - pc + LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 33)
9199 >= LIMIT_ADJUST (1ULL << 34))
9200 continue;
9201 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
9202 rel->r_offset & ~3, 8))
9203 goto got_error_ret;
9204 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
9205 if ((insn & (-1u << 18)) != ((1u << 26) | (1u << 20)))
9206 continue;
9207 insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf + 4);
9208 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 57u << 26)
9209 continue;
9210 break;
9211 }
9212 #undef LIMIT_ADJUST
9213
9214 if (h != NULL)
9215 ent = h->got.glist;
9216 else
9217 {
9218 struct got_entry **local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9219 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
9220 }
9221 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9222 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
9223 && ent->owner == ibfd
9224 && ent->tls_type == 0)
9225 break;
9226 BFD_ASSERT (ent && ent->got.refcount > 0);
9227 ent->got.refcount -= 1;
9228 }
9229
9230 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
9231 free (relstart);
9232 }
9233
9234 if (local_syms != NULL
9235 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9236 {
9237 if (!info->keep_memory)
9238 free (local_syms);
9239 else
9240 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9241 }
9242 }
9243
9244 return TRUE;
9245 }
9246
9247 /* Return true iff input section I references the TOC using
9248 instructions limited to +/-32k offsets. */
9249
9250 bfd_boolean
9251 ppc64_elf_has_small_toc_reloc (asection *i)
9252 {
9253 return (is_ppc64_elf (i->owner)
9254 && ppc64_elf_tdata (i->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc);
9255 }
9256
9257 /* Allocate space for one GOT entry. */
9258
9259 static void
9260 allocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9261 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9262 struct got_entry *gent)
9263 {
9264 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9265 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
9266 int entsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)
9267 ? 16 : 8);
9268 int rentsize = (gent->tls_type & eh->tls_mask & TLS_GD
9269 ? 2 : 1) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9270 asection *got = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->got;
9271
9272 gent->got.offset = got->size;
9273 got->size += entsize;
9274
9275 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9276 {
9277 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rentsize;
9278 htab->got_reli_size += rentsize;
9279 }
9280 else if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
9281 && !((gent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9282 && bfd_link_executable (info)
9283 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9284 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9285 && h->dynindx != -1
9286 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
9287 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9288 {
9289 asection *relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (gent->owner)->relgot;
9290 relgot->size += rentsize;
9291 }
9292 }
9293
9294 /* This function merges got entries in the same toc group. */
9295
9296 static void
9297 merge_got_entries (struct got_entry **pent)
9298 {
9299 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
9300
9301 for (ent = *pent; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9302 if (!ent->is_indirect)
9303 for (ent2 = ent->next; ent2 != NULL; ent2 = ent2->next)
9304 if (!ent2->is_indirect
9305 && ent2->addend == ent->addend
9306 && ent2->tls_type == ent->tls_type
9307 && elf_gp (ent2->owner) == elf_gp (ent->owner))
9308 {
9309 ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
9310 ent2->got.ent = ent;
9311 }
9312 }
9313
9314 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
9315
9316 static bfd_boolean
9317 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9318 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9319 {
9320 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
9321
9322 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
9323 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
9324 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
9325 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9326 && h->dynindx == -1
9327 && !h->forced_local
9328 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
9329 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
9330 return TRUE;
9331 }
9332
9333 /* Allocate space in .plt, .got and associated reloc sections for
9334 dynamic relocs. */
9335
9336 static bfd_boolean
9337 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9338 {
9339 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9340 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9341 asection *s;
9342 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
9343 struct got_entry **pgent, *gent;
9344
9345 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9346 return TRUE;
9347
9348 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9349 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9350 if (htab == NULL)
9351 return FALSE;
9352
9353 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
9354 /* Run through the TLS GD got entries first if we're changing them
9355 to TPREL. */
9356 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE))
9357 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9358 if (gent->got.refcount > 0
9359 && (gent->tls_type & TLS_GD) != 0)
9360 {
9361 /* This was a GD entry that has been converted to TPREL. If
9362 there happens to be a TPREL entry we can use that one. */
9363 struct got_entry *ent;
9364 for (ent = h->got.glist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9365 if (ent->got.refcount > 0
9366 && (ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9367 && ent->addend == gent->addend
9368 && ent->owner == gent->owner)
9369 {
9370 gent->got.refcount = 0;
9371 break;
9372 }
9373
9374 /* If not, then we'll be using our own TPREL entry. */
9375 if (gent->got.refcount != 0)
9376 gent->tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
9377 }
9378
9379 /* Remove any list entry that won't generate a word in the GOT before
9380 we call merge_got_entries. Otherwise we risk merging to empty
9381 entries. */
9382 pgent = &h->got.glist;
9383 while ((gent = *pgent) != NULL)
9384 if (gent->got.refcount > 0)
9385 {
9386 if ((gent->tls_type & TLS_LD) != 0
9387 && !h->def_dynamic)
9388 {
9389 ppc64_tlsld_got (gent->owner)->got.refcount += 1;
9390 *pgent = gent->next;
9391 }
9392 else
9393 pgent = &gent->next;
9394 }
9395 else
9396 *pgent = gent->next;
9397
9398 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
9399 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
9400
9401 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
9402 if (!gent->is_indirect)
9403 {
9404 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol should
9405 be made dynamic. */
9406 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9407 return FALSE;
9408
9409 if (!is_ppc64_elf (gent->owner))
9410 abort ();
9411
9412 allocate_got (h, info, gent);
9413 }
9414
9415 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
9416 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
9417 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9418 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9419 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9420
9421 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
9422 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
9423 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
9424 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9425
9426 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
9427 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
9428 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9429 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9430
9431 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9432 {
9433 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p, **pp;
9434
9435 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
9436 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to
9437 be defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case,
9438 discard space for relocs that have become local due to symbol
9439 visibility changes. */
9440 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9441 {
9442 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call
9443 insn, or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that
9444 can be generated via assembly. We want calls to
9445 protected symbols to resolve directly to the function
9446 rather than going via the plt. If people want function
9447 pointer comparisons to work as expected then they should
9448 avoid writing weird assembly. */
9449 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
9450 {
9451 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
9452 {
9453 p->count -= p->pc_count;
9454 p->pc_count = 0;
9455 if (p->count == 0)
9456 *pp = p->next;
9457 else
9458 pp = &p->next;
9459 }
9460 }
9461
9462 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
9463 {
9464 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9465 should be made dynamic. */
9466 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9467 return FALSE;
9468 }
9469 }
9470
9471 /* For a fixed position executable, discard space for
9472 relocs against symbols which are not dynamic. */
9473 else if (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9474 {
9475 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
9476 && !h->def_regular
9477 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
9478 {
9479 /* Ensure we catch all the cases where this symbol
9480 should be made dynamic. */
9481 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
9482 return FALSE;
9483
9484 /* But if that didn't work out, discard dynamic relocs. */
9485 if (h->dynindx == -1)
9486 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9487 }
9488 else
9489 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
9490 }
9491
9492 /* Finally, allocate space. */
9493 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9494 {
9495 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9496 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9497 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
9498 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9499 }
9500 }
9501
9502 /* We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
9503 a) is dynamic, or
9504 b) is an ifunc, or
9505 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
9506 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
9507 if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
9508 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
9509 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
9510 || (h->needs_plt
9511 && h->def_regular
9512 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9513 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
9514 && (((struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask
9515 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
9516 {
9517 struct plt_entry *pent;
9518 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
9519 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9520 if (pent->plt.refcount > 0)
9521 {
9522 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9523 || h->dynindx == -1)
9524 {
9525 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9526 {
9527 s = htab->elf.iplt;
9528 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9529 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9530 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
9531 }
9532 else
9533 {
9534 s = htab->pltlocal;
9535 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9536 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9537 s = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9538 }
9539 }
9540 else
9541 {
9542 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room for the special
9543 first entry. */
9544 s = htab->elf.splt;
9545 if (s->size == 0)
9546 s->size += PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9547
9548 pent->plt.offset = s->size;
9549
9550 /* Make room for this entry. */
9551 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9552
9553 /* Make room for the .glink code. */
9554 s = htab->glink;
9555 if (s->size == 0)
9556 s->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab);
9557 if (htab->opd_abi)
9558 {
9559 /* We need bigger stubs past index 32767. */
9560 if (s->size >= GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + 32768*2*4)
9561 s->size += 4;
9562 s->size += 2*4;
9563 }
9564 else
9565 s->size += 4;
9566
9567 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9568 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9569 }
9570 if (s != NULL)
9571 s->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9572 doneone = TRUE;
9573 }
9574 else
9575 pent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9576 if (!doneone)
9577 {
9578 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9579 h->needs_plt = 0;
9580 }
9581 }
9582 else
9583 {
9584 h->plt.plist = NULL;
9585 h->needs_plt = 0;
9586 }
9587
9588 return TRUE;
9589 }
9590
9591 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
9592 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
9593 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
9594 #define D34(v) \
9595 ((((v) & 0x3ffff0000ULL) << 16) | (v & 0xffff))
9596 #define HA34(v) ((v + (1ULL << 33)) >> 34)
9597
9598 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections
9599 to set up space for global entry stubs. These are put in glink,
9600 after the branch table. */
9601
9602 static bfd_boolean
9603 size_global_entry_stubs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9604 {
9605 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9606 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9607 struct plt_entry *pent;
9608 asection *s, *plt;
9609
9610 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9611 return TRUE;
9612
9613 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9614 return TRUE;
9615
9616 if (h->def_regular)
9617 return TRUE;
9618
9619 info = inf;
9620 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9621 if (htab == NULL)
9622 return FALSE;
9623
9624 s = htab->global_entry;
9625 plt = htab->elf.splt;
9626 for (pent = h->plt.plist; pent != NULL; pent = pent->next)
9627 if (pent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
9628 && pent->addend == 0)
9629 {
9630 /* For ELFv2, if this symbol is not defined in a regular file
9631 and we are not generating a shared library or pie, then we
9632 need to define the symbol in the executable on a call stub.
9633 This is to avoid text relocations. */
9634 bfd_vma off, stub_align, stub_off, stub_size;
9635 unsigned int align_power;
9636
9637 stub_size = 16;
9638 stub_off = s->size;
9639 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
9640 align_power = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9641 else
9642 align_power = -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
9643 /* Setting section alignment is delayed until we know it is
9644 non-empty. Otherwise the .text output section will be
9645 aligned at least to plt_stub_align even when no global
9646 entry stubs are needed. */
9647 if (s->alignment_power < align_power)
9648 s->alignment_power = align_power;
9649 stub_align = (bfd_vma) 1 << align_power;
9650 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0
9651 || ((((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)
9652 - (stub_off & -stub_align))
9653 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align)))
9654 stub_off = (stub_off + stub_align - 1) & -stub_align;
9655 off = pent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
9656 off -= stub_off + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
9657 /* Note that for --plt-stub-align negative we have a possible
9658 dependency between stub offset and size. Break that
9659 dependency by assuming the max stub size when calculating
9660 the stub offset. */
9661 if (PPC_HA (off) == 0)
9662 stub_size -= 4;
9663 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
9664 h->root.u.def.section = s;
9665 h->root.u.def.value = stub_off;
9666 s->size = stub_off + stub_size;
9667 break;
9668 }
9669 return TRUE;
9670 }
9671
9672 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
9673 read-only sections. */
9674
9675 static bfd_boolean
9676 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9677 {
9678 asection *sec;
9679
9680 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9681 return TRUE;
9682
9683 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
9684 if (sec != NULL)
9685 {
9686 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9687
9688 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9689 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT'"
9690 " in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
9691 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
9692
9693 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
9694 return FALSE;
9695 }
9696 return TRUE;
9697 }
9698
9699 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
9700
9701 static bfd_boolean
9702 ppc64_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9703 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9704 {
9705 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
9706 bfd *dynobj;
9707 asection *s;
9708 bfd_boolean relocs;
9709 bfd *ibfd;
9710 struct got_entry *first_tlsld;
9711
9712 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
9713 if (htab == NULL)
9714 return FALSE;
9715
9716 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9717 if (dynobj == NULL)
9718 abort ();
9719
9720 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9721 {
9722 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
9723 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
9724 {
9725 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9726 if (s == NULL)
9727 abort ();
9728 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9729 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
9730 }
9731 }
9732
9733 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
9734 relocs. */
9735 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9736 {
9737 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
9738 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
9739 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
9740 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
9741 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
9742 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9743 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9744
9745 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9746 continue;
9747
9748 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9749 {
9750 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
9751
9752 for (p = elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9753 {
9754 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
9755 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
9756 {
9757 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
9758 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
9759 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
9760 the relocs too. */
9761 }
9762 else if (p->count != 0)
9763 {
9764 asection *srel = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
9765 if (p->ifunc)
9766 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
9767 srel->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9768 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
9769 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9770 }
9771 }
9772 }
9773
9774 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
9775 if (!lgot_ents)
9776 continue;
9777
9778 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9779 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9780 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
9781 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
9782 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9783 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
9784 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9785 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
9786 {
9787 struct got_entry **pent, *ent;
9788
9789 pent = lgot_ents;
9790 while ((ent = *pent) != NULL)
9791 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
9792 {
9793 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_LD) != 0)
9794 {
9795 ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd)->got.refcount += 1;
9796 *pent = ent->next;
9797 }
9798 else
9799 {
9800 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
9801 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9802
9803 ent->got.offset = s->size;
9804 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
9805 {
9806 ent_size *= 2;
9807 rel_size *= 2;
9808 }
9809 s->size += ent_size;
9810 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
9811 {
9812 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
9813 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
9814 }
9815 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
9816 && !((ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
9817 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
9818 {
9819 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
9820 srel->size += rel_size;
9821 }
9822 pent = &ent->next;
9823 }
9824 }
9825 else
9826 *pent = ent->next;
9827 }
9828
9829 /* Allocate space for plt calls to local syms. */
9830 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
9831 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
9832 {
9833 struct plt_entry *ent;
9834
9835 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9836 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
9837 {
9838 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
9839 {
9840 s = htab->elf.iplt;
9841 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
9842 s->size += PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9843 htab->elf.irelplt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9844 }
9845 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
9846 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
9847 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9848 else
9849 {
9850 s = htab->pltlocal;
9851 ent->plt.offset = s->size;
9852 s->size += LOCAL_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
9853 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9854 htab->relpltlocal->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9855 }
9856 }
9857 else
9858 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9859 }
9860 }
9861
9862 /* Allocate global sym .plt and .got entries, and space for global
9863 sym dynamic relocs. */
9864 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
9865
9866 if (!htab->opd_abi && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9867 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, size_global_entry_stubs, info);
9868
9869 first_tlsld = NULL;
9870 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9871 {
9872 struct got_entry *ent;
9873
9874 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9875 continue;
9876
9877 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
9878 if (ent->got.refcount > 0)
9879 {
9880 if (!htab->do_multi_toc && first_tlsld != NULL)
9881 {
9882 ent->is_indirect = TRUE;
9883 ent->got.ent = first_tlsld;
9884 }
9885 else
9886 {
9887 if (first_tlsld == NULL)
9888 first_tlsld = ent;
9889 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9890 ent->got.offset = s->size;
9891 ent->owner = ibfd;
9892 s->size += 16;
9893 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9894 {
9895 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
9896 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
9897 }
9898 }
9899 }
9900 else
9901 ent->got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
9902 }
9903
9904 /* We now have determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
9905 Allocate memory for them. */
9906 relocs = FALSE;
9907 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9908 {
9909 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
9910 continue;
9911
9912 if (s == htab->brlt || s == htab->relbrlt)
9913 /* These haven't been allocated yet; don't strip. */
9914 continue;
9915 else if (s == htab->elf.sgot
9916 || s == htab->elf.splt
9917 || s == htab->elf.iplt
9918 || s == htab->pltlocal
9919 || s == htab->glink
9920 || s == htab->global_entry
9921 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
9922 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9923 {
9924 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
9925 comment below. */
9926 }
9927 else if (s == htab->glink_eh_frame)
9928 {
9929 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
9930 /* Not sized yet. */
9931 continue;
9932 }
9933 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".rela"))
9934 {
9935 if (s->size != 0)
9936 {
9937 if (s != htab->elf.srelplt)
9938 relocs = TRUE;
9939
9940 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
9941 to copy relocs into the output file. */
9942 s->reloc_count = 0;
9943 }
9944 }
9945 else
9946 {
9947 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
9948 continue;
9949 }
9950
9951 if (s->size == 0)
9952 {
9953 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
9954 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
9955 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
9956 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
9957 before the linker maps input sections to output
9958 sections. The linker does that before
9959 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
9960 function which decides whether anything needs to go
9961 into these sections. */
9962 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9963 continue;
9964 }
9965
9966 if (bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section))
9967 _bfd_error_handler (_("warning: discarding dynamic section %s"),
9968 s->name);
9969
9970 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
9971 continue;
9972
9973 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. We use bfd_zalloc
9974 here in case unused entries are not reclaimed before the
9975 section's contents are written out. This should not happen,
9976 but this way if it does we get a R_PPC64_NONE reloc in .rela
9977 sections instead of garbage.
9978 We also rely on the section contents being zero when writing
9979 the GOT and .dynrelro. */
9980 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
9981 if (s->contents == NULL)
9982 return FALSE;
9983 }
9984
9985 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9986 {
9987 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
9988 continue;
9989
9990 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
9991 if (s != NULL && s != htab->elf.sgot)
9992 {
9993 if (s->size == 0)
9994 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
9995 else
9996 {
9997 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
9998 if (s->contents == NULL)
9999 return FALSE;
10000 }
10001 }
10002 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
10003 if (s != NULL)
10004 {
10005 if (s->size == 0)
10006 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10007 else
10008 {
10009 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (ibfd, s->size);
10010 if (s->contents == NULL)
10011 return FALSE;
10012 relocs = TRUE;
10013 s->reloc_count = 0;
10014 }
10015 }
10016 }
10017
10018 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10019 {
10020 bfd_boolean tls_opt;
10021
10022 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
10023 values later, in ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
10024 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
10025 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
10026 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
10027 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
10028 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
10029
10030 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
10031 {
10032 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
10033 return FALSE;
10034 }
10035
10036 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
10037 {
10038 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
10039 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
10040 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
10041 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0)
10042 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_GLINK, 0))
10043 return FALSE;
10044 }
10045
10046 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && abiversion (output_bfd) <= 1)
10047 {
10048 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPD, 0)
10049 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPDSZ, 0))
10050 return FALSE;
10051 }
10052
10053 tls_opt = (htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
10054 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd != NULL
10055 && htab->tls_get_addr_fd->elf.plt.plist != NULL);
10056 if (tls_opt || !htab->opd_abi)
10057 {
10058 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC64_OPT, tls_opt ? PPC64_OPT_TLS : 0))
10059 return FALSE;
10060 }
10061
10062 if (relocs)
10063 {
10064 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
10065 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
10066 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)))
10067 return FALSE;
10068
10069 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section,
10070 then we need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
10071 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
10072 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, maybe_set_textrel, info);
10073
10074 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
10075 {
10076 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
10077 return FALSE;
10078 }
10079 }
10080 }
10081 #undef add_dynamic_entry
10082
10083 return TRUE;
10084 }
10085
10086 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
10087
10088 static bfd_boolean
10089 ppc64_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
10090 {
10091 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
10092 && !h->def_regular
10093 && !h->pointer_equality_needed)
10094 return FALSE;
10095
10096 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
10097 }
10098
10099 /* Determine the type of stub needed, if any, for a call. */
10100
10101 static inline enum ppc_stub_type
10102 ppc_type_of_stub (asection *input_sec,
10103 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10104 struct ppc_link_hash_entry **hash,
10105 struct plt_entry **plt_ent,
10106 bfd_vma destination,
10107 unsigned long local_off)
10108 {
10109 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h = *hash;
10110 bfd_vma location;
10111 bfd_vma branch_offset;
10112 bfd_vma max_branch_offset;
10113 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
10114
10115 if (h != NULL)
10116 {
10117 struct plt_entry *ent;
10118 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh = h;
10119 if (h->oh != NULL
10120 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
10121 {
10122 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
10123 *hash = fdh;
10124 }
10125
10126 for (ent = fdh->elf.plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10127 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10128 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10129 {
10130 *plt_ent = ent;
10131 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10132 }
10133
10134 /* Here, we know we don't have a plt entry. If we don't have a
10135 either a defined function descriptor or a defined entry symbol
10136 in a regular object file, then it is pointless trying to make
10137 any other type of stub. */
10138 if (!is_static_defined (&fdh->elf)
10139 && !is_static_defined (&h->elf))
10140 return ppc_stub_none;
10141 }
10142 else if (elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) != NULL)
10143 {
10144 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_sec->owner);
10145 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
10146 elf_local_got_ents (input_sec->owner) + symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10147 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10148
10149 if (local_plt[r_symndx] != NULL)
10150 {
10151 struct plt_entry *ent;
10152
10153 for (ent = local_plt[r_symndx]; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
10154 if (ent->addend == rel->r_addend
10155 && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
10156 {
10157 *plt_ent = ent;
10158 return ppc_stub_plt_call;
10159 }
10160 }
10161 }
10162
10163 /* Determine where the call point is. */
10164 location = (input_sec->output_offset
10165 + input_sec->output_section->vma
10166 + rel->r_offset);
10167
10168 branch_offset = destination - location;
10169 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10170
10171 /* Determine if a long branch stub is needed. */
10172 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
10173 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL14
10174 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
10175 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
10176 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
10177
10178 if (branch_offset + max_branch_offset >= 2 * max_branch_offset - local_off)
10179 /* We need a stub. Figure out whether a long_branch or plt_branch
10180 is needed later. */
10181 return ppc_stub_long_branch;
10182
10183 return ppc_stub_none;
10184 }
10185
10186 /* Gets the address of a label (1:) in r11 and builds an offset in r12,
10187 then adds it to r11 (LOAD false) or loads r12 from r11+r12 (LOAD true).
10188 . mflr %r12
10189 . bcl 20,31,1f
10190 .1: mflr %r11
10191 . mtlr %r12
10192 . lis %r12,xxx-1b@highest
10193 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@higher
10194 . sldi %r12,%r12,32
10195 . oris %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@high
10196 . ori %r12,%r12,xxx-1b@l
10197 . add/ldx %r12,%r11,%r12 */
10198
10199 static bfd_byte *
10200 build_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, bfd_boolean load)
10201 {
10202 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R12, p);
10203 p += 4;
10204 bfd_put_32 (abfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10205 p += 4;
10206 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MFLR_R11, p);
10207 p += 4;
10208 bfd_put_32 (abfd, MTLR_R12, p);
10209 p += 4;
10210 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10211 {
10212 if (load)
10213 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10214 else
10215 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R11 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10216 p += 4;
10217 }
10218 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10219 {
10220 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDIS_R12_R11 + PPC_HA (off), p);
10221 p += 4;
10222 if (load)
10223 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LD_R12_0R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10224 else
10225 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADDI_R12_R12 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10226 p += 4;
10227 }
10228 else
10229 {
10230 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10231 {
10232 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10233 p += 4;
10234 }
10235 else
10236 {
10237 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R12 + ((off >> 48) & 0xffff), p);
10238 p += 4;
10239 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10240 {
10241 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + ((off >> 32) & 0xffff), p);
10242 p += 4;
10243 }
10244 }
10245 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10246 {
10247 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R12_R12_32, p);
10248 p += 4;
10249 }
10250 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10251 {
10252 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORIS_R12_R12_0 + PPC_HI (off), p);
10253 p += 4;
10254 }
10255 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10256 {
10257 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R12_R12_0 + PPC_LO (off), p);
10258 p += 4;
10259 }
10260 if (load)
10261 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10262 else
10263 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10264 p += 4;
10265 }
10266 return p;
10267 }
10268
10269 static unsigned int
10270 size_offset (bfd_vma off)
10271 {
10272 unsigned int size;
10273 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10274 size = 4;
10275 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10276 size = 8;
10277 else
10278 {
10279 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10280 size = 4;
10281 else
10282 {
10283 size = 4;
10284 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10285 size += 4;
10286 }
10287 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10288 size += 4;
10289 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10290 size += 4;
10291 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10292 size += 4;
10293 size += 4;
10294 }
10295 return size + 16;
10296 }
10297
10298 static unsigned int
10299 num_relocs_for_offset (bfd_vma off)
10300 {
10301 unsigned int num_rel;
10302 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10303 num_rel = 1;
10304 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10305 num_rel = 2;
10306 else
10307 {
10308 num_rel = 1;
10309 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL >= 0x1000000000000ULL
10310 && ((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10311 num_rel += 1;
10312 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10313 num_rel += 1;
10314 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10315 num_rel += 1;
10316 }
10317 return num_rel;
10318 }
10319
10320 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10321 emit_relocs_for_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info, Elf_Internal_Rela *r,
10322 bfd_vma roff, bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off)
10323 {
10324 bfd_vma relative_targ = targ - (roff - 8);
10325 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
10326 roff += 2;
10327 r->r_offset = roff;
10328 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10329 if (off + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
10330 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16);
10331 else if (off + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL)
10332 {
10333 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HA);
10334 ++r;
10335 roff += 4;
10336 r->r_offset = roff;
10337 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10338 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10339 }
10340 else
10341 {
10342 if (off + 0x800000000000ULL < 0x1000000000000ULL)
10343 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10344 else
10345 {
10346 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST);
10347 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffff) != 0)
10348 {
10349 ++r;
10350 roff += 4;
10351 r->r_offset = roff;
10352 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER);
10353 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10354 }
10355 }
10356 if (((off >> 32) & 0xffffffffULL) != 0)
10357 roff += 4;
10358 if (PPC_HI (off) != 0)
10359 {
10360 ++r;
10361 roff += 4;
10362 r->r_offset = roff;
10363 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH);
10364 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10365 }
10366 if (PPC_LO (off) != 0)
10367 {
10368 ++r;
10369 roff += 4;
10370 r->r_offset = roff;
10371 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_LO);
10372 r->r_addend = relative_targ + roff;
10373 }
10374 }
10375 return r;
10376 }
10377
10378 static bfd_byte *
10379 build_powerxx_offset (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma off, int odd,
10380 bfd_boolean load)
10381 {
10382 uint64_t insn;
10383 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10384 {
10385 off -= odd;
10386 if (odd)
10387 {
10388 bfd_put_32 (abfd, NOP, p);
10389 p += 4;
10390 }
10391 if (load)
10392 insn = PLD_R12_PC;
10393 else
10394 insn = PADDI_R12_PC;
10395 insn |= D34 (off);
10396 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10397 p += 4;
10398 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10399 }
10400 /* The minimum value for paddi is -0x200000000. The minimum value
10401 for li is -0x8000, which when shifted by 34 and added gives a
10402 minimum value of -0x2000200000000. The maximum value is
10403 0x1ffffffff+0x7fff<<34 which is 0x2000200000000-1. */
10404 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10405 {
10406 off -= 8 - odd;
10407 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LI_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10408 p += 4;
10409 if (!odd)
10410 {
10411 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10412 p += 4;
10413 }
10414 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10415 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10416 p += 4;
10417 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10418 p += 4;
10419 if (odd)
10420 {
10421 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10422 p += 4;
10423 }
10424 if (load)
10425 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10426 else
10427 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10428 }
10429 else
10430 {
10431 off -= odd + 8;
10432 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LIS_R11 | ((HA34 (off) >> 16) & 0x3fff), p);
10433 p += 4;
10434 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ORI_R11_R11_0 | (HA34 (off) & 0xffff), p);
10435 p += 4;
10436 if (odd)
10437 {
10438 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10439 p += 4;
10440 }
10441 insn = PADDI_R12_PC | D34 (off);
10442 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn >> 32, p);
10443 p += 4;
10444 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, p);
10445 p += 4;
10446 if (!odd)
10447 {
10448 bfd_put_32 (abfd, SLDI_R11_R11_34, p);
10449 p += 4;
10450 }
10451 if (load)
10452 bfd_put_32 (abfd, LDX_R12_R11_R12, p);
10453 else
10454 bfd_put_32 (abfd, ADD_R12_R11_R12, p);
10455 }
10456 p += 4;
10457 return p;
10458 }
10459
10460 static unsigned int
10461 size_powerxx_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10462 {
10463 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10464 return odd + 8;
10465 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10466 return 20;
10467 else
10468 return 24;
10469 }
10470
10471 static unsigned int
10472 num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (bfd_vma off, int odd)
10473 {
10474 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10475 return 1;
10476 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10477 return 2;
10478 else
10479 return 3;
10480 }
10481
10482 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10483 emit_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10484 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, bfd_vma roff,
10485 bfd_vma targ, bfd_vma off, int odd)
10486 {
10487 if (off - odd + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34)
10488 roff += odd;
10489 else if (off - (8 - odd) + (0x20002ULL << 32) < 0x40004ULL << 32)
10490 {
10491 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10492 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10493 r->r_addend = targ + 8 - odd - d_offset;
10494 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10495 ++r;
10496 roff += 8 - odd;
10497 }
10498 else
10499 {
10500 int d_offset = bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd) ? 2 : 0;
10501 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10502 r->r_addend = targ + 8 + odd - d_offset;
10503 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34);
10504 ++r;
10505 roff += 4;
10506 r->r_offset = roff + d_offset;
10507 r->r_addend = targ + 4 + odd - d_offset;
10508 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34);
10509 ++r;
10510 roff += 4 + odd;
10511 }
10512 r->r_offset = roff;
10513 r->r_addend = targ;
10514 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL34);
10515 return r;
10516 }
10517
10518 /* Emit .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10519
10520 static bfd_byte *
10521 eh_advance (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *eh, unsigned int delta)
10522 {
10523 delta /= 4;
10524 if (delta < 64)
10525 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + delta;
10526 else if (delta < 256)
10527 {
10528 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
10529 *eh++ = delta;
10530 }
10531 else if (delta < 65536)
10532 {
10533 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
10534 bfd_put_16 (abfd, delta, eh);
10535 eh += 2;
10536 }
10537 else
10538 {
10539 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
10540 bfd_put_32 (abfd, delta, eh);
10541 eh += 4;
10542 }
10543 return eh;
10544 }
10545
10546 /* Size of required .eh_frame opcode to advance pc by DELTA. */
10547
10548 static unsigned int
10549 eh_advance_size (unsigned int delta)
10550 {
10551 if (delta < 64 * 4)
10552 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc+[1..63]. */
10553 return 1;
10554 if (delta < 256 * 4)
10555 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc1, byte. */
10556 return 2;
10557 if (delta < 65536 * 4)
10558 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc2, 2 bytes. */
10559 return 3;
10560 /* DW_CFA_advance_loc4, 4 bytes. */
10561 return 5;
10562 }
10563
10564 /* With power7 weakly ordered memory model, it is possible for ld.so
10565 to update a plt entry in one thread and have another thread see a
10566 stale zero toc entry. To avoid this we need some sort of acquire
10567 barrier in the call stub. One solution is to make the load of the
10568 toc word seem to appear to depend on the load of the function entry
10569 word. Another solution is to test for r2 being zero, and branch to
10570 the appropriate glink entry if so.
10571
10572 . fake dep barrier compare
10573 . ld 12,xxx(2) ld 12,xxx(2)
10574 . mtctr 12 mtctr 12
10575 . xor 11,12,12 ld 2,xxx+8(2)
10576 . add 2,2,11 cmpldi 2,0
10577 . ld 2,xxx+8(2) bnectr+
10578 . bctr b <glink_entry>
10579
10580 The solution involving the compare turns out to be faster, so
10581 that's what we use unless the branch won't reach. */
10582
10583 #define ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP 0
10584 #define ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE 0
10585
10586 static inline unsigned int
10587 plt_stub_size (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10588 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10589 bfd_vma off)
10590 {
10591 unsigned size;
10592
10593 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10594 {
10595 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
10596 {
10597 bfd_vma start = (stub_entry->stub_offset
10598 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10599 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10600 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10601 start += 4;
10602 size = 8 + size_powerxx_offset (off, start & 4);
10603 }
10604 else
10605 size = 8 + size_offset (off - 8);
10606 if (stub_entry->stub_type > ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
10607 size += 4;
10608 return size;
10609 }
10610
10611 size = 12;
10612 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10613 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10614 size += 4;
10615 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
10616 size += 4;
10617 if (htab->opd_abi)
10618 {
10619 size += 4;
10620 if (htab->params->plt_static_chain)
10621 size += 4;
10622 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10623 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10624 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10625 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1)
10626 size += 8;
10627 if (PPC_HA (off + 8 + 8 * htab->params->plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (off))
10628 size += 4;
10629 }
10630 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
10631 && (stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
10632 || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
10633 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
10634 {
10635 size += 7 * 4;
10636 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10637 size += 6 * 4;
10638 }
10639 return size;
10640 }
10641
10642 /* Depending on the sign of plt_stub_align:
10643 If positive, return the padding to align to a 2**plt_stub_align
10644 boundary.
10645 If negative, if this stub would cross fewer 2**plt_stub_align
10646 boundaries if we align, then return the padding needed to do so. */
10647
10648 static inline unsigned int
10649 plt_stub_pad (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10650 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10651 bfd_vma plt_off)
10652 {
10653 int stub_align;
10654 unsigned stub_size;
10655 bfd_vma stub_off = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
10656
10657 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align >= 0)
10658 {
10659 stub_align = 1 << htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10660 if ((stub_off & (stub_align - 1)) != 0)
10661 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10662 return 0;
10663 }
10664
10665 stub_align = 1 << -htab->params->plt_stub_align;
10666 stub_size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, plt_off);
10667 if (((stub_off + stub_size - 1) & -stub_align) - (stub_off & -stub_align)
10668 > ((stub_size - 1) & -stub_align))
10669 return stub_align - (stub_off & (stub_align - 1));
10670 return 0;
10671 }
10672
10673 /* Build a .plt call stub. */
10674
10675 static inline bfd_byte *
10676 build_plt_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10677 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10678 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
10679 {
10680 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
10681 bfd_boolean plt_load_toc = htab->opd_abi;
10682 bfd_boolean plt_static_chain = htab->params->plt_static_chain;
10683 bfd_boolean plt_thread_safe = (htab->params->plt_thread_safe
10684 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
10685 && stub_entry->h != NULL
10686 && stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx != -1);
10687 bfd_boolean use_fake_dep = plt_thread_safe;
10688 bfd_vma cmp_branch_off = 0;
10689
10690 if (!ALWAYS_USE_FAKE_DEP
10691 && plt_load_toc
10692 && plt_thread_safe
10693 && !((stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
10694 || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
10695 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt))
10696 {
10697 bfd_vma pltoff = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
10698 bfd_vma pltindex = ((pltoff - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
10699 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab));
10700 bfd_vma glinkoff = GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) + pltindex * 8;
10701 bfd_vma to, from;
10702
10703 if (pltindex > 32768)
10704 glinkoff += (pltindex - 32768) * 4;
10705 to = (glinkoff
10706 + htab->glink->output_offset
10707 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
10708 from = (p - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents
10709 + 4 * (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10710 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10711 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
10712 + 4 * (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain)
10713 != PPC_HA (offset))
10714 + 4 * (plt_static_chain != 0)
10715 + 20
10716 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
10717 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
10718 cmp_branch_off = to - from;
10719 use_fake_dep = cmp_branch_off + (1 << 25) >= (1 << 26);
10720 }
10721
10722 if (PPC_HA (offset) != 0)
10723 {
10724 if (r != NULL)
10725 {
10726 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10727 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10728 r[0].r_offset += 4;
10729 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
10730 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
10731 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10732 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10733 if (plt_load_toc)
10734 {
10735 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10736 {
10737 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
10738 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO);
10739 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10740 }
10741 else
10742 {
10743 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
10744 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10745 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
10746 if (plt_static_chain)
10747 {
10748 r[3].r_offset = r[2].r_offset + 4;
10749 r[3].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
10750 r[3].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 16;
10751 }
10752 }
10753 }
10754 }
10755 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10756 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10757 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
10758 if (plt_load_toc)
10759 {
10760 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R11_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
10761 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10762 }
10763 else
10764 {
10765 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (offset), p), p += 4;
10766 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10767 }
10768 if (plt_load_toc
10769 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10770 {
10771 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R11_R11 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10772 offset = 0;
10773 }
10774 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
10775 if (plt_load_toc)
10776 {
10777 if (use_fake_dep)
10778 {
10779 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R2_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
10780 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R11_R11_R2, p), p += 4;
10781 }
10782 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
10783 if (plt_static_chain)
10784 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R11 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
10785 }
10786 }
10787 else
10788 {
10789 if (r != NULL)
10790 {
10791 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10792 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10793 r[0].r_offset += 4;
10794 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
10795 if (plt_load_toc)
10796 {
10797 if (PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10798 {
10799 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
10800 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16);
10801 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
10802 }
10803 else
10804 {
10805 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 8 + 8 * use_fake_dep;
10806 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
10807 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain;
10808 if (plt_static_chain)
10809 {
10810 r[2].r_offset = r[1].r_offset + 4;
10811 r[2].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
10812 r[2].r_addend = r[0].r_addend + 8;
10813 }
10814 }
10815 }
10816 }
10817 if (ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE
10818 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10819 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
10820 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10821 if (plt_load_toc
10822 && PPC_HA (offset + 8 + 8 * plt_static_chain) != PPC_HA (offset))
10823 {
10824 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (offset), p), p += 4;
10825 offset = 0;
10826 }
10827 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTCTR_R12, p), p += 4;
10828 if (plt_load_toc)
10829 {
10830 if (use_fake_dep)
10831 {
10832 bfd_put_32 (obfd, XOR_R11_R12_R12, p), p += 4;
10833 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R2_R2_R11, p), p += 4;
10834 }
10835 if (plt_static_chain)
10836 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 16), p), p += 4;
10837 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R2 | PPC_LO (offset + 8), p), p += 4;
10838 }
10839 }
10840 if (plt_load_toc && plt_thread_safe && !use_fake_dep)
10841 {
10842 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPLDI_R2_0, p), p += 4;
10843 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BNECTR_P4, p), p += 4;
10844 bfd_put_32 (obfd, B_DOT | (cmp_branch_off & 0x3fffffc), p), p += 4;
10845 }
10846 else
10847 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTR, p), p += 4;
10848 return p;
10849 }
10850
10851 /* Build a special .plt call stub for __tls_get_addr. */
10852
10853 #define LD_R11_0R3 0xe9630000
10854 #define LD_R12_0R3 0xe9830000
10855 #define MR_R0_R3 0x7c601b78
10856 #define CMPDI_R11_0 0x2c2b0000
10857 #define ADD_R3_R12_R13 0x7c6c6a14
10858 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
10859 #define MR_R3_R0 0x7c030378
10860 #define STD_R11_0R1 0xf9610000
10861 #define BCTRL 0x4e800421
10862 #define LD_R11_0R1 0xe9610000
10863 #define MTLR_R11 0x7d6803a6
10864
10865 static inline bfd_byte *
10866 build_tls_get_addr_stub (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10867 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10868 bfd_byte *p, bfd_vma offset, Elf_Internal_Rela *r)
10869 {
10870 bfd *obfd = htab->params->stub_bfd;
10871 bfd_byte *loc = p;
10872
10873 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R3 + 0, p), p += 4;
10874 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R12_0R3 + 8, p), p += 4;
10875 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R0_R3, p), p += 4;
10876 bfd_put_32 (obfd, CMPDI_R11_0, p), p += 4;
10877 bfd_put_32 (obfd, ADD_R3_R12_R13, p), p += 4;
10878 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BEQLR, p), p += 4;
10879 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MR_R3_R0, p), p += 4;
10880 if (r != NULL)
10881 r[0].r_offset += 7 * 4;
10882 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
10883 return build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
10884
10885 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MFLR_R11, p), p += 4;
10886 bfd_put_32 (obfd, STD_R11_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p), p += 4;
10887
10888 if (r != NULL)
10889 r[0].r_offset += 2 * 4;
10890 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, p, offset, r);
10891 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BCTRL, p - 4);
10892
10893 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p), p += 4;
10894 bfd_put_32 (obfd, LD_R11_0R1 + STK_LINKER (htab), p), p += 4;
10895 bfd_put_32 (obfd, MTLR_R11, p), p += 4;
10896 bfd_put_32 (obfd, BLR, p), p += 4;
10897
10898 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10899 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
10900 {
10901 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
10902 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
10903
10904 base = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17;
10905 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
10906 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - 20 - loc);
10907 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
10908 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 16;
10909 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
10910 *eh++ = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
10911 *eh++ = 65;
10912 *eh++ = -(STK_LINKER (htab) / 8) & 0x7f;
10913 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
10914 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
10915 *eh++ = 65;
10916 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
10917 }
10918 return p;
10919 }
10920
10921 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
10922 get_relocs (asection *sec, int count)
10923 {
10924 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;
10925 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elfsec_data;
10926
10927 elfsec_data = elf_section_data (sec);
10928 relocs = elfsec_data->relocs;
10929 if (relocs == NULL)
10930 {
10931 bfd_size_type relsize;
10932 relsize = sec->reloc_count * sizeof (*relocs);
10933 relocs = bfd_alloc (sec->owner, relsize);
10934 if (relocs == NULL)
10935 return NULL;
10936 elfsec_data->relocs = relocs;
10937 elfsec_data->rela.hdr = bfd_zalloc (sec->owner,
10938 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
10939 if (elfsec_data->rela.hdr == NULL)
10940 return NULL;
10941 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_size = (sec->reloc_count
10942 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
10943 elfsec_data->rela.hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
10944 sec->reloc_count = 0;
10945 }
10946 relocs += sec->reloc_count;
10947 sec->reloc_count += count;
10948 return relocs;
10949 }
10950
10951 /* Convert the relocs R[0] thru R[-NUM_REL+1], which are all no-symbol
10952 forms, to the equivalent relocs against the global symbol given by
10953 STUB_ENTRY->H. */
10954
10955 static bfd_boolean
10956 use_global_in_relocs (struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab,
10957 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry,
10958 Elf_Internal_Rela *r, unsigned int num_rel)
10959 {
10960 struct elf_link_hash_entry **hashes;
10961 unsigned long symndx;
10962 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
10963 bfd_vma symval;
10964
10965 /* Relocs are always against symbols in their own object file. Fake
10966 up global sym hashes for the stub bfd (which has no symbols). */
10967 hashes = elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd);
10968 if (hashes == NULL)
10969 {
10970 bfd_size_type hsize;
10971
10972 /* When called the first time, stub_globals will contain the
10973 total number of symbols seen during stub sizing. After
10974 allocating, stub_globals is used as an index to fill the
10975 hashes array. */
10976 hsize = (htab->stub_globals + 1) * sizeof (*hashes);
10977 hashes = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd, hsize);
10978 if (hashes == NULL)
10979 return FALSE;
10980 elf_sym_hashes (htab->params->stub_bfd) = hashes;
10981 htab->stub_globals = 1;
10982 }
10983 symndx = htab->stub_globals++;
10984 h = stub_entry->h;
10985 hashes[symndx] = &h->elf;
10986 if (h->oh != NULL && h->oh->is_func)
10987 h = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
10988 BFD_ASSERT (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10989 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
10990 symval = (h->elf.root.u.def.value
10991 + h->elf.root.u.def.section->output_offset
10992 + h->elf.root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
10993 while (num_rel-- != 0)
10994 {
10995 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (symndx, ELF64_R_TYPE (r->r_info));
10996 if (h->elf.root.u.def.section != stub_entry->target_section)
10997 {
10998 /* H is an opd symbol. The addend must be zero, and the
10999 branch reloc is the only one we can convert. */
11000 r->r_addend = 0;
11001 break;
11002 }
11003 else
11004 r->r_addend -= symval;
11005 --r;
11006 }
11007 return TRUE;
11008 }
11009
11010 static bfd_vma
11011 get_r2off (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11012 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry)
11013 {
11014 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11015 bfd_vma r2off = htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off;
11016
11017 if (r2off == 0)
11018 {
11019 /* Support linking -R objects. Get the toc pointer from the
11020 opd entry. */
11021 char buf[8];
11022 if (!htab->opd_abi)
11023 return r2off;
11024 asection *opd = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section;
11025 bfd_vma opd_off = stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.value;
11026
11027 if (strcmp (opd->name, ".opd") != 0
11028 || opd->reloc_count != 0)
11029 {
11030 info->callbacks->einfo
11031 (_("%P: cannot find opd entry toc for `%pT'\n"),
11032 stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string);
11033 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11034 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11035 }
11036 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (opd->owner, opd, buf, opd_off + 8, 8))
11037 return (bfd_vma) -1;
11038 r2off = bfd_get_64 (opd->owner, buf);
11039 r2off -= elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
11040 }
11041 r2off -= htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off;
11042 return r2off;
11043 }
11044
11045 static bfd_boolean
11046 ppc_build_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11047 {
11048 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11049 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11050 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11051 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11052 bfd_byte *loc;
11053 bfd_byte *p, *relp;
11054 bfd_vma targ, off;
11055 Elf_Internal_Rela *r;
11056 asection *plt;
11057 int num_rel;
11058 int odd;
11059
11060 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11061 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11062 info = in_arg;
11063
11064 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11065 if (htab == NULL)
11066 return FALSE;
11067
11068 BFD_ASSERT (stub_entry->stub_offset >= stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size);
11069 loc = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents + stub_entry->stub_offset;
11070
11071 htab->stub_count[stub_entry->stub_type - 1] += 1;
11072 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11073 {
11074 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11075 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11076 /* Branches are relative. This is where we are going to. */
11077 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11078 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11079 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11080 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11081
11082 /* And this is where we are coming from. */
11083 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11084 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11085 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11086 off = targ - off;
11087
11088 p = loc;
11089 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11090 {
11091 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11092
11093 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11094 {
11095 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11096 return FALSE;
11097 }
11098 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11099 p += 4;
11100 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11101 {
11102 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11103 ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11104 p += 4;
11105 }
11106 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11107 {
11108 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11109 ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11110 p += 4;
11111 }
11112 off -= p - loc;
11113 }
11114 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, B_DOT | (off & 0x3fffffc), p);
11115 p += 4;
11116
11117 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11118 {
11119 _bfd_error_handler
11120 (_("long branch stub `%s' offset overflow"),
11121 stub_entry->root.string);
11122 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11123 return FALSE;
11124 }
11125
11126 if (info->emitrelocations)
11127 {
11128 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1);
11129 if (r == NULL)
11130 return FALSE;
11131 r->r_offset = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11132 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11133 r->r_addend = targ;
11134 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11135 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, 1))
11136 return FALSE;
11137 }
11138 break;
11139
11140 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11141 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11142 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11143 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11144 FALSE, FALSE);
11145 if (br_entry == NULL)
11146 {
11147 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't find branch stub `%s'"),
11148 stub_entry->root.string);
11149 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11150 return FALSE;
11151 }
11152
11153 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11154 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11155 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11156 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11157 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11158
11159 bfd_put_64 (htab->brlt->owner, targ,
11160 htab->brlt->contents + br_entry->offset);
11161
11162 if (br_entry->iter == htab->stub_iteration)
11163 {
11164 br_entry->iter = 0;
11165
11166 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11167 {
11168 /* Create a reloc for the branch lookup table entry. */
11169 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
11170 bfd_byte *rl;
11171
11172 rela.r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11173 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11174 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11175 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11176 rela.r_addend = targ;
11177
11178 rl = htab->relbrlt->contents;
11179 rl += (htab->relbrlt->reloc_count++
11180 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
11181 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (htab->relbrlt->owner, &rela, rl);
11182 }
11183 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11184 {
11185 r = get_relocs (htab->brlt, 1);
11186 if (r == NULL)
11187 return FALSE;
11188 /* brlt, being SEC_LINKER_CREATED does not go through the
11189 normal reloc processing. Symbols and offsets are not
11190 translated from input file to output file form, so
11191 set up the offset per the output file. */
11192 r->r_offset = (br_entry->offset
11193 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11194 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11195 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
11196 r->r_addend = targ;
11197 }
11198 }
11199
11200 targ = (br_entry->offset
11201 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11202 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11203
11204 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11205 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11206 off = targ - off;
11207
11208 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11209 {
11210 info->callbacks->einfo
11211 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11212 stub_entry->root.string);
11213 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11214 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11215 return FALSE;
11216 }
11217
11218 if (info->emitrelocations)
11219 {
11220 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0));
11221 if (r == NULL)
11222 return FALSE;
11223 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11224 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11225 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11226 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11227 r[0].r_offset += 4;
11228 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_DS);
11229 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11230 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11231 {
11232 r[0].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_HA);
11233 r[1].r_offset = r[0].r_offset + 4;
11234 r[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS);
11235 r[1].r_addend = r[0].r_addend;
11236 }
11237 }
11238
11239 p = loc;
11240 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11241 {
11242 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11243 {
11244 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11245 ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11246 p += 4;
11247 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11248 LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11249 }
11250 else
11251 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11252 LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11253 }
11254 else
11255 {
11256 bfd_vma r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11257
11258 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11259 {
11260 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11261 return FALSE;
11262 }
11263
11264 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11265 p += 4;
11266 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11267 {
11268 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11269 ADDIS_R12_R2 | PPC_HA (off), p);
11270 p += 4;
11271 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11272 LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11273 }
11274 else
11275 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, LD_R12_0R2 | PPC_LO (off), p);
11276
11277 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11278 {
11279 p += 4;
11280 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11281 ADDIS_R2_R2 | PPC_HA (r2off), p);
11282 }
11283 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11284 {
11285 p += 4;
11286 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11287 ADDI_R2_R2 | PPC_LO (r2off), p);
11288 }
11289 }
11290 p += 4;
11291 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11292 p += 4;
11293 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
11294 p += 4;
11295 break;
11296
11297 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
11298 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
11299 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
11300 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
11301 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
11302 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
11303 p = loc;
11304 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11305 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11306 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11307 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11308 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11309 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11310 {
11311 off += 4;
11312 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab), p);
11313 p += 4;
11314 }
11315 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
11316 {
11317 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11318 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11319 abort ();
11320
11321 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11322 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11323 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11324 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11325 {
11326 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11327 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11328 else
11329 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11330 }
11331 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11332 }
11333 else
11334 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11335 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11336 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11337 odd = off & 4;
11338 off = targ - off;
11339
11340 relp = p;
11341 num_rel = 0;
11342 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11343 {
11344 bfd_boolean load = stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
11345 p = build_powerxx_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off, odd, load);
11346 }
11347 else
11348 {
11349 /* The notoc stubs calculate their target (either a PLT entry or
11350 the global entry point of a function) relative to the PC
11351 returned by the "bcl" two instructions past the start of the
11352 sequence emitted by build_offset. The offset is therefore 8
11353 less than calculated from the start of the sequence. */
11354 off -= 8;
11355 p = build_offset (htab->params->stub_bfd, p, off,
11356 stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc);
11357 }
11358
11359 if (stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11360 {
11361 bfd_vma from;
11362 num_rel = 1;
11363 from = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11364 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11365 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
11366 + (p - loc));
11367 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd,
11368 B_DOT | ((targ - from) & 0x3fffffc), p);
11369 }
11370 else
11371 {
11372 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, MTCTR_R12, p);
11373 p += 4;
11374 bfd_put_32 (htab->params->stub_bfd, BCTR, p);
11375 }
11376 p += 4;
11377
11378 if (info->emitrelocations)
11379 {
11380 bfd_vma roff = relp - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11381 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11382 num_rel += num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
11383 else
11384 {
11385 num_rel += num_relocs_for_offset (off);
11386 roff += 16;
11387 }
11388 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec, num_rel);
11389 if (r == NULL)
11390 return FALSE;
11391 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11392 r = emit_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off, odd);
11393 else
11394 r = emit_relocs_for_offset (info, r, roff, targ, off);
11395 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
11396 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11397 {
11398 ++r;
11399 roff = p - 4 - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11400 r->r_offset = roff;
11401 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL24);
11402 r->r_addend = targ;
11403 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11404 && !use_global_in_relocs (htab, stub_entry, r, num_rel))
11405 return FALSE;
11406 }
11407 }
11408
11409 if (!htab->powerxx_stubs
11410 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
11411 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
11412 {
11413 bfd_byte *base, *eh;
11414 unsigned int lr_used, delta;
11415
11416 base = (htab->glink_eh_frame->contents
11417 + stub_entry->group->eh_base + 17);
11418 eh = base + stub_entry->group->eh_size;
11419 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
11420 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
11421 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
11422 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11423 lr_used += 4;
11424 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11425 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
11426 eh = eh_advance (htab->elf.dynobj, eh, delta);
11427 *eh++ = DW_CFA_register;
11428 *eh++ = 65;
11429 *eh++ = 12;
11430 *eh++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 2;
11431 *eh++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
11432 *eh++ = 65;
11433 stub_entry->group->eh_size = eh - base;
11434 }
11435 break;
11436
11437 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
11438 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
11439 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11440 && stub_entry->h->is_func_descriptor
11441 && stub_entry->h->oh != NULL)
11442 {
11443 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fh = ppc_follow_link (stub_entry->h->oh);
11444
11445 /* If the old-ABI "dot-symbol" is undefined make it weak so
11446 we don't get a link error from RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL. */
11447 if (fh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
11448 && (stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11449 || stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
11450 fh->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_undefweak;
11451 }
11452
11453 /* Now build the stub. */
11454 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11455 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11456 abort ();
11457
11458 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11459 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11460 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11461 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11462 {
11463 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11464 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11465 else
11466 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11467 }
11468 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11469
11470 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11471 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11472 off = targ - off;
11473
11474 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 7) != 0)
11475 {
11476 info->callbacks->einfo
11477 /* xgettext:c-format */
11478 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
11479 stub_entry->h != NULL
11480 ? stub_entry->h->elf.root.root.string
11481 : "<local sym>");
11482 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11483 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11484 return FALSE;
11485 }
11486
11487 r = NULL;
11488 if (info->emitrelocations)
11489 {
11490 r = get_relocs (stub_entry->group->stub_sec,
11491 ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11492 + (htab->opd_abi
11493 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
11494 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
11495 : 1)));
11496 if (r == NULL)
11497 return FALSE;
11498 r[0].r_offset = loc - stub_entry->group->stub_sec->contents;
11499 if (bfd_big_endian (info->output_bfd))
11500 r[0].r_offset += 2;
11501 r[0].r_addend = targ;
11502 }
11503 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11504 && (stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
11505 || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
11506 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
11507 p = build_tls_get_addr_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
11508 else
11509 p = build_plt_stub (htab, stub_entry, loc, off, r);
11510 break;
11511
11512 case ppc_stub_save_res:
11513 return TRUE;
11514
11515 default:
11516 BFD_FAIL ();
11517 return FALSE;
11518 }
11519
11520 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size = stub_entry->stub_offset + (p - loc);
11521
11522 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
11523 {
11524 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11525 size_t len1, len2;
11526 char *name;
11527 const char *const stub_str[] = { "long_branch",
11528 "long_branch",
11529 "long_branch",
11530 "long_branch",
11531 "plt_branch",
11532 "plt_branch",
11533 "plt_branch",
11534 "plt_branch",
11535 "plt_call",
11536 "plt_call",
11537 "plt_call",
11538 "plt_call" };
11539
11540 len1 = strlen (stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1]);
11541 len2 = strlen (stub_entry->root.string);
11542 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + 2);
11543 if (name == NULL)
11544 return FALSE;
11545 memcpy (name, stub_entry->root.string, 9);
11546 memcpy (name + 9, stub_str[stub_entry->stub_type - 1], len1);
11547 memcpy (name + len1 + 9, stub_entry->root.string + 8, len2 - 8 + 1);
11548 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
11549 if (h == NULL)
11550 return FALSE;
11551 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
11552 {
11553 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
11554 h->root.u.def.section = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
11555 h->root.u.def.value = stub_entry->stub_offset;
11556 h->ref_regular = 1;
11557 h->def_regular = 1;
11558 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
11559 h->forced_local = 1;
11560 h->non_elf = 0;
11561 h->root.linker_def = 1;
11562 }
11563 }
11564
11565 return TRUE;
11566 }
11567
11568 /* As above, but don't actually build the stub. Just bump offset so
11569 we know stub section sizes, and select plt_branch stubs where
11570 long_branch stubs won't do. */
11571
11572 static bfd_boolean
11573 ppc_size_one_stub (struct bfd_hash_entry *gen_entry, void *in_arg)
11574 {
11575 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
11576 struct bfd_link_info *info;
11577 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
11578 asection *plt;
11579 bfd_vma targ, off, r2off;
11580 unsigned int size, extra, lr_used, delta, odd;
11581
11582 /* Massage our args to the form they really have. */
11583 stub_entry = (struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *) gen_entry;
11584 info = in_arg;
11585
11586 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11587 if (htab == NULL)
11588 return FALSE;
11589
11590 /* Make a note of the offset within the stubs for this entry. */
11591 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
11592
11593 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11594 && stub_entry->h->save_res
11595 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11596 && stub_entry->h->elf.root.u.def.section == htab->sfpr)
11597 {
11598 /* Don't make stubs to out-of-line register save/restore
11599 functions. Instead, emit copies of the functions. */
11600 stub_entry->group->needs_save_res = 1;
11601 stub_entry->stub_type = ppc_stub_save_res;
11602 return TRUE;
11603 }
11604
11605 switch (stub_entry->stub_type)
11606 {
11607 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
11608 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
11609 /* Reset the stub type from the plt branch variant in case we now
11610 can reach with a shorter stub. */
11611 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
11612 /* Fall through. */
11613 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
11614 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
11615 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11616 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11617 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11618 targ += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (stub_entry->other);
11619 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11620 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11621 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11622
11623 size = 4;
11624 r2off = 0;
11625 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
11626 {
11627 r2off = get_r2off (info, stub_entry);
11628 if (r2off == (bfd_vma) -1)
11629 {
11630 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11631 return FALSE;
11632 }
11633 size = 8;
11634 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11635 size += 4;
11636 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11637 size += 4;
11638 off += size - 4;
11639 }
11640 off = targ - off;
11641
11642 /* If the branch offset is too big, use a ppc_stub_plt_branch.
11643 Do the same for -R objects without function descriptors. */
11644 if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
11645 && r2off == 0
11646 && htab->sec_info[stub_entry->target_section->id].toc_off == 0)
11647 || off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11648 {
11649 struct ppc_branch_hash_entry *br_entry;
11650
11651 br_entry = ppc_branch_hash_lookup (&htab->branch_hash_table,
11652 stub_entry->root.string + 9,
11653 TRUE, FALSE);
11654 if (br_entry == NULL)
11655 {
11656 _bfd_error_handler (_("can't build branch stub `%s'"),
11657 stub_entry->root.string);
11658 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
11659 return FALSE;
11660 }
11661
11662 if (br_entry->iter != htab->stub_iteration)
11663 {
11664 br_entry->iter = htab->stub_iteration;
11665 br_entry->offset = htab->brlt->size;
11666 htab->brlt->size += 8;
11667
11668 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
11669 htab->relbrlt->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
11670 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11671 {
11672 htab->brlt->reloc_count += 1;
11673 htab->brlt->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11674 }
11675 }
11676
11677 targ = (br_entry->offset
11678 + htab->brlt->output_offset
11679 + htab->brlt->output_section->vma);
11680 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11681 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11682 off = targ - off;
11683
11684 if (info->emitrelocations)
11685 {
11686 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
11687 += 1 + (PPC_HA (off) != 0);
11688 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11689 }
11690
11691 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_plt_branch - ppc_stub_long_branch;
11692 if (stub_entry->stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off)
11693 {
11694 size = 12;
11695 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11696 size = 16;
11697 }
11698 else
11699 {
11700 size = 16;
11701 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11702 size += 4;
11703
11704 if (PPC_HA (r2off) != 0)
11705 size += 4;
11706 if (PPC_LO (r2off) != 0)
11707 size += 4;
11708 }
11709 }
11710 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11711 {
11712 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += 1;
11713 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11714 }
11715 break;
11716
11717 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
11718 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
11719 stub_entry->stub_type += ppc_stub_long_branch - ppc_stub_plt_branch;
11720 /* Fall through. */
11721 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
11722 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
11723 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11724 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11725 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11726 size = 0;
11727 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11728 size = 4;
11729 off += size;
11730 targ = (stub_entry->target_value
11731 + stub_entry->target_section->output_offset
11732 + stub_entry->target_section->output_section->vma);
11733 odd = off & 4;
11734 off = targ - off;
11735
11736 if (info->emitrelocations)
11737 {
11738 unsigned int num_rel;
11739 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11740 num_rel = num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
11741 else
11742 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
11743 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
11744 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11745 }
11746
11747 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11748 extra = size_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
11749 else
11750 extra = size_offset (off - 8);
11751 /* Include branch insn plus those in the offset sequence. */
11752 size += 4 + extra;
11753 /* The branch insn is at the end, or "extra" bytes along. So
11754 its offset will be "extra" bytes less that that already
11755 calculated. */
11756 off -= extra;
11757
11758 if (!htab->powerxx_stubs)
11759 {
11760 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
11761 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
11762 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
11763 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both)
11764 lr_used += 4;
11765 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
11766 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
11767 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
11768 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11769 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
11770 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
11771 }
11772
11773 /* If the branch can't reach, use a plt_branch. */
11774 if (off + (1 << 25) >= (bfd_vma) (1 << 26))
11775 {
11776 stub_entry->stub_type += (ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
11777 - ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc);
11778 size += 4;
11779 }
11780 else if (info->emitrelocations)
11781 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count +=1;
11782 break;
11783
11784 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
11785 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
11786 off = (stub_entry->stub_offset
11787 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_offset
11788 + stub_entry->group->stub_sec->output_section->vma);
11789 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11790 off += 4;
11791 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~1;
11792 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11793 abort ();
11794
11795 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11796 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11797 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11798 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11799 {
11800 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11801 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11802 else
11803 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11804 }
11805 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11806 odd = off & 4;
11807 off = targ - off;
11808
11809 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
11810 {
11811 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
11812
11813 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
11814 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
11815 off -= pad;
11816 }
11817
11818 if (info->emitrelocations)
11819 {
11820 unsigned int num_rel;
11821 if (htab->powerxx_stubs)
11822 num_rel = num_relocs_for_powerxx_offset (off, odd);
11823 else
11824 num_rel = num_relocs_for_offset (off - 8);
11825 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count += num_rel;
11826 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11827 }
11828
11829 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
11830
11831 if (!htab->powerxx_stubs)
11832 {
11833 /* After the bcl, lr has been modified so we need to emit
11834 .eh_frame info saying the return address is in r12. */
11835 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + 8;
11836 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
11837 lr_used += 4;
11838 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc or
11839 variant, DW_CFA_register, 65, 12, DW_CFA_advance_loc+2,
11840 DW_CFA_restore_extended 65. */
11841 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11842 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
11843 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = lr_used + 8;
11844 }
11845 break;
11846
11847 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
11848 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
11849 targ = stub_entry->plt_ent->plt.offset & ~(bfd_vma) 1;
11850 if (targ >= (bfd_vma) -2)
11851 abort ();
11852 plt = htab->elf.splt;
11853 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
11854 || stub_entry->h == NULL
11855 || stub_entry->h->elf.dynindx == -1)
11856 {
11857 if (stub_entry->symtype == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
11858 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
11859 else
11860 plt = htab->pltlocal;
11861 }
11862 targ += plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
11863
11864 off = (elf_gp (info->output_bfd)
11865 + htab->sec_info[stub_entry->group->link_sec->id].toc_off);
11866 off = targ - off;
11867
11868 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
11869 {
11870 unsigned pad = plt_stub_pad (htab, stub_entry, off);
11871
11872 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += pad;
11873 stub_entry->stub_offset = stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size;
11874 }
11875
11876 if (info->emitrelocations)
11877 {
11878 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->reloc_count
11879 += ((PPC_HA (off) != 0)
11880 + (htab->opd_abi
11881 ? 2 + (htab->params->plt_static_chain
11882 && PPC_HA (off + 16) == PPC_HA (off))
11883 : 1));
11884 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
11885 }
11886
11887 size = plt_stub_size (htab, stub_entry, off);
11888
11889 if (stub_entry->h != NULL
11890 && (stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
11891 || stub_entry->h == htab->tls_get_addr)
11892 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt
11893 && stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
11894 {
11895 /* After the bctrl, lr has been modified so we need to
11896 emit .eh_frame info saying the return address is
11897 on the stack. In fact we put the EH info specifying
11898 that the return address is on the stack *at* the
11899 call rather than after it, because the EH info for a
11900 call needs to be specified by that point.
11901 See libgcc/unwind-dw2.c execute_cfa_program. */
11902 lr_used = stub_entry->stub_offset + size - 20;
11903 /* The eh_frame info will consist of a DW_CFA_advance_loc
11904 or variant, DW_CFA_offset_externed_sf, 65, -stackoff,
11905 DW_CFA_advance_loc+4, DW_CFA_restore_extended, 65. */
11906 delta = lr_used - stub_entry->group->lr_restore;
11907 stub_entry->group->eh_size += eh_advance_size (delta) + 6;
11908 stub_entry->group->lr_restore = size - 4;
11909 }
11910 break;
11911
11912 default:
11913 BFD_FAIL ();
11914 return FALSE;
11915 }
11916
11917 stub_entry->group->stub_sec->size += size;
11918 return TRUE;
11919 }
11920
11921 /* Set up various things so that we can make a list of input sections
11922 for each output section included in the link. Returns -1 on error,
11923 0 when no stubs will be needed, and 1 on success. */
11924
11925 int
11926 ppc64_elf_setup_section_lists (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11927 {
11928 unsigned int id;
11929 bfd_size_type amt;
11930 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11931
11932 if (htab == NULL)
11933 return -1;
11934
11935 htab->sec_info_arr_size = _bfd_section_id;
11936 amt = sizeof (*htab->sec_info) * (htab->sec_info_arr_size);
11937 htab->sec_info = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
11938 if (htab->sec_info == NULL)
11939 return -1;
11940
11941 /* Set toc_off for com, und, abs and ind sections. */
11942 for (id = 0; id < 3; id++)
11943 htab->sec_info[id].toc_off = TOC_BASE_OFF;
11944
11945 return 1;
11946 }
11947
11948 /* Set up for first pass at multitoc partitioning. */
11949
11950 void
11951 ppc64_elf_start_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11952 {
11953 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11954
11955 htab->toc_curr = ppc64_elf_set_toc (info, info->output_bfd);
11956 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
11957 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
11958 }
11959
11960 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each TOC input section
11961 and linker generated GOT section. Group input bfds such that the toc
11962 within a group is less than 64k in size. */
11963
11964 bfd_boolean
11965 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
11966 {
11967 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
11968 bfd_vma addr, off, limit;
11969
11970 if (htab == NULL)
11971 return FALSE;
11972
11973 if (!htab->second_toc_pass)
11974 {
11975 /* Keep track of the first .toc or .got section for this input bfd. */
11976 bfd_boolean new_bfd = htab->toc_bfd != isec->owner;
11977
11978 if (new_bfd)
11979 {
11980 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
11981 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
11982 }
11983
11984 addr = isec->output_offset + isec->output_section->vma;
11985 off = addr - htab->toc_curr;
11986 limit = 0x80008000;
11987 if (ppc64_elf_tdata (isec->owner)->has_small_toc_reloc)
11988 limit = 0x10000;
11989 if (off + isec->size > limit)
11990 {
11991 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
11992 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
11993 htab->toc_curr = addr;
11994 htab->toc_curr &= -TOC_BASE_ALIGN;
11995 }
11996
11997 /* toc_curr is the base address of this toc group. Set elf_gp
11998 for the input section to be the offset relative to the
11999 output toc base plus 0x8000. Making the input elf_gp an
12000 offset allows us to move the toc as a whole without
12001 recalculating input elf_gp. */
12002 off = htab->toc_curr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12003 off += TOC_BASE_OFF;
12004
12005 /* Die if someone uses a linker script that doesn't keep input
12006 file .toc and .got together. */
12007 if (new_bfd
12008 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0
12009 && elf_gp (isec->owner) != off)
12010 return FALSE;
12011
12012 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12013 return TRUE;
12014 }
12015
12016 /* During the second pass toc_first_sec points to the start of
12017 a toc group, and toc_curr is used to track the old elf_gp.
12018 We use toc_bfd to ensure we only look at each bfd once. */
12019 if (htab->toc_bfd == isec->owner)
12020 return TRUE;
12021 htab->toc_bfd = isec->owner;
12022
12023 if (htab->toc_first_sec == NULL
12024 || htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (isec->owner))
12025 {
12026 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12027 htab->toc_first_sec = isec;
12028 }
12029 addr = (htab->toc_first_sec->output_offset
12030 + htab->toc_first_sec->output_section->vma);
12031 off = addr - elf_gp (info->output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF;
12032 elf_gp (isec->owner) = off;
12033
12034 return TRUE;
12035 }
12036
12037 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to merge GOT entries for global
12038 symbol H. */
12039
12040 static bfd_boolean
12041 merge_global_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12042 {
12043 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12044 return TRUE;
12045
12046 merge_got_entries (&h->got.glist);
12047
12048 return TRUE;
12049 }
12050
12051 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse to allocate GOT entries for global
12052 symbol H. */
12053
12054 static bfd_boolean
12055 reallocate_got (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
12056 {
12057 struct got_entry *gent;
12058
12059 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12060 return TRUE;
12061
12062 for (gent = h->got.glist; gent != NULL; gent = gent->next)
12063 if (!gent->is_indirect)
12064 allocate_got (h, (struct bfd_link_info *) inf, gent);
12065 return TRUE;
12066 }
12067
12068 /* Called on the first multitoc pass after the last call to
12069 ppc64_elf_next_toc_section. This function removes duplicate GOT
12070 entries. */
12071
12072 bfd_boolean
12073 ppc64_elf_layout_multitoc (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12074 {
12075 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12076 struct bfd *ibfd, *ibfd2;
12077 bfd_boolean done_something;
12078
12079 htab->multi_toc_needed = htab->toc_curr != elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
12080
12081 if (!htab->do_multi_toc)
12082 return FALSE;
12083
12084 /* Merge global sym got entries within a toc group. */
12085 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, merge_global_got, info);
12086
12087 /* And tlsld_got. */
12088 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12089 {
12090 struct got_entry *ent, *ent2;
12091
12092 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12093 continue;
12094
12095 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12096 if (!ent->is_indirect
12097 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12098 {
12099 for (ibfd2 = ibfd->link.next; ibfd2 != NULL; ibfd2 = ibfd2->link.next)
12100 {
12101 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd2))
12102 continue;
12103
12104 ent2 = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd2);
12105 if (!ent2->is_indirect
12106 && ent2->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
12107 && elf_gp (ibfd2) == elf_gp (ibfd))
12108 {
12109 ent2->is_indirect = TRUE;
12110 ent2->got.ent = ent;
12111 }
12112 }
12113 }
12114 }
12115
12116 /* Zap sizes of got sections. */
12117 htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize = htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12118 htab->elf.irelplt->size -= htab->got_reli_size;
12119 htab->got_reli_size = 0;
12120
12121 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12122 {
12123 asection *got, *relgot;
12124
12125 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12126 continue;
12127
12128 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12129 if (got != NULL)
12130 {
12131 got->rawsize = got->size;
12132 got->size = 0;
12133 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12134 relgot->rawsize = relgot->size;
12135 relgot->size = 0;
12136 }
12137 }
12138
12139 /* Now reallocate the got, local syms first. We don't need to
12140 allocate section contents again since we never increase size. */
12141 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12142 {
12143 struct got_entry **lgot_ents;
12144 struct got_entry **end_lgot_ents;
12145 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
12146 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
12147 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
12148 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
12149 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12150 asection *s;
12151
12152 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12153 continue;
12154
12155 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
12156 if (!lgot_ents)
12157 continue;
12158
12159 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
12160 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
12161 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
12162 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
12163 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
12164 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *) end_local_plt;
12165 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12166 for (; lgot_ents < end_lgot_ents; ++lgot_ents, ++lgot_masks)
12167 {
12168 struct got_entry *ent;
12169
12170 for (ent = *lgot_ents; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
12171 {
12172 unsigned int ent_size = 8;
12173 unsigned int rel_size = sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12174
12175 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12176 if ((ent->tls_type & *lgot_masks & TLS_GD) != 0)
12177 {
12178 ent_size *= 2;
12179 rel_size *= 2;
12180 }
12181 s->size += ent_size;
12182 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
12183 {
12184 htab->elf.irelplt->size += rel_size;
12185 htab->got_reli_size += rel_size;
12186 }
12187 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
12188 && !((ent->tls_type & TLS_TPREL) != 0
12189 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
12190 {
12191 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12192 srel->size += rel_size;
12193 }
12194 }
12195 }
12196 }
12197
12198 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, reallocate_got, info);
12199
12200 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12201 {
12202 struct got_entry *ent;
12203
12204 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12205 continue;
12206
12207 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (ibfd);
12208 if (!ent->is_indirect
12209 && ent->got.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
12210 {
12211 asection *s = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12212 ent->got.offset = s->size;
12213 s->size += 16;
12214 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
12215 {
12216 asection *srel = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->relgot;
12217 srel->size += sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
12218 }
12219 }
12220 }
12221
12222 done_something = htab->elf.irelplt->rawsize != htab->elf.irelplt->size;
12223 if (!done_something)
12224 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
12225 {
12226 asection *got;
12227
12228 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
12229 continue;
12230
12231 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ibfd)->got;
12232 if (got != NULL)
12233 {
12234 done_something = got->rawsize != got->size;
12235 if (done_something)
12236 break;
12237 }
12238 }
12239
12240 if (done_something)
12241 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
12242
12243 /* Set up for second pass over toc sections to recalculate elf_gp
12244 on input sections. */
12245 htab->toc_bfd = NULL;
12246 htab->toc_first_sec = NULL;
12247 htab->second_toc_pass = TRUE;
12248 return done_something;
12249 }
12250
12251 /* Called after second pass of multitoc partitioning. */
12252
12253 void
12254 ppc64_elf_finish_multitoc_partition (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12255 {
12256 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12257
12258 /* After the second pass, toc_curr tracks the TOC offset used
12259 for code sections below in ppc64_elf_next_input_section. */
12260 htab->toc_curr = TOC_BASE_OFF;
12261 }
12262
12263 /* No toc references were found in ISEC. If the code in ISEC makes no
12264 calls, then there's no need to use toc adjusting stubs when branching
12265 into ISEC. Actually, indirect calls from ISEC are OK as they will
12266 load r2. Returns -1 on error, 0 for no stub needed, 1 for stub
12267 needed, and 2 if a cyclical call-graph was found but no other reason
12268 for a stub was detected. If called from the top level, a return of
12269 2 means the same as a return of 0. */
12270
12271 static int
12272 toc_adjusting_stub_needed (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12273 {
12274 int ret;
12275
12276 /* Mark this section as checked. */
12277 isec->call_check_done = 1;
12278
12279 /* We know none of our code bearing sections will need toc stubs. */
12280 if ((isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
12281 return 0;
12282
12283 if (isec->size == 0)
12284 return 0;
12285
12286 if (isec->output_section == NULL)
12287 return 0;
12288
12289 ret = 0;
12290 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
12291 {
12292 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel;
12293 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
12294 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12295
12296 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (isec->owner, isec, NULL, NULL,
12297 info->keep_memory);
12298 if (relstart == NULL)
12299 return -1;
12300
12301 /* Look for branches to outside of this section. */
12302 local_syms = NULL;
12303 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12304 if (htab == NULL)
12305 return -1;
12306
12307 for (rel = relstart; rel < relstart + isec->reloc_count; ++rel)
12308 {
12309 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
12310 unsigned long r_symndx;
12311 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12312 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *eh;
12313 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12314 asection *sym_sec;
12315 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
12316 bfd_vma sym_value;
12317 bfd_vma dest;
12318
12319 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
12320 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
12321 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
12322 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
12323 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
12324 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN
12325 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL
12326 && r_type != R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
12327 continue;
12328
12329 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
12330 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms, r_symndx,
12331 isec->owner))
12332 {
12333 ret = -1;
12334 break;
12335 }
12336
12337 /* Calls to dynamic lib functions go through a plt call stub
12338 that uses r2. */
12339 eh = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
12340 if (eh != NULL
12341 && (eh->elf.plt.plist != NULL
12342 || (eh->oh != NULL
12343 && ppc_follow_link (eh->oh)->elf.plt.plist != NULL)))
12344 {
12345 ret = 1;
12346 break;
12347 }
12348
12349 if (sym_sec == NULL)
12350 /* Ignore other undefined symbols. */
12351 continue;
12352
12353 /* Assume branches to other sections not included in the
12354 link need stubs too, to cover -R and absolute syms. */
12355 if (sym_sec->output_section == NULL)
12356 {
12357 ret = 1;
12358 break;
12359 }
12360
12361 if (h == NULL)
12362 sym_value = sym->st_value;
12363 else
12364 {
12365 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
12366 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12367 abort ();
12368 sym_value = h->root.u.def.value;
12369 }
12370 sym_value += rel->r_addend;
12371
12372 /* If this branch reloc uses an opd sym, find the code section. */
12373 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
12374 if (opd != NULL)
12375 {
12376 if (h == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
12377 {
12378 long adjust;
12379
12380 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
12381 if (adjust == -1)
12382 /* Assume deleted functions won't ever be called. */
12383 continue;
12384 sym_value += adjust;
12385 }
12386
12387 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
12388 &sym_sec, NULL, FALSE);
12389 if (dest == (bfd_vma) -1)
12390 continue;
12391 }
12392 else
12393 dest = (sym_value
12394 + sym_sec->output_offset
12395 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
12396
12397 /* Ignore branch to self. */
12398 if (sym_sec == isec)
12399 continue;
12400
12401 /* If the called function uses the toc, we need a stub. */
12402 if (sym_sec->has_toc_reloc
12403 || sym_sec->makes_toc_func_call)
12404 {
12405 ret = 1;
12406 break;
12407 }
12408
12409 /* Assume any branch that needs a long branch stub might in fact
12410 need a plt_branch stub. A plt_branch stub uses r2. */
12411 else if (dest - (isec->output_offset
12412 + isec->output_section->vma
12413 + rel->r_offset) + (1 << 25)
12414 >= (2u << 25) - PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h
12415 ? h->other
12416 : sym->st_other))
12417 {
12418 ret = 1;
12419 break;
12420 }
12421
12422 /* If calling back to a section in the process of being
12423 tested, we can't say for sure that no toc adjusting stubs
12424 are needed, so don't return zero. */
12425 else if (sym_sec->call_check_in_progress)
12426 ret = 2;
12427
12428 /* Branches to another section that itself doesn't have any TOC
12429 references are OK. Recursively call ourselves to check. */
12430 else if (!sym_sec->call_check_done)
12431 {
12432 int recur;
12433
12434 /* Mark current section as indeterminate, so that other
12435 sections that call back to current won't be marked as
12436 known. */
12437 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12438 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, sym_sec);
12439 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12440
12441 if (recur != 0)
12442 {
12443 ret = recur;
12444 if (recur != 2)
12445 break;
12446 }
12447 }
12448 }
12449
12450 if (local_syms != NULL
12451 && (elf_symtab_hdr (isec->owner).contents
12452 != (unsigned char *) local_syms))
12453 free (local_syms);
12454 if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != relstart)
12455 free (relstart);
12456 }
12457
12458 if ((ret & 1) == 0
12459 && isec->map_head.s != NULL
12460 && (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
12461 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
12462 {
12463 if (isec->map_head.s->has_toc_reloc
12464 || isec->map_head.s->makes_toc_func_call)
12465 ret = 1;
12466 else if (!isec->map_head.s->call_check_done)
12467 {
12468 int recur;
12469 isec->call_check_in_progress = 1;
12470 recur = toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec->map_head.s);
12471 isec->call_check_in_progress = 0;
12472 if (recur != 0)
12473 ret = recur;
12474 }
12475 }
12476
12477 if (ret == 1)
12478 isec->makes_toc_func_call = 1;
12479
12480 return ret;
12481 }
12482
12483 /* The linker repeatedly calls this function for each input section,
12484 in the order that input sections are linked into output sections.
12485 Build lists of input sections to determine groupings between which
12486 we may insert linker stubs. */
12487
12488 bfd_boolean
12489 ppc64_elf_next_input_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12490 {
12491 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12492
12493 if (htab == NULL)
12494 return FALSE;
12495
12496 if ((isec->output_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
12497 && isec->output_section->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12498 {
12499 /* This happens to make the list in reverse order,
12500 which is what we want. */
12501 htab->sec_info[isec->id].u.list
12502 = htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list;
12503 htab->sec_info[isec->output_section->id].u.list = isec;
12504 }
12505
12506 if (htab->multi_toc_needed)
12507 {
12508 /* Analyse sections that aren't already flagged as needing a
12509 valid toc pointer. Exclude .fixup for the linux kernel.
12510 .fixup contains branches, but only back to the function that
12511 hit an exception. */
12512 if (!(isec->has_toc_reloc
12513 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
12514 || strcmp (isec->name, ".fixup") == 0
12515 || isec->call_check_done))
12516 {
12517 if (toc_adjusting_stub_needed (info, isec) < 0)
12518 return FALSE;
12519 }
12520 /* Make all sections use the TOC assigned for this object file.
12521 This will be wrong for pasted sections; We fix that in
12522 check_pasted_section(). */
12523 if (elf_gp (isec->owner) != 0)
12524 htab->toc_curr = elf_gp (isec->owner);
12525 }
12526
12527 htab->sec_info[isec->id].toc_off = htab->toc_curr;
12528 return TRUE;
12529 }
12530
12531 /* Check that all .init and .fini sections use the same toc, if they
12532 have toc relocs. */
12533
12534 static bfd_boolean
12535 check_pasted_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, const char *name)
12536 {
12537 asection *o = bfd_get_section_by_name (info->output_bfd, name);
12538
12539 if (o != NULL)
12540 {
12541 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12542 bfd_vma toc_off = 0;
12543 asection *i;
12544
12545 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12546 if (i->has_toc_reloc)
12547 {
12548 if (toc_off == 0)
12549 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
12550 else if (toc_off != htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off)
12551 return FALSE;
12552 }
12553
12554 if (toc_off == 0)
12555 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12556 if (i->makes_toc_func_call)
12557 {
12558 toc_off = htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off;
12559 break;
12560 }
12561
12562 /* Make sure the whole pasted function uses the same toc offset. */
12563 if (toc_off != 0)
12564 for (i = o->map_head.s; i != NULL; i = i->map_head.s)
12565 htab->sec_info[i->id].toc_off = toc_off;
12566 }
12567 return TRUE;
12568 }
12569
12570 bfd_boolean
12571 ppc64_elf_check_init_fini (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12572 {
12573 return (check_pasted_section (info, ".init")
12574 & check_pasted_section (info, ".fini"));
12575 }
12576
12577 /* See whether we can group stub sections together. Grouping stub
12578 sections may result in fewer stubs. More importantly, we need to
12579 put all .init* and .fini* stubs at the beginning of the .init or
12580 .fini output sections respectively, because glibc splits the
12581 _init and _fini functions into multiple parts. Putting a stub in
12582 the middle of a function is not a good idea. */
12583
12584 static bfd_boolean
12585 group_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12586 bfd_size_type stub_group_size,
12587 bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch)
12588 {
12589 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
12590 asection *osec;
12591 bfd_boolean suppress_size_errors;
12592
12593 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12594 if (htab == NULL)
12595 return FALSE;
12596
12597 suppress_size_errors = FALSE;
12598 if (stub_group_size == 1)
12599 {
12600 /* Default values. */
12601 if (stubs_always_before_branch)
12602 stub_group_size = 0x1e00000;
12603 else
12604 stub_group_size = 0x1c00000;
12605 suppress_size_errors = TRUE;
12606 }
12607
12608 for (osec = info->output_bfd->sections; osec != NULL; osec = osec->next)
12609 {
12610 asection *tail;
12611
12612 if (osec->id >= htab->sec_info_arr_size)
12613 continue;
12614
12615 tail = htab->sec_info[osec->id].u.list;
12616 while (tail != NULL)
12617 {
12618 asection *curr;
12619 asection *prev;
12620 bfd_size_type total;
12621 bfd_boolean big_sec;
12622 bfd_vma curr_toc;
12623 struct map_stub *group;
12624 bfd_size_type group_size;
12625
12626 curr = tail;
12627 total = tail->size;
12628 group_size = (ppc64_elf_section_data (tail) != NULL
12629 && ppc64_elf_section_data (tail)->has_14bit_branch
12630 ? stub_group_size >> 10 : stub_group_size);
12631
12632 big_sec = total > group_size;
12633 if (big_sec && !suppress_size_errors)
12634 /* xgettext:c-format */
12635 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB section %pA exceeds stub group size"),
12636 tail->owner, tail);
12637 curr_toc = htab->sec_info[tail->id].toc_off;
12638
12639 while ((prev = htab->sec_info[curr->id].u.list) != NULL
12640 && ((total += curr->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
12641 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
12642 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
12643 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10) : group_size))
12644 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
12645 curr = prev;
12646
12647 /* OK, the size from the start of CURR to the end is less
12648 than group_size and thus can be handled by one stub
12649 section. (or the tail section is itself larger than
12650 group_size, in which case we may be toast.) We should
12651 really be keeping track of the total size of stubs added
12652 here, as stubs contribute to the final output section
12653 size. That's a little tricky, and this way will only
12654 break if stubs added make the total size more than 2^25,
12655 ie. for the default stub_group_size, if stubs total more
12656 than 2097152 bytes, or nearly 75000 plt call stubs. */
12657 group = bfd_alloc (curr->owner, sizeof (*group));
12658 if (group == NULL)
12659 return FALSE;
12660 group->link_sec = curr;
12661 group->stub_sec = NULL;
12662 group->needs_save_res = 0;
12663 group->lr_restore = 0;
12664 group->eh_size = 0;
12665 group->eh_base = 0;
12666 group->next = htab->group;
12667 htab->group = group;
12668 do
12669 {
12670 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
12671 /* Set up this stub group. */
12672 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
12673 }
12674 while (tail != curr && (tail = prev) != NULL);
12675
12676 /* But wait, there's more! Input sections up to group_size
12677 bytes before the stub section can be handled by it too.
12678 Don't do this if we have a really large section after the
12679 stubs, as adding more stubs increases the chance that
12680 branches may not reach into the stub section. */
12681 if (!stubs_always_before_branch && !big_sec)
12682 {
12683 total = 0;
12684 while (prev != NULL
12685 && ((total += tail->output_offset - prev->output_offset)
12686 < (ppc64_elf_section_data (prev) != NULL
12687 && ppc64_elf_section_data (prev)->has_14bit_branch
12688 ? (group_size = stub_group_size >> 10)
12689 : group_size))
12690 && htab->sec_info[prev->id].toc_off == curr_toc)
12691 {
12692 tail = prev;
12693 prev = htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.list;
12694 htab->sec_info[tail->id].u.group = group;
12695 }
12696 }
12697 tail = prev;
12698 }
12699 }
12700 return TRUE;
12701 }
12702
12703 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
12704 {
12705 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
12706 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
12707 1, /* CIE version. */
12708 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
12709 4, /* Code alignment. */
12710 0x78, /* Data alignment. */
12711 65, /* RA reg. */
12712 1, /* Augmentation size. */
12713 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
12714 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
12715 };
12716
12717 /* Stripping output sections is normally done before dynamic section
12718 symbols have been allocated. This function is called later, and
12719 handles cases like htab->brlt which is mapped to its own output
12720 section. */
12721
12722 static void
12723 maybe_strip_output (struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *isec)
12724 {
12725 if (isec->size == 0
12726 && isec->output_section->size == 0
12727 && !(isec->output_section->flags & SEC_KEEP)
12728 && !bfd_section_removed_from_list (info->output_bfd,
12729 isec->output_section)
12730 && elf_section_data (isec->output_section)->dynindx == 0)
12731 {
12732 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
12733 bfd_section_list_remove (info->output_bfd, isec->output_section);
12734 info->output_bfd->section_count--;
12735 }
12736 }
12737
12738 /* Determine and set the size of the stub section for a final link.
12739
12740 The basic idea here is to examine all the relocations looking for
12741 PC-relative calls to a target that is unreachable with a "bl"
12742 instruction. */
12743
12744 bfd_boolean
12745 ppc64_elf_size_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
12746 {
12747 bfd_size_type stub_group_size;
12748 bfd_boolean stubs_always_before_branch;
12749 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
12750
12751 if (htab == NULL)
12752 return FALSE;
12753
12754 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1 && !bfd_link_executable (info))
12755 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 1;
12756 if (!htab->opd_abi)
12757 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = 0;
12758 else if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe == -1)
12759 {
12760 static const char *const thread_starter[] =
12761 {
12762 "pthread_create",
12763 /* libstdc++ */
12764 "_ZNSt6thread15_M_start_threadESt10shared_ptrINS_10_Impl_baseEE",
12765 /* librt */
12766 "aio_init", "aio_read", "aio_write", "aio_fsync", "lio_listio",
12767 "mq_notify", "create_timer",
12768 /* libanl */
12769 "getaddrinfo_a",
12770 /* libgomp */
12771 "GOMP_parallel",
12772 "GOMP_parallel_start",
12773 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static",
12774 "GOMP_parallel_loop_static_start",
12775 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic",
12776 "GOMP_parallel_loop_dynamic_start",
12777 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided",
12778 "GOMP_parallel_loop_guided_start",
12779 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime",
12780 "GOMP_parallel_loop_runtime_start",
12781 "GOMP_parallel_sections",
12782 "GOMP_parallel_sections_start",
12783 /* libgo */
12784 "__go_go",
12785 };
12786 unsigned i;
12787
12788 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (thread_starter); i++)
12789 {
12790 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12791 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, thread_starter[i],
12792 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
12793 htab->params->plt_thread_safe = h != NULL && h->ref_regular;
12794 if (htab->params->plt_thread_safe)
12795 break;
12796 }
12797 }
12798 stubs_always_before_branch = htab->params->group_size < 0;
12799 if (htab->params->group_size < 0)
12800 stub_group_size = -htab->params->group_size;
12801 else
12802 stub_group_size = htab->params->group_size;
12803
12804 if (!group_sections (info, stub_group_size, stubs_always_before_branch))
12805 return FALSE;
12806
12807 #define STUB_SHRINK_ITER 20
12808 /* Loop until no stubs added. After iteration 20 of this loop we may
12809 exit on a stub section shrinking. This is to break out of a
12810 pathological case where adding stubs on one iteration decreases
12811 section gaps (perhaps due to alignment), which then requires
12812 fewer or smaller stubs on the next iteration. */
12813
12814 while (1)
12815 {
12816 bfd *input_bfd;
12817 unsigned int bfd_indx;
12818 struct map_stub *group;
12819
12820 htab->stub_iteration += 1;
12821
12822 for (input_bfd = info->input_bfds, bfd_indx = 0;
12823 input_bfd != NULL;
12824 input_bfd = input_bfd->link.next, bfd_indx++)
12825 {
12826 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
12827 asection *section;
12828 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
12829
12830 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
12831 continue;
12832
12833 /* We'll need the symbol table in a second. */
12834 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
12835 if (symtab_hdr->sh_info == 0)
12836 continue;
12837
12838 /* Walk over each section attached to the input bfd. */
12839 for (section = input_bfd->sections;
12840 section != NULL;
12841 section = section->next)
12842 {
12843 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irelaend, *irela;
12844
12845 /* If there aren't any relocs, then there's nothing more
12846 to do. */
12847 if ((section->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
12848 || (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
12849 || (section->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0
12850 || (section->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
12851 || section->reloc_count == 0)
12852 continue;
12853
12854 /* If this section is a link-once section that will be
12855 discarded, then don't create any stubs. */
12856 if (section->output_section == NULL
12857 || section->output_section->owner != info->output_bfd)
12858 continue;
12859
12860 /* Get the relocs. */
12861 internal_relocs
12862 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (input_bfd, section, NULL, NULL,
12863 info->keep_memory);
12864 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12865 goto error_ret_free_local;
12866
12867 /* Now examine each relocation. */
12868 irela = internal_relocs;
12869 irelaend = irela + section->reloc_count;
12870 for (; irela < irelaend; irela++)
12871 {
12872 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
12873 unsigned int r_indx;
12874 enum ppc_stub_type stub_type;
12875 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
12876 asection *sym_sec, *code_sec;
12877 bfd_vma sym_value, code_value;
12878 bfd_vma destination;
12879 unsigned long local_off;
12880 bfd_boolean ok_dest;
12881 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *hash;
12882 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
12883 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
12884 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
12885 char *stub_name;
12886 const asection *id_sec;
12887 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
12888 struct plt_entry *plt_ent;
12889
12890 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (irela->r_info);
12891 r_indx = ELF64_R_SYM (irela->r_info);
12892
12893 if (r_type >= R_PPC64_max)
12894 {
12895 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12896 goto error_ret_free_internal;
12897 }
12898
12899 /* Only look for stubs on branch instructions. */
12900 if (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24
12901 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
12902 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14
12903 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN
12904 && r_type != R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
12905 continue;
12906
12907 /* Now determine the call target, its name, value,
12908 section. */
12909 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
12910 r_indx, input_bfd))
12911 goto error_ret_free_internal;
12912 hash = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h;
12913
12914 ok_dest = FALSE;
12915 fdh = NULL;
12916 sym_value = 0;
12917 if (hash == NULL)
12918 {
12919 sym_value = sym->st_value;
12920 if (sym_sec != NULL
12921 && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12922 ok_dest = TRUE;
12923 }
12924 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12925 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12926 {
12927 sym_value = hash->elf.root.u.def.value;
12928 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12929 ok_dest = TRUE;
12930 }
12931 else if (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
12932 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
12933 {
12934 /* Recognise an old ABI func code entry sym, and
12935 use the func descriptor sym instead if it is
12936 defined. */
12937 if (hash->elf.root.root.string[0] == '.'
12938 && hash->oh != NULL)
12939 {
12940 fdh = ppc_follow_link (hash->oh);
12941 if (fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
12942 || fdh->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
12943 {
12944 sym_sec = fdh->elf.root.u.def.section;
12945 sym_value = fdh->elf.root.u.def.value;
12946 if (sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
12947 ok_dest = TRUE;
12948 }
12949 else
12950 fdh = NULL;
12951 }
12952 }
12953 else
12954 {
12955 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12956 goto error_ret_free_internal;
12957 }
12958
12959 destination = 0;
12960 local_off = 0;
12961 if (ok_dest)
12962 {
12963 sym_value += irela->r_addend;
12964 destination = (sym_value
12965 + sym_sec->output_offset
12966 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
12967 local_off = PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (hash
12968 ? hash->elf.other
12969 : sym->st_other);
12970 }
12971
12972 code_sec = sym_sec;
12973 code_value = sym_value;
12974 opd = get_opd_info (sym_sec);
12975 if (opd != NULL)
12976 {
12977 bfd_vma dest;
12978
12979 if (hash == NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
12980 {
12981 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym_value)];
12982 if (adjust == -1)
12983 continue;
12984 code_value += adjust;
12985 sym_value += adjust;
12986 }
12987 dest = opd_entry_value (sym_sec, sym_value,
12988 &code_sec, &code_value, FALSE);
12989 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
12990 {
12991 destination = dest;
12992 if (fdh != NULL)
12993 {
12994 /* Fixup old ABI sym to point at code
12995 entry. */
12996 hash->elf.root.type = bfd_link_hash_defweak;
12997 hash->elf.root.u.def.section = code_sec;
12998 hash->elf.root.u.def.value = code_value;
12999 }
13000 }
13001 }
13002
13003 /* Determine what (if any) linker stub is needed. */
13004 plt_ent = NULL;
13005 stub_type = ppc_type_of_stub (section, irela, &hash,
13006 &plt_ent, destination,
13007 local_off);
13008
13009 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
13010 {
13011 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13012 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc;
13013 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
13014 || (code_sec != NULL
13015 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13016 && (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13017 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13018 > 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)))
13019 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc;
13020 }
13021 else if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call)
13022 {
13023 /* Check whether we need a TOC adjusting stub.
13024 Since the linker pastes together pieces from
13025 different object files when creating the
13026 _init and _fini functions, it may be that a
13027 call to what looks like a local sym is in
13028 fact a call needing a TOC adjustment. */
13029 if ((code_sec != NULL
13030 && code_sec->output_section != NULL
13031 && (htab->sec_info[code_sec->id].toc_off
13032 != htab->sec_info[section->id].toc_off)
13033 && (code_sec->has_toc_reloc
13034 || code_sec->makes_toc_func_call))
13035 || (((hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other)
13036 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK)
13037 == 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT))
13038 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off;
13039 }
13040
13041 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_none)
13042 continue;
13043
13044 /* __tls_get_addr calls might be eliminated. */
13045 if (stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call
13046 && stub_type != ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
13047 && hash != NULL
13048 && (hash == htab->tls_get_addr
13049 || hash == htab->tls_get_addr_fd)
13050 && section->has_tls_reloc
13051 && irela != internal_relocs)
13052 {
13053 /* Get tls info. */
13054 unsigned char *tls_mask;
13055
13056 if (!get_tls_mask (&tls_mask, NULL, NULL, &local_syms,
13057 irela - 1, input_bfd))
13058 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13059 if ((*tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0)
13060 continue;
13061 }
13062
13063 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13064 {
13065 if (!htab->opd_abi
13066 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
13067 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&hash->elf))
13068 htab->has_plt_localentry0 = 1;
13069 else if (irela + 1 < irelaend
13070 && irela[1].r_offset == irela->r_offset + 4
13071 && (ELF64_R_TYPE (irela[1].r_info)
13072 == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE))
13073 {
13074 if (!tocsave_find (htab, INSERT,
13075 &local_syms, irela + 1, input_bfd))
13076 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13077 }
13078 else
13079 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save;
13080 }
13081
13082 /* Support for grouping stub sections. */
13083 id_sec = htab->sec_info[section->id].u.group->link_sec;
13084
13085 /* Get the name of this stub. */
13086 stub_name = ppc_stub_name (id_sec, sym_sec, hash, irela);
13087 if (!stub_name)
13088 goto error_ret_free_internal;
13089
13090 stub_entry = ppc_stub_hash_lookup (&htab->stub_hash_table,
13091 stub_name, FALSE, FALSE);
13092 if (stub_entry != NULL)
13093 {
13094 enum ppc_stub_type old_type;
13095 /* A stub has already been created, but it may
13096 not be the required type. We shouldn't be
13097 transitioning from plt_call to long_branch
13098 stubs or vice versa, but we might be
13099 upgrading from plt_call to plt_call_r2save or
13100 from long_branch to long_branch_r2off. */
13101 free (stub_name);
13102 old_type = stub_entry->stub_type;
13103 switch (old_type)
13104 {
13105 default:
13106 abort ();
13107
13108 case ppc_stub_save_res:
13109 continue;
13110
13111 case ppc_stub_plt_call:
13112 case ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save:
13113 case ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc:
13114 case ppc_stub_plt_call_both:
13115 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call)
13116 continue;
13117 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13118 {
13119 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13120 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13121 }
13122 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc)
13123 {
13124 if (old_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save)
13125 stub_type = ppc_stub_plt_call_both;
13126 }
13127 else
13128 abort ();
13129 break;
13130
13131 case ppc_stub_plt_branch:
13132 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off:
13133 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc:
13134 case ppc_stub_plt_branch_both:
13135 old_type += (ppc_stub_long_branch
13136 - ppc_stub_plt_branch);
13137 /* Fall through. */
13138 case ppc_stub_long_branch:
13139 case ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off:
13140 case ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc:
13141 case ppc_stub_long_branch_both:
13142 if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch)
13143 continue;
13144 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13145 {
13146 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13147 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13148 }
13149 else if (stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc)
13150 {
13151 if (old_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off)
13152 stub_type = ppc_stub_long_branch_both;
13153 }
13154 else
13155 abort ();
13156 break;
13157 }
13158 if (old_type < stub_type)
13159 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13160 continue;
13161 }
13162
13163 stub_entry = ppc_add_stub (stub_name, section, info);
13164 if (stub_entry == NULL)
13165 {
13166 free (stub_name);
13167 error_ret_free_internal:
13168 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs == NULL)
13169 free (internal_relocs);
13170 error_ret_free_local:
13171 if (local_syms != NULL
13172 && (symtab_hdr->contents
13173 != (unsigned char *) local_syms))
13174 free (local_syms);
13175 return FALSE;
13176 }
13177
13178 stub_entry->stub_type = stub_type;
13179 if (stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
13180 && stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
13181 {
13182 stub_entry->target_value = sym_value;
13183 stub_entry->target_section = sym_sec;
13184 }
13185 else
13186 {
13187 stub_entry->target_value = code_value;
13188 stub_entry->target_section = code_sec;
13189 }
13190 stub_entry->h = hash;
13191 stub_entry->plt_ent = plt_ent;
13192 stub_entry->symtype
13193 = hash ? hash->elf.type : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
13194 stub_entry->other = hash ? hash->elf.other : sym->st_other;
13195
13196 if (hash != NULL
13197 && (hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13198 || hash->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
13199 htab->stub_globals += 1;
13200 }
13201
13202 /* We're done with the internal relocs, free them. */
13203 if (elf_section_data (section)->relocs != internal_relocs)
13204 free (internal_relocs);
13205 }
13206
13207 if (local_syms != NULL
13208 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13209 {
13210 if (!info->keep_memory)
13211 free (local_syms);
13212 else
13213 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
13214 }
13215 }
13216
13217 /* We may have added some stubs. Find out the new size of the
13218 stub sections. */
13219 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13220 {
13221 group->lr_restore = 0;
13222 group->eh_size = 0;
13223 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13224 {
13225 asection *stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
13226
13227 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13228 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size)
13229 /* Past STUB_SHRINK_ITER, rawsize is the max size seen. */
13230 stub_sec->rawsize = stub_sec->size;
13231 stub_sec->size = 0;
13232 stub_sec->reloc_count = 0;
13233 stub_sec->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13234 }
13235 }
13236
13237 if (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13238 || htab->brlt->rawsize < htab->brlt->size)
13239 htab->brlt->rawsize = htab->brlt->size;
13240 htab->brlt->size = 0;
13241 htab->brlt->reloc_count = 0;
13242 htab->brlt->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
13243 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13244 htab->relbrlt->size = 0;
13245
13246 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_size_one_stub, info);
13247
13248 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13249 if (group->needs_save_res)
13250 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
13251
13252 if (info->emitrelocations
13253 && htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13254 {
13255 htab->glink->reloc_count = 1;
13256 htab->glink->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
13257 }
13258
13259 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13260 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
13261 && htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->size > 8)
13262 {
13263 size_t size = 0, align = 4;
13264
13265 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13266 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13267 size += (group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align;
13268 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13269 size += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
13270 if (size != 0)
13271 size += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
13272 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13273 size = (size + align - 1) & -align;
13274 htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize = htab->glink_eh_frame->size;
13275 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size;
13276 }
13277
13278 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
13279 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13280 if (group->stub_sec != NULL)
13281 {
13282 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
13283 group->stub_sec->size
13284 = (group->stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
13285 }
13286
13287 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13288 if (group->stub_sec != NULL
13289 && group->stub_sec->rawsize != group->stub_sec->size
13290 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13291 || group->stub_sec->rawsize < group->stub_sec->size))
13292 break;
13293
13294 if (group == NULL
13295 && (htab->brlt->rawsize == htab->brlt->size
13296 || (htab->stub_iteration > STUB_SHRINK_ITER
13297 && htab->brlt->rawsize > htab->brlt->size))
13298 && (htab->glink_eh_frame == NULL
13299 || htab->glink_eh_frame->rawsize == htab->glink_eh_frame->size))
13300 break;
13301
13302 /* Ask the linker to do its stuff. */
13303 (*htab->params->layout_sections_again) ();
13304 }
13305
13306 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
13307 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
13308 {
13309 bfd_vma val;
13310 bfd_byte *p, *last_fde;
13311 size_t last_fde_len, size, align, pad;
13312 struct map_stub *group;
13313
13314 /* It is necessary to at least have a rough outline of the
13315 linker generated CIEs and FDEs written before
13316 bfd_elf_discard_info is run, in order for these FDEs to be
13317 indexed in .eh_frame_hdr. */
13318 p = bfd_zalloc (htab->glink_eh_frame->owner, htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
13319 if (p == NULL)
13320 return FALSE;
13321 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents = p;
13322 last_fde = p;
13323 align = 4;
13324
13325 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
13326 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
13327 last_fde_len = ((sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13328 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13329 p += last_fde_len + 4;
13330
13331 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13332 if (group->eh_size != 0)
13333 {
13334 group->eh_base = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13335 last_fde = p;
13336 last_fde_len = ((group->eh_size + 17 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13337 /* FDE length. */
13338 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13339 p += 4;
13340 /* CIE pointer. */
13341 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13342 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13343 p += 4;
13344 /* Offset to stub section, written later. */
13345 p += 4;
13346 /* stub section size. */
13347 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, group->stub_sec->size, p);
13348 p += 4;
13349 /* Augmentation. */
13350 p += 1;
13351 /* Make sure we don't have all nops. This is enough for
13352 elf-eh-frame.c to detect the last non-nop opcode. */
13353 p[group->eh_size - 1] = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13354 p = last_fde + last_fde_len + 4;
13355 }
13356 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13357 {
13358 last_fde = p;
13359 last_fde_len = ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 4;
13360 /* FDE length. */
13361 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len, p);
13362 p += 4;
13363 /* CIE pointer. */
13364 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13365 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
13366 p += 4;
13367 /* Offset to .glink, written later. */
13368 p += 4;
13369 /* .glink size. */
13370 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size - 8, p);
13371 p += 4;
13372 /* Augmentation. */
13373 p += 1;
13374
13375 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 1;
13376 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
13377 *p++ = 65;
13378 *p++ = htab->opd_abi ? 12 : 0;
13379 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + (htab->opd_abi ? 5 : 7);
13380 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
13381 *p++ = 65;
13382 p += ((24 + align - 1) & -align) - 24;
13383 }
13384 /* Subsume any padding into the last FDE if user .eh_frame
13385 sections are aligned more than glink_eh_frame. Otherwise any
13386 zero padding will be seen as a terminator. */
13387 align = 1ul << htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->alignment_power;
13388 size = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
13389 pad = ((size + align - 1) & -align) - size;
13390 htab->glink_eh_frame->size = size + pad;
13391 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, last_fde_len + pad, last_fde);
13392 }
13393
13394 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->brlt);
13395 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL)
13396 maybe_strip_output (info, htab->glink_eh_frame);
13397
13398 return TRUE;
13399 }
13400
13401 /* Called after we have determined section placement. If sections
13402 move, we'll be called again. Provide a value for TOCstart. */
13403
13404 bfd_vma
13405 ppc64_elf_set_toc (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *obfd)
13406 {
13407 asection *s;
13408 bfd_vma TOCstart, adjust;
13409
13410 if (info != NULL)
13411 {
13412 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13413 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
13414
13415 if (is_elf_hash_table (htab)
13416 && htab->hgot != NULL)
13417 h = htab->hgot;
13418 else
13419 {
13420 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, ".TOC.", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
13421 if (is_elf_hash_table (htab))
13422 htab->hgot = h;
13423 }
13424 if (h != NULL
13425 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13426 && !h->root.linker_def
13427 && (!is_elf_hash_table (htab)
13428 || h->def_regular))
13429 {
13430 TOCstart = (h->root.u.def.value - TOC_BASE_OFF
13431 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
13432 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
13433 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13434 return TOCstart;
13435 }
13436 }
13437
13438 /* The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, .plt in that
13439 order. The TOC starts where the first of these sections starts. */
13440 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".got");
13441 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13442 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".toc");
13443 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13444 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".tocbss");
13445 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13446 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (obfd, ".plt");
13447 if (s == NULL || (s->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
13448 {
13449 /* This may happen for
13450 o references to TOC base (SYM@toc / TOC[tc0]) without a
13451 .toc directive
13452 o bad linker script
13453 o --gc-sections and empty TOC sections
13454
13455 FIXME: Warn user? */
13456
13457 /* Look for a likely section. We probably won't even be
13458 using TOCstart. */
13459 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13460 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_READONLY
13461 | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13462 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
13463 break;
13464 if (s == NULL)
13465 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13466 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13467 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_SMALL_DATA))
13468 break;
13469 if (s == NULL)
13470 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13471 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_READONLY | SEC_EXCLUDE))
13472 == SEC_ALLOC)
13473 break;
13474 if (s == NULL)
13475 for (s = obfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
13476 if ((s->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_ALLOC)
13477 break;
13478 }
13479
13480 TOCstart = 0;
13481 if (s != NULL)
13482 TOCstart = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
13483
13484 /* Force alignment. */
13485 adjust = TOCstart & (TOC_BASE_ALIGN - 1);
13486 TOCstart -= adjust;
13487 _bfd_set_gp_value (obfd, TOCstart);
13488
13489 if (info != NULL && s != NULL)
13490 {
13491 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13492
13493 if (htab != NULL)
13494 {
13495 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
13496 {
13497 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust;
13498 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section = s;
13499 }
13500 }
13501 else
13502 {
13503 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = NULL;
13504 _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, obfd, ".TOC.", BSF_GLOBAL,
13505 s, TOC_BASE_OFF - adjust,
13506 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &bh);
13507 }
13508 }
13509 return TOCstart;
13510 }
13511
13512 /* Called via elf_link_hash_traverse from ppc64_elf_build_stubs to
13513 write out any global entry stubs, and PLT relocations. */
13514
13515 static bfd_boolean
13516 build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
13517 {
13518 struct bfd_link_info *info;
13519 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
13520 struct plt_entry *ent;
13521 asection *s;
13522
13523 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
13524 return TRUE;
13525
13526 info = inf;
13527 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13528 if (htab == NULL)
13529 return FALSE;
13530
13531 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
13532 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13533 {
13534 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage
13535 table. Set it up. */
13536 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
13537 asection *plt, *relplt;
13538 bfd_byte *loc;
13539
13540 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
13541 || h->dynindx == -1)
13542 {
13543 if (!(h->def_regular
13544 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13545 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)))
13546 continue;
13547 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13548 {
13549 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
13550 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
13551 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
13552 if (htab->opd_abi)
13553 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
13554 else
13555 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
13556 }
13557 else
13558 {
13559 plt = htab->pltlocal;
13560 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
13561 {
13562 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
13563 if (htab->opd_abi)
13564 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
13565 else
13566 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
13567 }
13568 else
13569 relplt = NULL;
13570 }
13571 rela.r_addend = (h->root.u.def.value
13572 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
13573 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
13574 + ent->addend);
13575
13576 if (relplt == NULL)
13577 {
13578 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
13579 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
13580 if (htab->opd_abi)
13581 {
13582 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (info->output_bfd);
13583 toc += htab->sec_info[h->root.u.def.section->id].toc_off;
13584 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
13585 }
13586 }
13587 else
13588 {
13589 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
13590 + plt->output_offset
13591 + ent->plt.offset);
13592 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
13593 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
13594 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
13595 }
13596 }
13597 else
13598 {
13599 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
13600 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
13601 + ent->plt.offset);
13602 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
13603 rela.r_addend = ent->addend;
13604 loc = (htab->elf.srelplt->contents
13605 + ((ent->plt.offset - PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE (htab))
13606 / PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab) * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)));
13607 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
13608 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
13609 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
13610 }
13611 }
13612
13613 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
13614 return TRUE;
13615
13616 if (h->def_regular)
13617 return TRUE;
13618
13619 s = htab->global_entry;
13620 if (s == NULL || s->size == 0)
13621 return TRUE;
13622
13623 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
13624 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
13625 && ent->addend == 0)
13626 {
13627 bfd_byte *p;
13628 asection *plt;
13629 bfd_vma off;
13630
13631 p = s->contents + h->root.u.def.value;
13632 plt = htab->elf.splt;
13633 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
13634 || h->dynindx == -1)
13635 {
13636 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13637 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
13638 else
13639 plt = htab->pltlocal;
13640 }
13641 off = ent->plt.offset + plt->output_offset + plt->output_section->vma;
13642 off -= h->root.u.def.value + s->output_offset + s->output_section->vma;
13643
13644 if (off + 0x80008000 > 0xffffffff || (off & 3) != 0)
13645 {
13646 info->callbacks->einfo
13647 (_("%P: linkage table error against `%pT'\n"),
13648 h->root.root.string);
13649 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13650 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
13651 }
13652
13653 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1] += 1;
13654 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
13655 {
13656 size_t len = strlen (h->root.root.string);
13657 char *name = bfd_malloc (sizeof "12345678.global_entry." + len);
13658
13659 if (name == NULL)
13660 return FALSE;
13661
13662 sprintf (name, "%08x.global_entry.%s", s->id, h->root.root.string);
13663 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
13664 if (h == NULL)
13665 return FALSE;
13666 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
13667 {
13668 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13669 h->root.u.def.section = s;
13670 h->root.u.def.value = p - s->contents;
13671 h->ref_regular = 1;
13672 h->def_regular = 1;
13673 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
13674 h->forced_local = 1;
13675 h->non_elf = 0;
13676 h->root.linker_def = 1;
13677 }
13678 }
13679
13680 if (PPC_HA (off) != 0)
13681 {
13682 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, ADDIS_R12_R12 | PPC_HA (off), p);
13683 p += 4;
13684 }
13685 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, LD_R12_0R12 | PPC_LO (off), p);
13686 p += 4;
13687 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
13688 p += 4;
13689 bfd_put_32 (s->owner, BCTR, p);
13690 break;
13691 }
13692 return TRUE;
13693 }
13694
13695 /* Write PLT relocs for locals. */
13696
13697 static bfd_boolean
13698 write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
13699 {
13700 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13701 bfd *ibfd;
13702
13703 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
13704 {
13705 struct got_entry **lgot_ents, **end_lgot_ents;
13706 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
13707 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13708 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
13709 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
13710 struct plt_entry *ent;
13711
13712 if (!is_ppc64_elf (ibfd))
13713 continue;
13714
13715 lgot_ents = elf_local_got_ents (ibfd);
13716 if (!lgot_ents)
13717 continue;
13718
13719 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
13720 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
13721 end_lgot_ents = lgot_ents + locsymcount;
13722 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_lgot_ents;
13723 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
13724 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
13725 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
13726 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
13727 {
13728 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
13729 asection *sym_sec;
13730 asection *plt, *relplt;
13731 bfd_byte *loc;
13732 bfd_vma val;
13733
13734 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
13735 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
13736 {
13737 if (local_syms != NULL
13738 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13739 free (local_syms);
13740 return FALSE;
13741 }
13742
13743 val = sym->st_value + ent->addend;
13744 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13745 val += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (sym->st_other);
13746 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
13747 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
13748
13749 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13750 {
13751 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
13752 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
13753 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
13754 }
13755 else
13756 {
13757 plt = htab->pltlocal;
13758 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
13759 }
13760
13761 if (relplt == NULL)
13762 {
13763 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
13764 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
13765 if (htab->opd_abi)
13766 {
13767 bfd_vma toc = elf_gp (ibfd);
13768 bfd_put_64 (info->output_bfd, toc, loc + 8);
13769 }
13770 }
13771 else
13772 {
13773 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
13774 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
13775 + plt->output_offset
13776 + plt->output_section->vma);
13777 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
13778 {
13779 if (htab->opd_abi)
13780 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_IREL);
13781 else
13782 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
13783 }
13784 else
13785 {
13786 if (htab->opd_abi)
13787 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT);
13788 else
13789 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
13790 }
13791 rela.r_addend = val;
13792 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
13793 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
13794 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
13795 }
13796 }
13797
13798 if (local_syms != NULL
13799 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
13800 {
13801 if (!info->keep_memory)
13802 free (local_syms);
13803 else
13804 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
13805 }
13806 }
13807 return TRUE;
13808 }
13809
13810 /* Build all the stubs associated with the current output file.
13811 The stubs are kept in a hash table attached to the main linker
13812 hash table. This function is called via gldelf64ppc_finish. */
13813
13814 bfd_boolean
13815 ppc64_elf_build_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
13816 char **stats)
13817 {
13818 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
13819 struct map_stub *group;
13820 asection *stub_sec;
13821 bfd_byte *p;
13822 int stub_sec_count = 0;
13823
13824 if (htab == NULL)
13825 return FALSE;
13826
13827 /* Allocate memory to hold the linker stubs. */
13828 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13829 {
13830 group->eh_size = 0;
13831 group->lr_restore = 0;
13832 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL
13833 && stub_sec->size != 0)
13834 {
13835 stub_sec->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->params->stub_bfd,
13836 stub_sec->size);
13837 if (stub_sec->contents == NULL)
13838 return FALSE;
13839 stub_sec->size = 0;
13840 }
13841 }
13842
13843 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
13844 {
13845 unsigned int indx;
13846 bfd_vma plt0;
13847
13848 /* Build the .glink plt call stub. */
13849 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
13850 {
13851 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13852 h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
13853 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
13854 if (h == NULL)
13855 return FALSE;
13856 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
13857 {
13858 h->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
13859 h->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
13860 h->root.u.def.value = 8;
13861 h->ref_regular = 1;
13862 h->def_regular = 1;
13863 h->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
13864 h->forced_local = 1;
13865 h->non_elf = 0;
13866 h->root.linker_def = 1;
13867 }
13868 }
13869 plt0 = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
13870 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
13871 - 16);
13872 if (info->emitrelocations)
13873 {
13874 Elf_Internal_Rela *r = get_relocs (htab->glink, 1);
13875 if (r == NULL)
13876 return FALSE;
13877 r->r_offset = (htab->glink->output_offset
13878 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
13879 r->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_REL64);
13880 r->r_addend = plt0;
13881 }
13882 p = htab->glink->contents;
13883 plt0 -= htab->glink->output_section->vma + htab->glink->output_offset;
13884 bfd_put_64 (htab->glink->owner, plt0, p);
13885 p += 8;
13886 if (htab->opd_abi)
13887 {
13888 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R12, p);
13889 p += 4;
13890 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
13891 p += 4;
13892 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
13893 p += 4;
13894 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
13895 p += 4;
13896 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R12, p);
13897 p += 4;
13898 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
13899 p += 4;
13900 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
13901 p += 4;
13902 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | 8, p);
13903 p += 4;
13904 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
13905 p += 4;
13906 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 16, p);
13907 p += 4;
13908 }
13909 else
13910 {
13911 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R0, p);
13912 p += 4;
13913 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCL_20_31, p);
13914 p += 4;
13915 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MFLR_R11, p);
13916 p += 4;
13917 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, STD_R2_0R1 + 24, p);
13918 p += 4;
13919 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R2_0R11 | (-16 & 0xfffc), p);
13920 p += 4;
13921 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTLR_R0, p);
13922 p += 4;
13923 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SUB_R12_R12_R11, p);
13924 p += 4;
13925 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADD_R11_R2_R11, p);
13926 p += 4;
13927 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ADDI_R0_R12 | (-48 & 0xffff), p);
13928 p += 4;
13929 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R12_0R11, p);
13930 p += 4;
13931 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, SRDI_R0_R0_2, p);
13932 p += 4;
13933 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, MTCTR_R12, p);
13934 p += 4;
13935 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LD_R11_0R11 | 8, p);
13936 p += 4;
13937 }
13938 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, BCTR, p);
13939 p += 4;
13940 BFD_ASSERT (p == htab->glink->contents + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab));
13941
13942 /* Build the .glink lazy link call stubs. */
13943 indx = 0;
13944 while (p < htab->glink->contents + htab->glink->size)
13945 {
13946 if (htab->opd_abi)
13947 {
13948 if (indx < 0x8000)
13949 {
13950 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LI_R0_0 | indx, p);
13951 p += 4;
13952 }
13953 else
13954 {
13955 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, LIS_R0_0 | PPC_HI (indx), p);
13956 p += 4;
13957 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner, ORI_R0_R0_0 | PPC_LO (indx),
13958 p);
13959 p += 4;
13960 }
13961 }
13962 bfd_put_32 (htab->glink->owner,
13963 B_DOT | ((htab->glink->contents - p + 8) & 0x3fffffc), p);
13964 indx++;
13965 p += 4;
13966 }
13967 }
13968
13969 /* Build .glink global entry stubs, and PLT relocs for globals. */
13970 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, build_global_entry_stubs_and_plt, info);
13971
13972 if (!write_plt_relocs_for_local_syms (info))
13973 return FALSE;
13974
13975 if (htab->brlt != NULL && htab->brlt->size != 0)
13976 {
13977 htab->brlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->brlt->owner,
13978 htab->brlt->size);
13979 if (htab->brlt->contents == NULL)
13980 return FALSE;
13981 }
13982 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL && htab->relbrlt->size != 0)
13983 {
13984 htab->relbrlt->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->relbrlt->owner,
13985 htab->relbrlt->size);
13986 if (htab->relbrlt->contents == NULL)
13987 return FALSE;
13988 }
13989
13990 /* Build the stubs as directed by the stub hash table. */
13991 bfd_hash_traverse (&htab->stub_hash_table, ppc_build_one_stub, info);
13992
13993 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
13994 if (group->needs_save_res)
13995 group->stub_sec->size += htab->sfpr->size;
13996
13997 if (htab->relbrlt != NULL)
13998 htab->relbrlt->reloc_count = 0;
13999
14000 if (htab->params->plt_stub_align != 0)
14001 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14002 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14003 {
14004 int align = abs (htab->params->plt_stub_align);
14005 stub_sec->size = (stub_sec->size + (1 << align) - 1) & -(1 << align);
14006 }
14007
14008 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14009 if (group->needs_save_res)
14010 {
14011 stub_sec = group->stub_sec;
14012 memcpy (stub_sec->contents + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size,
14013 htab->sfpr->contents, htab->sfpr->size);
14014 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
14015 {
14016 unsigned int i;
14017
14018 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (save_res_funcs); i++)
14019 if (!sfpr_define (info, &save_res_funcs[i], stub_sec))
14020 return FALSE;
14021 }
14022 }
14023
14024 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
14025 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0)
14026 {
14027 bfd_vma val;
14028 size_t align = 4;
14029
14030 p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
14031 p += (sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + align - 1) & -align;
14032
14033 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14034 if (group->eh_size != 0)
14035 {
14036 /* Offset to stub section. */
14037 val = (group->stub_sec->output_section->vma
14038 + group->stub_sec->output_offset);
14039 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14040 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14041 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14042 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14043 {
14044 _bfd_error_handler
14045 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14046 group->stub_sec->name);
14047 return FALSE;
14048 }
14049 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14050 p += (group->eh_size + 17 + 3) & -4;
14051 }
14052 if (htab->glink != NULL && htab->glink->size != 0)
14053 {
14054 /* Offset to .glink. */
14055 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
14056 + htab->glink->output_offset
14057 + 8);
14058 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
14059 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset
14060 + (p + 8 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents));
14061 if (val + 0x80000000 > 0xffffffff)
14062 {
14063 _bfd_error_handler
14064 (_("%s offset too large for .eh_frame sdata4 encoding"),
14065 htab->glink->name);
14066 return FALSE;
14067 }
14068 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p + 8);
14069 p += (24 + align - 1) & -align;
14070 }
14071 }
14072
14073 for (group = htab->group; group != NULL; group = group->next)
14074 if ((stub_sec = group->stub_sec) != NULL)
14075 {
14076 stub_sec_count += 1;
14077 if (stub_sec->rawsize != stub_sec->size
14078 && (htab->stub_iteration <= STUB_SHRINK_ITER
14079 || stub_sec->rawsize < stub_sec->size))
14080 break;
14081 }
14082
14083 if (group != NULL)
14084 {
14085 htab->stub_error = TRUE;
14086 _bfd_error_handler (_("stubs don't match calculated size"));
14087 }
14088
14089 if (htab->stub_error)
14090 return FALSE;
14091
14092 if (stats != NULL)
14093 {
14094 size_t len;
14095 *stats = bfd_malloc (500);
14096 if (*stats == NULL)
14097 return FALSE;
14098
14099 len = sprintf (*stats,
14100 ngettext ("linker stubs in %u group\n",
14101 "linker stubs in %u groups\n",
14102 stub_sec_count),
14103 stub_sec_count);
14104 sprintf (*stats + len, _(" branch %lu\n"
14105 " branch toc adj %lu\n"
14106 " branch notoc %lu\n"
14107 " branch both %lu\n"
14108 " long branch %lu\n"
14109 " long toc adj %lu\n"
14110 " long notoc %lu\n"
14111 " long both %lu\n"
14112 " plt call %lu\n"
14113 " plt call save %lu\n"
14114 " plt call notoc %lu\n"
14115 " plt call both %lu\n"
14116 " global entry %lu"),
14117 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch - 1],
14118 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off - 1],
14119 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc - 1],
14120 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_long_branch_both - 1],
14121 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch - 1],
14122 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off - 1],
14123 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc - 1],
14124 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_branch_both - 1],
14125 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call - 1],
14126 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save - 1],
14127 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc - 1],
14128 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_plt_call_both - 1],
14129 htab->stub_count[ppc_stub_global_entry - 1]);
14130 }
14131 return TRUE;
14132 }
14133
14134 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
14135 discarded sections. */
14136
14137 static unsigned int
14138 ppc64_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
14139 {
14140 if (strcmp (".opd", sec->name) == 0)
14141 return 0;
14142
14143 if (strcmp (".toc", sec->name) == 0)
14144 return 0;
14145
14146 if (strcmp (".toc1", sec->name) == 0)
14147 return 0;
14148
14149 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
14150 }
14151
14152 /* These are the dynamic relocations supported by glibc. */
14153
14154 static bfd_boolean
14155 ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type)
14156 {
14157 switch (r_type)
14158 {
14159 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
14160 case R_PPC64_NONE:
14161 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
14162 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
14163 case R_PPC64_IRELATIVE:
14164 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
14165 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
14166 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
14167 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
14168 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
14169 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14170 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
14171 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
14172 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
14173 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
14174 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
14175 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
14176 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
14177 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
14178 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
14179 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
14180 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
14181 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
14182 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
14183 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
14184 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
14185 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
14186 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
14187 case R_PPC64_REL30:
14188 case R_PPC64_COPY:
14189 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
14190 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
14191 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
14192 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
14193 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
14194 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
14195 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
14196 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
14197 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
14198 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
14199 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
14200 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
14201 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
14202 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
14203 case R_PPC64_REL32:
14204 case R_PPC64_REL64:
14205 return TRUE;
14206
14207 default:
14208 return FALSE;
14209 }
14210 }
14211
14212 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
14213 to handle the relocations for a section.
14214
14215 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
14216 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
14217 zero.
14218
14219 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
14220 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
14221 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
14222 necessary.
14223
14224 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
14225 address or the reloc symbol index.
14226
14227 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
14228
14229 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
14230 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
14231
14232 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
14233 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
14234
14235 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
14236 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
14237 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
14238 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
14239 accordingly. */
14240
14241 static bfd_boolean
14242 ppc64_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
14243 struct bfd_link_info *info,
14244 bfd *input_bfd,
14245 asection *input_section,
14246 bfd_byte *contents,
14247 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
14248 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
14249 asection **local_sections)
14250 {
14251 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
14252 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
14253 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
14254 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
14255 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
14256 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
14257 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
14258 bfd_byte *loc;
14259 struct got_entry **local_got_ents;
14260 bfd_vma TOCstart;
14261 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
14262 bfd_boolean is_opd;
14263 /* Assume 'at' branch hints. */
14264 bfd_boolean is_isa_v2 = TRUE;
14265 bfd_boolean warned_dynamic = FALSE;
14266 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
14267
14268 /* Initialize howto table if needed. */
14269 if (!ppc64_elf_howto_table[R_PPC64_ADDR32])
14270 ppc_howto_init ();
14271
14272 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
14273 if (htab == NULL)
14274 return FALSE;
14275
14276 /* Don't relocate stub sections. */
14277 if (input_section->owner == htab->params->stub_bfd)
14278 return TRUE;
14279
14280 if (!is_ppc64_elf (input_bfd))
14281 {
14282 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
14283 return FALSE;
14284 }
14285
14286 local_got_ents = elf_local_got_ents (input_bfd);
14287 TOCstart = elf_gp (output_bfd);
14288 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
14289 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
14290 is_opd = ppc64_elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_type == sec_opd;
14291
14292 rel = wrel = relocs;
14293 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
14294 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
14295 {
14296 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
14297 bfd_vma addend;
14298 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
14299 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
14300 asection *sec;
14301 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h_elf;
14302 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *h;
14303 struct ppc_link_hash_entry *fdh;
14304 const char *sym_name;
14305 unsigned long r_symndx, toc_symndx;
14306 bfd_vma toc_addend;
14307 unsigned char tls_mask, tls_gd, tls_type;
14308 unsigned char sym_type;
14309 bfd_vma relocation;
14310 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
14311 bfd_boolean warned;
14312 enum { DEST_NORMAL, DEST_OPD, DEST_STUB } reloc_dest;
14313 unsigned int insn;
14314 unsigned int mask;
14315 struct ppc_stub_hash_entry *stub_entry;
14316 bfd_vma max_br_offset;
14317 bfd_vma from;
14318 Elf_Internal_Rela orig_rel;
14319 reloc_howto_type *howto;
14320 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
14321 uint64_t pinsn;
14322 bfd_vma offset;
14323
14324 again:
14325 orig_rel = *rel;
14326
14327 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
14328 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
14329
14330 /* For old style R_PPC64_TOC relocs with a zero symbol, use the
14331 symbol of the previous ADDR64 reloc. The symbol gives us the
14332 proper TOC base to use. */
14333 if (rel->r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_TOC)
14334 && wrel != relocs
14335 && ELF64_R_TYPE (wrel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC64_ADDR64
14336 && is_opd)
14337 r_symndx = ELF64_R_SYM (wrel[-1].r_info);
14338
14339 sym = NULL;
14340 sec = NULL;
14341 h_elf = NULL;
14342 sym_name = NULL;
14343 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14344 warned = FALSE;
14345
14346 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
14347 {
14348 /* It's a local symbol. */
14349 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
14350
14351 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
14352 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
14353 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
14354 sym_type = ELF64_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
14355 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
14356 opd = get_opd_info (sec);
14357 if (opd != NULL && opd->adjust != NULL)
14358 {
14359 long adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (sym->st_value
14360 + rel->r_addend)];
14361 if (adjust == -1)
14362 relocation = 0;
14363 else
14364 {
14365 /* If this is a relocation against the opd section sym
14366 and we have edited .opd, adjust the reloc addend so
14367 that ld -r and ld --emit-relocs output is correct.
14368 If it is a reloc against some other .opd symbol,
14369 then the symbol value will be adjusted later. */
14370 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
14371 rel->r_addend += adjust;
14372 else
14373 relocation += adjust;
14374 }
14375 }
14376 }
14377 else
14378 {
14379 bfd_boolean ignored;
14380
14381 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
14382 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
14383 h_elf, sec, relocation,
14384 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
14385 sym_name = h_elf->root.root.string;
14386 sym_type = h_elf->type;
14387 if (sec != NULL
14388 && sec->owner == output_bfd
14389 && strcmp (sec->name, ".opd") == 0)
14390 {
14391 /* This is a symbol defined in a linker script. All
14392 such are defined in output sections, even those
14393 defined by simple assignment from a symbol defined in
14394 an input section. Transfer the symbol to an
14395 appropriate input .opd section, so that a branch to
14396 this symbol will be mapped to the location specified
14397 by the opd entry. */
14398 struct bfd_link_order *lo;
14399 for (lo = sec->map_head.link_order; lo != NULL; lo = lo->next)
14400 if (lo->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
14401 {
14402 asection *isec = lo->u.indirect.section;
14403 if (h_elf->root.u.def.value >= isec->output_offset
14404 && h_elf->root.u.def.value < (isec->output_offset
14405 + isec->size))
14406 {
14407 h_elf->root.u.def.value -= isec->output_offset;
14408 h_elf->root.u.def.section = isec;
14409 sec = isec;
14410 break;
14411 }
14412 }
14413 }
14414 }
14415 h = (struct ppc_link_hash_entry *) h_elf;
14416
14417 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
14418 {
14419 _bfd_clear_contents (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type],
14420 input_bfd, input_section,
14421 contents, rel->r_offset);
14422 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
14423 wrel->r_info = 0;
14424 wrel->r_addend = 0;
14425
14426 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
14427 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
14428 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
14429 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
14430 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
14431 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
14432 wrel--;
14433
14434 continue;
14435 }
14436
14437 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
14438 goto copy_reloc;
14439
14440 if (h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot)
14441 {
14442 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
14443 sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
14444 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
14445 }
14446
14447 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
14448 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
14449 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
14450 for the final instruction stream. */
14451 tls_mask = 0;
14452 tls_gd = 0;
14453 toc_symndx = 0;
14454 if (h != NULL)
14455 tls_mask = h->tls_mask;
14456 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
14457 {
14458 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
14459 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14460 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
14461 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
14462 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
14463 }
14464 if (((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0 || tls_mask == (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
14465 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
14466 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
14467 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
14468 {
14469 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
14470 unsigned char *toc_tls;
14471
14472 if (!get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
14473 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
14474 return FALSE;
14475
14476 if (toc_tls)
14477 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
14478 }
14479
14480 /* Check that tls relocs are used with tls syms, and non-tls
14481 relocs are used with non-tls syms. */
14482 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
14483 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE
14484 && (h == NULL
14485 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
14486 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
14487 && IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
14488 {
14489 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14490 && (r_type == R_PPC64_TLS
14491 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSGD
14492 || r_type == R_PPC64_TLSLD))
14493 /* R_PPC64_TLS is OK against a symbol in the TOC. */
14494 ;
14495 else
14496 info->callbacks->einfo
14497 (!IS_PPC64_TLS_RELOC (r_type)
14498 /* xgettext:c-format */
14499 ? _("%H: %s used with TLS symbol `%pT'\n")
14500 /* xgettext:c-format */
14501 : _("%H: %s used with non-TLS symbol `%pT'\n"),
14502 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
14503 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
14504 sym_name);
14505 }
14506
14507 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
14508 if (R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS != R_PPC64_TOC16_DS + 1
14509 || R_PPC64_TOC16_LO != R_PPC64_TOC16 + 1
14510 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
14511 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
14512 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
14513 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
14514 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS & 3)
14515 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS & 3)
14516 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
14517 || (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
14518 abort ();
14519
14520 switch (r_type)
14521 {
14522 default:
14523 break;
14524
14525 case R_PPC64_LO_DS_OPT:
14526 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14527 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 58u << 26)
14528 abort ();
14529 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
14530 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14531 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
14532 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14533 break;
14534
14535 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
14536 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
14537 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
14538 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
14539 {
14540 /* Check for toc tls entries. */
14541 unsigned char *toc_tls;
14542 int retval;
14543
14544 retval = get_tls_mask (&toc_tls, &toc_symndx, &toc_addend,
14545 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd);
14546 if (retval == 0)
14547 return FALSE;
14548
14549 if (toc_tls)
14550 {
14551 tls_mask = *toc_tls;
14552 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_DS
14553 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS)
14554 {
14555 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14556 && (tls_mask & (TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL)) == 0)
14557 goto toctprel;
14558 }
14559 else
14560 {
14561 /* If we found a GD reloc pair, then we might be
14562 doing a GD->IE transition. */
14563 if (retval == 2)
14564 {
14565 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
14566 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14567 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
14568 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
14569 }
14570 else if (retval == 3)
14571 {
14572 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14573 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
14574 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
14575 }
14576 }
14577 }
14578 }
14579 break;
14580
14581 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
14582 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
14583 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14584 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
14585 {
14586 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
14587 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
14588 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14589 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14590 }
14591 break;
14592
14593 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
14594 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
14595 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14596 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
14597 {
14598 toctprel:
14599 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
14600 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14601 insn &= 31 << 21;
14602 insn |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis 0,13,0 */
14603 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
14604 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14605 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
14606 if (toc_symndx != 0)
14607 {
14608 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
14609 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
14610 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
14611 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
14612 goto again;
14613 }
14614 else
14615 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14616 }
14617 break;
14618
14619 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
14620 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14621 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
14622 {
14623 /* pld ra,sym@got@tprel@pcrel -> paddi ra,r13,sym@tprel */
14624 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
14625 pinsn <<= 32;
14626 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14627 pinsn += ((2ULL << 56) + (-1ULL << 52)
14628 + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26) + (13ULL << 16));
14629 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
14630 contents + rel->r_offset);
14631 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
14632 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14633 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
14634 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14635 }
14636 break;
14637
14638 case R_PPC64_TLS:
14639 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
14640 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
14641 {
14642 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
14643 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 13);
14644 if (insn == 0)
14645 break;
14646 if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 0)
14647 {
14648 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
14649 /* Was PPC64_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
14650 PPC64_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
14651 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
14652 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
14653 if (toc_symndx != 0)
14654 {
14655 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (toc_symndx, r_type);
14656 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
14657 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order to
14658 get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
14659 goto again;
14660 }
14661 else
14662 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14663 }
14664 else if ((rel->r_offset & 3) == 1)
14665 {
14666 /* For pcrel IE to LE we already have the full
14667 offset and thus don't need an addi here. A nop
14668 or mr will do. */
14669 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14 << 26)
14670 {
14671 /* Extract regs from addi rt,ra,si. */
14672 unsigned int rt = (insn >> 21) & 0x1f;
14673 unsigned int ra = (insn >> 16) & 0x1f;
14674 if (rt == ra)
14675 insn = NOP;
14676 else
14677 {
14678 /* Build or ra,rs,rb with rb==rs, ie. mr ra,rs. */
14679 insn = (rt << 16) | (ra << 21) | (ra << 11);
14680 insn |= (31u << 26) | (444u << 1);
14681 }
14682 }
14683 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset - 1);
14684 }
14685 }
14686 break;
14687
14688 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
14689 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
14690 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
14691 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
14692 goto tls_gdld_hi;
14693 break;
14694
14695 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
14696 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
14697 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
14698 {
14699 tls_gdld_hi:
14700 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
14701 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
14702 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
14703 else
14704 {
14705 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
14706 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
14707 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14708 }
14709 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14710 }
14711 break;
14712
14713 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
14714 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
14715 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
14716 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
14717 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
14718 break;
14719
14720 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
14721 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
14722 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
14723 {
14724 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
14725
14726 tls_ldgd_opt:
14727 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
14728 /* If not using the newer R_PPC64_TLSGD/LD to mark
14729 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
14730 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
14731 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
14732 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
14733 if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
14734 && rel + 1 < relend
14735 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
14736 htab->tls_get_addr,
14737 htab->tls_get_addr_fd))
14738 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
14739 /* We read the low GOT_TLS (or TOC16) insn because we
14740 need to keep the destination reg. It may be
14741 something other than the usual r3, and moved to r3
14742 before the call by intervening code. */
14743 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
14744 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14745 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
14746 {
14747 /* IE */
14748 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
14749 insn1 |= 58 << 26; /* ld */
14750 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
14751 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14752 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
14753 if (r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16
14754 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC16_LO)
14755 r_type += R_PPC64_TOC16_DS - R_PPC64_TOC16;
14756 else
14757 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16 & 1)) & 1)
14758 + R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS);
14759 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14760 }
14761 else
14762 {
14763 /* LE */
14764 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
14765 insn1 |= 0x3c0d0000; /* addis r,13,0 */
14766 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
14767 if (tls_gd == 0)
14768 {
14769 /* Was an LD reloc. */
14770 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
14771 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
14772 }
14773 else if (toc_symndx != 0)
14774 {
14775 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
14776 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
14777 }
14778 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA;
14779 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14780 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14781 {
14782 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx,
14783 R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO);
14784 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
14785 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
14786 }
14787 }
14788 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
14789 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
14790 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
14791 {
14792 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
14793 if (offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
14794 {
14795 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
14796 if (insn2 == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
14797 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
14798 }
14799 }
14800 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) == 0
14801 && (tls_gd == 0 || toc_symndx != 0))
14802 {
14803 /* We changed the symbol. Start over in order
14804 to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
14805 goto again;
14806 }
14807 }
14808 break;
14809
14810 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
14811 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
14812 {
14813 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
14814 pinsn <<= 32;
14815 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14816 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
14817 {
14818 /* IE, pla -> pld */
14819 pinsn += (-2ULL << 56) + (57ULL << 26) - (14ULL << 26);
14820 r_type = R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34;
14821 }
14822 else
14823 {
14824 /* LE, pla pcrel -> paddi r13 */
14825 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
14826 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
14827 }
14828 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14829 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
14830 contents + rel->r_offset);
14831 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
14832 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14833 }
14834 break;
14835
14836 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
14837 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
14838 {
14839 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
14840 pinsn <<= 32;
14841 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14842 pinsn += (-1ULL << 52) + (13ULL << 16);
14843 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
14844 contents + rel->r_offset);
14845 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn & 0xffffffff,
14846 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
14847 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
14848 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
14849 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL34;
14850 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14851 goto again;
14852 }
14853 break;
14854
14855 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
14856 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
14857 && rel + 1 < relend)
14858 {
14859 unsigned int insn2;
14860 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
14861
14862 offset = rel->r_offset;
14863 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
14864 {
14865 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
14866 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
14867 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
14868 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
14869 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
14870 break;
14871 }
14872
14873 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
14874 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
14875
14876 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
14877 {
14878 /* IE */
14879 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14880 insn2 = 0x7c636a14; /* add 3,3,13 */
14881 }
14882 else
14883 {
14884 /* LE */
14885 if (toc_symndx != 0)
14886 {
14887 r_symndx = toc_symndx;
14888 rel->r_addend = toc_addend;
14889 }
14890 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
14891 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
14892 {
14893 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14894 insn2 = NOP;
14895 }
14896 else
14897 {
14898 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
14899 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
14900 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
14901 }
14902 }
14903 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14904 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
14905 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
14906 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
14907 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
14908 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) == 0
14909 && toc_symndx != 0
14910 && r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
14911 goto again;
14912 }
14913 break;
14914
14915 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
14916 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
14917 && rel + 1 < relend)
14918 {
14919 unsigned int insn2;
14920 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type1 = ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
14921
14922 offset = rel->r_offset;
14923 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (r_type1))
14924 {
14925 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
14926 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34
14927 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC)
14928 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
14929 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
14930 break;
14931 }
14932
14933 if (ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
14934 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, contents + offset + 4);
14935
14936 if (r_type1 == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
14937 || r_type1 == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
14938 {
14939 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14940 insn2 = NOP;
14941 }
14942 else
14943 {
14944 rel->r_offset = offset + d_offset;
14945 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
14946 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO;
14947 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
14948 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
14949 }
14950 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14951 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
14952 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
14953 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC64_NONE);
14954 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
14955 if (r_type != R_PPC64_NONE)
14956 goto again;
14957 }
14958 break;
14959
14960 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
14961 if (rel + 1 < relend
14962 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64)
14963 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 8)
14964 {
14965 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
14966 {
14967 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_NONE);
14968 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
14969 r_type = R_PPC64_TPREL64;
14970 else
14971 {
14972 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
14973 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14974 }
14975 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14976 }
14977 }
14978 else
14979 {
14980 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
14981 {
14982 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, 1, contents + rel->r_offset);
14983 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14984 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14985 }
14986 }
14987 break;
14988
14989 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
14990 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
14991 {
14992 r_type = R_PPC64_NONE;
14993 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
14994 }
14995 break;
14996
14997 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
14998 relocation = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
14999 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15000 && !info->traditional_format
15001 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15002 {
15003 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15004
15005 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15006 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15007 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15008 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15009 {
15010 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15011 LIS_R2 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15012 contents + rel->r_offset);
15013 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15014 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15015 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15016 }
15017 }
15018 else
15019 {
15020 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
15021 + input_section->output_offset
15022 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15023 if (relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15024 {
15025 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15026
15027 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15028 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15029 if ((insn1 & ~0xfffc) == LD_R2_0R12
15030 && insn2 == ADD_R2_R2_R12)
15031 {
15032 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15033 ADDIS_R2_R12 + PPC_HA (relocation),
15034 contents + rel->r_offset);
15035 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15036 ADDI_R2_R2 + PPC_LO (relocation),
15037 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15038 }
15039 }
15040 }
15041 break;
15042
15043 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
15044 /* If we are generating a non-PIC executable, edit
15045 . 0: addis 2,12,.TOC.-0b@ha
15046 . addi 2,2,.TOC.-0b@l
15047 used by ELFv2 global entry points to set up r2, to
15048 . lis 2,.TOC.@ha
15049 . addi 2,2,.TOC.@l
15050 if .TOC. is in range. */
15051 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
15052 && !info->traditional_format
15053 && !htab->opd_abi
15054 && rel->r_addend == d_offset
15055 && h != NULL && &h->elf == htab->elf.hgot
15056 && rel + 1 < relend
15057 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_REL16_LO)
15058 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15059 && rel[1].r_addend == rel->r_addend + 4
15060 && relocation + 0x80008000 <= 0xffffffff)
15061 {
15062 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
15063 offset = rel->r_offset - d_offset;
15064 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15065 insn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15066 if ((insn1 & 0xffff0000) == ADDIS_R2_R12
15067 && (insn2 & 0xffff0000) == ADDI_R2_R2)
15068 {
15069 r_type = R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA;
15070 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15071 rel->r_addend -= d_offset;
15072 rel[1].r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO);
15073 rel[1].r_addend -= d_offset + 4;
15074 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, LIS_R2, contents + offset);
15075 }
15076 }
15077 break;
15078 }
15079
15080 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
15081 insn = 0;
15082 max_br_offset = 1 << 25;
15083 addend = rel->r_addend;
15084 reloc_dest = DEST_NORMAL;
15085 switch (r_type)
15086 {
15087 default:
15088 break;
15089
15090 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
15091 if (relocation + addend == (rel->r_offset
15092 + input_section->output_offset
15093 + input_section->output_section->vma)
15094 && tocsave_find (htab, NO_INSERT,
15095 &local_syms, rel, input_bfd))
15096 {
15097 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
15098 if (insn == NOP
15099 || insn == CROR_151515 || insn == CROR_313131)
15100 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15101 STD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15102 contents + rel->r_offset);
15103 }
15104 break;
15105
15106 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
15107 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
15108 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
15109 insn = 0x01 << 21; /* 'y' or 't' bit, lowest bit of BO field. */
15110 /* Fall through. */
15111
15112 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
15113 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
15114 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
15115 insn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15116 contents + rel->r_offset) & ~(0x01 << 21);
15117 /* Fall through. */
15118
15119 case R_PPC64_REL14:
15120 max_br_offset = 1 << 15;
15121 /* Fall through. */
15122
15123 case R_PPC64_REL24:
15124 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
15125 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
15126 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
15127 /* Calls to functions with a different TOC, such as calls to
15128 shared objects, need to alter the TOC pointer. This is
15129 done using a linkage stub. A REL24 branching to these
15130 linkage stubs needs to be followed by a nop, as the nop
15131 will be replaced with an instruction to restore the TOC
15132 base pointer. */
15133 fdh = h;
15134 if (h != NULL
15135 && h->oh != NULL
15136 && h->oh->is_func_descriptor)
15137 fdh = ppc_follow_link (h->oh);
15138 stub_entry = ppc_get_stub_entry (input_section, sec, fdh, &orig_rel,
15139 htab);
15140 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL
15141 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC)
15142 && stub_entry != NULL
15143 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15144 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15145 stub_entry = NULL;
15146
15147 if (stub_entry != NULL
15148 && ((stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15149 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15150 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15151 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15152 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15153 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both))
15154 {
15155 bfd_boolean can_plt_call = FALSE;
15156
15157 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15158 && !htab->opd_abi
15159 && htab->params->plt_localentry0 != 0
15160 && is_elfv2_localentry0 (&h->elf))
15161 {
15162 /* The function doesn't use or change r2. */
15163 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15164 }
15165 else if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15166 {
15167 /* NOTOC calls don't need to restore r2. */
15168 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15169 }
15170
15171 /* All of these stubs may modify r2, so there must be a
15172 branch and link followed by a nop. The nop is
15173 replaced by an insn to restore r2. */
15174 else if (rel->r_offset + 8 <= input_section->size)
15175 {
15176 unsigned long br;
15177
15178 br = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15179 contents + rel->r_offset);
15180 if ((br & 1) != 0)
15181 {
15182 unsigned long nop;
15183
15184 nop = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15185 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15186 if (nop == LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab))
15187 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15188 else if (nop == NOP
15189 || nop == CROR_151515
15190 || nop == CROR_313131)
15191 {
15192 if (h != NULL
15193 && (h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
15194 || h == htab->tls_get_addr)
15195 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15196 {
15197 /* Special stub used, leave nop alone. */
15198 }
15199 else
15200 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
15201 LD_R2_0R1 + STK_TOC (htab),
15202 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
15203 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15204 }
15205 }
15206 }
15207
15208 if (!can_plt_call && h != NULL)
15209 {
15210 const char *name = h->elf.root.root.string;
15211
15212 if (*name == '.')
15213 ++name;
15214
15215 if (strncmp (name, "__libc_start_main", 17) == 0
15216 && (name[17] == 0 || name[17] == '@'))
15217 {
15218 /* Allow crt1 branch to go via a toc adjusting
15219 stub. Other calls that never return could do
15220 the same, if we could detect such. */
15221 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15222 }
15223 }
15224
15225 if (!can_plt_call)
15226 {
15227 /* g++ as of 20130507 emits self-calls without a
15228 following nop. This is arguably wrong since we
15229 have conflicting information. On the one hand a
15230 global symbol and on the other a local call
15231 sequence, but don't error for this special case.
15232 It isn't possible to cheaply verify we have
15233 exactly such a call. Allow all calls to the same
15234 section. */
15235 asection *code_sec = sec;
15236
15237 if (get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15238 {
15239 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15240 - sec->output_section->vma
15241 - sec->output_offset);
15242
15243 opd_entry_value (sec, off, &code_sec, NULL, FALSE);
15244 }
15245 if (code_sec == input_section)
15246 can_plt_call = TRUE;
15247 }
15248
15249 if (!can_plt_call)
15250 {
15251 if (stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15252 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15253 info->callbacks->einfo
15254 /* xgettext:c-format */
15255 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15256 "(plt call stub)\n"),
15257 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15258 else
15259 info->callbacks->einfo
15260 /* xgettext:c-format */
15261 (_("%H: call to `%pT' lacks nop, can't restore toc; "
15262 "(toc save/adjust stub)\n"),
15263 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
15264
15265 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15266 ret = FALSE;
15267 }
15268
15269 if (can_plt_call
15270 && stub_entry->stub_type >= ppc_stub_plt_call
15271 && stub_entry->stub_type <= ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15272 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15273 }
15274
15275 if ((stub_entry == NULL
15276 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15277 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15278 && get_opd_info (sec) != NULL)
15279 {
15280 /* The branch destination is the value of the opd entry. */
15281 bfd_vma off = (relocation + addend
15282 - sec->output_section->vma
15283 - sec->output_offset);
15284 bfd_vma dest = opd_entry_value (sec, off, NULL, NULL, FALSE);
15285 if (dest != (bfd_vma) -1)
15286 {
15287 relocation = dest;
15288 addend = 0;
15289 reloc_dest = DEST_OPD;
15290 }
15291 }
15292
15293 /* If the branch is out of reach we ought to have a long
15294 branch stub. */
15295 from = (rel->r_offset
15296 + input_section->output_offset
15297 + input_section->output_section->vma);
15298
15299 relocation += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (fdh
15300 ? fdh->elf.other
15301 : sym->st_other);
15302
15303 if (stub_entry != NULL
15304 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch
15305 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch)
15306 && (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
15307 || r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
15308 || (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15309 < 2 * max_br_offset)))
15310 /* Don't use the stub if this branch is in range. */
15311 stub_entry = NULL;
15312
15313 if (stub_entry != NULL
15314 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_notoc
15315 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15316 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_notoc
15317 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15318 && (r_type != R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15319 || ((fdh ? fdh->elf.other : sym->st_other)
15320 & STO_PPC64_LOCAL_MASK) <= 1 << STO_PPC64_LOCAL_BIT)
15321 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15322 < 2 * max_br_offset))
15323 stub_entry = NULL;
15324
15325 if (stub_entry != NULL
15326 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_r2off
15327 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15328 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_r2off
15329 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both)
15330 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15331 && (relocation + addend - from + max_br_offset
15332 < 2 * max_br_offset))
15333 stub_entry = NULL;
15334
15335 if (stub_entry != NULL)
15336 {
15337 /* Munge up the value and addend so that we call the stub
15338 rather than the procedure directly. */
15339 asection *stub_sec = stub_entry->group->stub_sec;
15340
15341 if (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_save_res)
15342 relocation += (stub_sec->output_offset
15343 + stub_sec->output_section->vma
15344 + stub_sec->size - htab->sfpr->size
15345 - htab->sfpr->output_offset
15346 - htab->sfpr->output_section->vma);
15347 else
15348 relocation = (stub_entry->stub_offset
15349 + stub_sec->output_offset
15350 + stub_sec->output_section->vma);
15351 addend = 0;
15352 reloc_dest = DEST_STUB;
15353
15354 if (((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call
15355 && ALWAYS_EMIT_R2SAVE)
15356 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_r2save
15357 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15358 && !(h != NULL
15359 && (h == htab->tls_get_addr_fd
15360 || h == htab->tls_get_addr)
15361 && htab->params->tls_get_addr_opt)
15362 && rel + 1 < relend
15363 && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset + 4
15364 && ELF64_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC64_TOCSAVE)
15365 relocation += 4;
15366 else if ((stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_long_branch_both
15367 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_branch_both
15368 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both)
15369 && r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15370 relocation += 4;
15371
15372 if (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC
15373 && (stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_notoc
15374 || stub_entry->stub_type == ppc_stub_plt_call_both))
15375 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
15376 }
15377
15378 if (insn != 0)
15379 {
15380 if (is_isa_v2)
15381 {
15382 /* Set 'a' bit. This is 0b00010 in BO field for branch
15383 on CR(BI) insns (BO == 001at or 011at), and 0b01000
15384 for branch on CTR insns (BO == 1a00t or 1a01t). */
15385 if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x04 << 21))
15386 insn |= 0x02 << 21;
15387 else if ((insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x10 << 21))
15388 insn |= 0x08 << 21;
15389 else
15390 break;
15391 }
15392 else
15393 {
15394 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
15395 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + addend - from) < 0)
15396 insn ^= 0x01 << 21;
15397 }
15398
15399 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
15400 }
15401
15402 /* NOP out calls to undefined weak functions.
15403 We can thus call a weak function without first
15404 checking whether the function is defined. */
15405 else if (h != NULL
15406 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
15407 && h->elf.dynindx == -1
15408 && (r_type == R_PPC64_REL24
15409 || r_type == R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC)
15410 && relocation == 0
15411 && addend == 0)
15412 {
15413 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
15414 goto copy_reloc;
15415 }
15416 break;
15417
15418 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
15419 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15420 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x8000 < 0x10000
15421 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15422 {
15423 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15424 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
15425 {
15426 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15427 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15428 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16;
15429 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15430 }
15431 }
15432 break;
15433
15434 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
15435 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
15436 from = TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15437 if (relocation + addend - from + 0x80008000ULL < 0x100000000ULL
15438 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15439 {
15440 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15441 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26 | 0x3)) == 58u << 26 /* ld */)
15442 {
15443 insn += (14u << 26) - (58u << 26);
15444 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
15445 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_LO;
15446 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15447 }
15448 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */)
15449 {
15450 r_type = R_PPC64_TOC16_HA;
15451 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15452 }
15453 }
15454 break;
15455
15456 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
15457 from = (rel->r_offset
15458 + input_section->output_section->vma
15459 + input_section->output_offset);
15460 if (relocation - from + (1ULL << 33) < 1ULL << 34
15461 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15462 {
15463 offset = rel->r_offset;
15464 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15465 pinsn <<= 32;
15466 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15467 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
15468 == ((1ULL << 58) | (1ULL << 52) | (57ULL << 26) /* pld */))
15469 {
15470 /* Replace with paddi. */
15471 pinsn += (2ULL << 56) + (14ULL << 26) - (57ULL << 26);
15472 r_type = R_PPC64_PCREL34;
15473 rel->r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
15474 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + offset);
15475 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + offset + 4);
15476 goto pcrelopt;
15477 }
15478 }
15479 break;
15480
15481 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
15482 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))
15483 {
15484 offset = rel->r_offset;
15485 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
15486 pinsn <<= 32;
15487 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset + 4);
15488 if ((pinsn & ((-1ULL << 50) | (63ULL << 26)))
15489 == ((1ULL << 58) | (2ULL << 56) | (1ULL << 52)
15490 | (14ULL << 26) /* paddi */))
15491 {
15492 pcrelopt:
15493 if (rel + 1 < relend
15494 && rel[1].r_offset == offset
15495 && rel[1].r_info == ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT))
15496 {
15497 bfd_vma off2 = rel[1].r_addend;
15498 if (off2 == 0)
15499 /* zero means next insn. */
15500 off2 = 8;
15501 off2 += offset;
15502 if (off2 + 4 <= input_section->size)
15503 {
15504 uint64_t pinsn2;
15505 bfd_signed_vma addend_off;
15506 pinsn2 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + off2);
15507 pinsn2 <<= 32;
15508 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
15509 {
15510 if (off2 + 8 > input_section->size)
15511 break;
15512 pinsn2 |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
15513 contents + off2 + 4);
15514 }
15515 if (xlate_pcrel_opt (&pinsn, &pinsn2, &addend_off))
15516 {
15517 addend += addend_off;
15518 rel->r_addend = addend;
15519 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32,
15520 contents + offset);
15521 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn,
15522 contents + offset + 4);
15523 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2 >> 32,
15524 contents + off2);
15525 if ((pinsn2 & (63ULL << 58)) == 1ULL << 58)
15526 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn2,
15527 contents + off2 + 4);
15528 }
15529 }
15530 }
15531 }
15532 }
15533 break;
15534 }
15535
15536 tls_type = 0;
15537 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
15538 switch (r_type)
15539 {
15540 default:
15541 /* xgettext:c-format */
15542 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
15543 input_bfd, ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
15544
15545 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15546 ret = FALSE;
15547 goto copy_reloc;
15548
15549 case R_PPC64_NONE:
15550 case R_PPC64_TLS:
15551 case R_PPC64_TLSGD:
15552 case R_PPC64_TLSLD:
15553 case R_PPC64_TOCSAVE:
15554 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTINHERIT:
15555 case R_PPC64_GNU_VTENTRY:
15556 case R_PPC64_ENTRY:
15557 case R_PPC64_PCREL_OPT:
15558 goto copy_reloc;
15559
15560 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
15561 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
15562 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
15563 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
15564 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16:
15565 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
15566 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
15567 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
15568 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
15569 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
15570 goto dogot;
15571
15572 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16:
15573 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
15574 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
15575 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
15576 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
15577 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
15578 goto dogot;
15579
15580 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
15581 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15582 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
15583 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
15584 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
15585 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
15586 goto dogot;
15587
15588 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
15589 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
15590 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
15591 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
15592 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
15593 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
15594 goto dogot;
15595
15596 case R_PPC64_GOT16:
15597 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
15598 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
15599 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
15600 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
15601 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
15602 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
15603 dogot:
15604 {
15605 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
15606 offset table. */
15607 asection *got;
15608 bfd_vma *offp;
15609 bfd_vma off;
15610 unsigned long indx = 0;
15611 struct got_entry *ent;
15612
15613 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
15614 && (h == NULL
15615 || !h->elf.def_dynamic))
15616 ent = ppc64_tlsld_got (input_bfd);
15617 else
15618 {
15619 if (h != NULL)
15620 {
15621 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
15622 || h->elf.dynindx == -1
15623 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
15624 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf))
15625 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
15626 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
15627 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
15628 because of a version file. */
15629 ;
15630 else
15631 {
15632 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
15633 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15634 }
15635 ent = h->elf.got.glist;
15636 }
15637 else
15638 {
15639 if (local_got_ents == NULL)
15640 abort ();
15641 ent = local_got_ents[r_symndx];
15642 }
15643
15644 for (; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
15645 if (ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend
15646 && ent->owner == input_bfd
15647 && ent->tls_type == tls_type)
15648 break;
15649 }
15650
15651 if (ent == NULL)
15652 abort ();
15653 if (ent->is_indirect)
15654 ent = ent->got.ent;
15655 offp = &ent->got.offset;
15656 got = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->got;
15657 if (got == NULL)
15658 abort ();
15659
15660 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 8. We use the
15661 least significant bit to record whether we have already
15662 processed this entry. */
15663 off = *offp;
15664 if ((off & 1) != 0)
15665 off &= ~1;
15666 else
15667 {
15668 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker, except in
15669 the case of TLSLD where we'll use one entry per
15670 module. */
15671 asection *relgot;
15672 bfd_boolean ifunc;
15673
15674 *offp = off | 1;
15675 relgot = NULL;
15676 ifunc = (h != NULL
15677 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
15678 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
15679 if (ifunc)
15680 {
15681 relgot = htab->elf.irelplt;
15682 if (indx == 0)
15683 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
15684 else if (is_static_defined (&h->elf))
15685 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
15686 }
15687 else if (indx != 0
15688 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
15689 && (h == NULL
15690 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->elf)
15691 || (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
15692 && !h->elf.def_dynamic))
15693 && !(tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
15694 && bfd_link_executable (info)
15695 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf))))
15696 relgot = ppc64_elf_tdata (ent->owner)->relgot;
15697 if (relgot != NULL)
15698 {
15699 outrel.r_offset = (got->output_section->vma
15700 + got->output_offset
15701 + off);
15702 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
15703 if (tls_type & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
15704 {
15705 outrel.r_addend = 0;
15706 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPMOD64);
15707 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
15708 {
15709 loc = relgot->contents;
15710 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
15711 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
15712 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
15713 &outrel, loc);
15714 outrel.r_offset += 8;
15715 outrel.r_addend = orig_rel.r_addend;
15716 outrel.r_info
15717 = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
15718 }
15719 }
15720 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
15721 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_DTPREL64);
15722 else if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
15723 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_TPREL64);
15724 else if (indx != 0)
15725 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT);
15726 else
15727 {
15728 if (ifunc)
15729 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
15730 else
15731 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
15732
15733 /* Write the .got section contents for the sake
15734 of prelink. */
15735 loc = got->contents + off;
15736 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, outrel.r_addend + relocation,
15737 loc);
15738 }
15739
15740 if (indx == 0 && tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
15741 {
15742 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
15743 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
15744 {
15745 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
15746 outrel.r_addend = 0;
15747 else
15748 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
15749 }
15750 }
15751 loc = relgot->contents;
15752 loc += (relgot->reloc_count++
15753 * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela));
15754 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
15755 }
15756
15757 /* Init the .got section contents here if we're not
15758 emitting a reloc. */
15759 else
15760 {
15761 relocation += orig_rel.r_addend;
15762 if (tls_type != 0)
15763 {
15764 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
15765 relocation = 0;
15766 else
15767 {
15768 if (tls_type & TLS_LD)
15769 relocation = 0;
15770 else
15771 relocation -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15772 if (tls_type & TLS_TPREL)
15773 relocation += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
15774 }
15775
15776 if (tls_type & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD))
15777 {
15778 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
15779 got->contents + off + 8);
15780 relocation = 1;
15781 }
15782 }
15783 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, relocation,
15784 got->contents + off);
15785 }
15786 }
15787
15788 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
15789 abort ();
15790
15791 relocation = got->output_section->vma + got->output_offset + off;
15792 addend = 0;
15793 if (!(r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34
15794 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34
15795 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34
15796 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34
15797 || r_type == R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34))
15798 addend = -(TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
15799 }
15800 break;
15801
15802 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
15803 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HI:
15804 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
15805 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
15806 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
15807 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
15808 case R_PPC64_PLT32:
15809 case R_PPC64_PLT64:
15810 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
15811 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
15812 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
15813 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
15814 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
15815 procedure linkage table. */
15816 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
15817 {
15818 struct plt_entry **plt_list = NULL;
15819 if (h != NULL)
15820 plt_list = &h->elf.plt.plist;
15821 else if (local_got_ents != NULL)
15822 {
15823 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
15824 (local_got_ents + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
15825 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
15826 }
15827 if (plt_list)
15828 {
15829 struct plt_entry *ent;
15830
15831 for (ent = *plt_list; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
15832 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1
15833 && ent->addend == orig_rel.r_addend)
15834 {
15835 asection *plt;
15836 bfd_vma got;
15837
15838 plt = htab->elf.splt;
15839 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
15840 || h == NULL
15841 || h->elf.dynindx == -1)
15842 {
15843 if (h != NULL
15844 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
15845 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
15846 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
15847 else
15848 plt = htab->pltlocal;
15849 }
15850 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
15851 + plt->output_offset
15852 + ent->plt.offset);
15853 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HA
15854 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_HI
15855 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO
15856 || r_type == R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS)
15857 {
15858 got = (elf_gp (output_bfd)
15859 + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off);
15860 relocation -= got;
15861 }
15862 addend = 0;
15863 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
15864 break;
15865 }
15866 }
15867 }
15868 break;
15869
15870 case R_PPC64_TOC:
15871 /* Relocation value is TOC base. */
15872 relocation = TOCstart;
15873 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
15874 relocation += htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15875 else if (unresolved_reloc)
15876 ;
15877 else if (sec != NULL && sec->id < htab->sec_info_arr_size)
15878 relocation += htab->sec_info[sec->id].toc_off;
15879 else
15880 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
15881 goto dodyn;
15882
15883 /* TOC16 relocs. We want the offset relative to the TOC base,
15884 which is the address of the start of the TOC plus 0x8000.
15885 The TOC consists of sections .got, .toc, .tocbss, and .plt,
15886 in this order. */
15887 case R_PPC64_TOC16:
15888 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
15889 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
15890 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
15891 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
15892 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
15893 addend -= TOCstart + htab->sec_info[input_section->id].toc_off;
15894 if (h != NULL)
15895 goto dodyn;
15896 break;
15897
15898 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
15899 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF:
15900 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO:
15901 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HI:
15902 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
15903 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
15904 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
15905 if (sec != NULL)
15906 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
15907 break;
15908
15909 case R_PPC64_REL16:
15910 case R_PPC64_REL16_LO:
15911 case R_PPC64_REL16_HI:
15912 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
15913 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGH:
15914 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
15915 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER:
15916 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
15917 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST:
15918 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
15919 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHER34:
15920 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
15921 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHEST34:
15922 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
15923 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
15924 case R_PPC64_REL14:
15925 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
15926 case R_PPC64_REL14_BRTAKEN:
15927 case R_PPC64_REL24:
15928 case R_PPC64_REL24_NOTOC:
15929 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
15930 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
15931 break;
15932
15933 case R_PPC64_TPREL16:
15934 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
15935 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HI:
15936 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
15937 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
15938 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
15939 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGH:
15940 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
15941 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHER:
15942 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
15943 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHEST:
15944 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
15945 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
15946 if (h != NULL
15947 && h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
15948 && h->elf.dynindx == -1)
15949 {
15950 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
15951 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
15952 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
15953 defined before using them. */
15954 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
15955
15956 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
15957 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 13);
15958 if (insn != 0)
15959 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
15960 break;
15961 }
15962 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
15963 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
15964 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
15965 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
15966 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
15967 goto dodyn;
15968
15969 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16:
15970 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO:
15971 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HI:
15972 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
15973 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
15974 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
15975 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGH:
15976 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
15977 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHER:
15978 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
15979 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHEST:
15980 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
15981 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
15982 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
15983 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
15984 break;
15985
15986 case R_PPC64_ADDR64_LOCAL:
15987 addend += PPC64_LOCAL_ENTRY_OFFSET (h != NULL
15988 ? h->elf.other
15989 : sym->st_other);
15990 break;
15991
15992 case R_PPC64_DTPMOD64:
15993 relocation = 1;
15994 addend = 0;
15995 goto dodyn;
15996
15997 case R_PPC64_TPREL64:
15998 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
15999 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
16000 goto dodyn;
16001
16002 case R_PPC64_DTPREL64:
16003 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
16004 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
16005 /* Fall through. */
16006
16007 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a
16008 dynamic object. */
16009 case R_PPC64_REL30:
16010 case R_PPC64_REL32:
16011 case R_PPC64_REL64:
16012 case R_PPC64_ADDR14:
16013 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
16014 case R_PPC64_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
16015 case R_PPC64_ADDR16:
16016 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
16017 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16018 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HI:
16019 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGH:
16020 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16021 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER:
16022 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16023 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST:
16024 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16025 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO:
16026 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
16027 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHER34:
16028 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16029 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHEST34:
16030 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16031 case R_PPC64_ADDR24:
16032 case R_PPC64_ADDR32:
16033 case R_PPC64_ADDR64:
16034 case R_PPC64_UADDR16:
16035 case R_PPC64_UADDR32:
16036 case R_PPC64_UADDR64:
16037 case R_PPC64_D34:
16038 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
16039 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
16040 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16041 case R_PPC64_D28:
16042 dodyn:
16043 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
16044 break;
16045
16046 if (NO_OPD_RELOCS && is_opd)
16047 break;
16048
16049 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
16050 ? ((h == NULL
16051 || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
16052 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
16053 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
16054 : (h != NULL
16055 ? h->dyn_relocs != NULL
16056 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16057 {
16058 bfd_boolean skip, relocate;
16059 asection *sreloc;
16060 bfd_vma out_off;
16061 long indx = 0;
16062
16063 /* When generating a dynamic object, these relocations
16064 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
16065 time. */
16066
16067 skip = FALSE;
16068 relocate = FALSE;
16069
16070 out_off = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
16071 input_section, rel->r_offset);
16072 if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -1)
16073 skip = TRUE;
16074 else if (out_off == (bfd_vma) -2)
16075 skip = TRUE, relocate = TRUE;
16076 out_off += (input_section->output_section->vma
16077 + input_section->output_offset);
16078 outrel.r_offset = out_off;
16079 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
16080
16081 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
16082 if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 && (out_off & 7) != 0)
16083 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR64 && (out_off & 7) == 0))
16084 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR64 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR64;
16085 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR32 && (out_off & 3) != 0)
16086 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR32 && (out_off & 3) == 0))
16087 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR32;
16088 else if ((r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR16 && (out_off & 1) != 0)
16089 || (r_type == R_PPC64_UADDR16 && (out_off & 1) == 0))
16090 r_type ^= R_PPC64_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC64_UADDR16;
16091
16092 if (skip)
16093 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
16094 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->elf)
16095 && !is_opd
16096 && r_type != R_PPC64_TOC)
16097 {
16098 indx = h->elf.dynindx;
16099 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
16100 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16101 }
16102 else
16103 {
16104 /* This symbol is local, or marked to become local,
16105 or this is an opd section reloc which must point
16106 at a local function. */
16107 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
16108 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64 || r_type == R_PPC64_TOC)
16109 {
16110 if (is_opd && h != NULL)
16111 {
16112 /* Lie about opd entries. This case occurs
16113 when building shared libraries and we
16114 reference a function in another shared
16115 lib. The same thing happens for a weak
16116 definition in an application that's
16117 overridden by a strong definition in a
16118 shared lib. (I believe this is a generic
16119 bug in binutils handling of weak syms.)
16120 In these cases we won't use the opd
16121 entry in this lib. */
16122 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16123 }
16124 if (!is_opd
16125 && r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64
16126 && (h != NULL
16127 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16128 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC))
16129 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_IRELATIVE);
16130 else
16131 {
16132 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (0, R_PPC64_RELATIVE);
16133
16134 /* We need to relocate .opd contents for ld.so.
16135 Prelink also wants simple and consistent rules
16136 for relocs. This make all RELATIVE relocs have
16137 *r_offset equal to r_addend. */
16138 relocate = TRUE;
16139 }
16140 }
16141 else
16142 {
16143 if (h != NULL
16144 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16145 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16146 {
16147 info->callbacks->einfo
16148 /* xgettext:c-format */
16149 (_("%H: %s for indirect "
16150 "function `%pT' unsupported\n"),
16151 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16152 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
16153 sym_name);
16154 ret = FALSE;
16155 }
16156 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
16157 ;
16158 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
16159 {
16160 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16161 return FALSE;
16162 }
16163 else
16164 {
16165 asection *osec = sec->output_section;
16166
16167 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
16168 {
16169 /* TLS symbol values are relative to the
16170 TLS segment. Dynamic relocations for
16171 local TLS symbols therefore can't be
16172 reduced to a relocation against their
16173 section symbol because it holds the
16174 address of the section, not a value
16175 relative to the TLS segment. We could
16176 change the .tdata dynamic section symbol
16177 to be zero value but STN_UNDEF works
16178 and is used elsewhere, eg. for TPREL64
16179 GOT relocs against local TLS symbols. */
16180 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
16181 indx = 0;
16182 }
16183 else
16184 {
16185 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16186 if (indx == 0)
16187 {
16188 if ((osec->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
16189 && htab->elf.data_index_section != NULL)
16190 osec = htab->elf.data_index_section;
16191 else
16192 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
16193 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
16194 }
16195 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
16196 }
16197
16198 /* We are turning this relocation into one
16199 against a section symbol, so subtract out
16200 the output section's address but not the
16201 offset of the input section in the output
16202 section. */
16203 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
16204 }
16205
16206 outrel.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
16207 }
16208 }
16209
16210 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
16211 if (h != NULL
16212 ? h->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
16213 : ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
16214 {
16215 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
16216 if (indx == 0)
16217 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
16218 else if (is_static_defined (&h->elf))
16219 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
16220 }
16221 if (sreloc == NULL)
16222 abort ();
16223
16224 if (sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela)
16225 >= sreloc->size)
16226 abort ();
16227 loc = sreloc->contents;
16228 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
16229 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
16230
16231 if (!warned_dynamic
16232 && !ppc64_glibc_dynamic_reloc (ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)))
16233 {
16234 info->callbacks->einfo
16235 /* xgettext:c-format */
16236 (_("%X%P: %pB: %s against %pT "
16237 "is not supported by glibc as a dynamic relocation\n"),
16238 input_bfd,
16239 ppc64_elf_howto_table[ELF64_R_TYPE (outrel.r_info)]->name,
16240 sym_name);
16241 warned_dynamic = TRUE;
16242 }
16243
16244 /* If this reloc is against an external symbol, it will
16245 be computed at runtime, so there's no need to do
16246 anything now. However, for the sake of prelink ensure
16247 that the section contents are a known value. */
16248 if (!relocate)
16249 {
16250 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16251 /* The value chosen here is quite arbitrary as ld.so
16252 ignores section contents except for the special
16253 case of .opd where the contents might be accessed
16254 before relocation. Choose zero, as that won't
16255 cause reloc overflow. */
16256 relocation = 0;
16257 addend = 0;
16258 /* Use *r_offset == r_addend for R_PPC64_ADDR64 relocs
16259 to improve backward compatibility with older
16260 versions of ld. */
16261 if (r_type == R_PPC64_ADDR64)
16262 addend = outrel.r_addend;
16263 /* Adjust pc_relative relocs to have zero in *r_offset. */
16264 else if (ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->pc_relative)
16265 addend = outrel.r_offset;
16266 }
16267 }
16268 break;
16269
16270 case R_PPC64_COPY:
16271 case R_PPC64_GLOB_DAT:
16272 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
16273 case R_PPC64_JMP_IREL:
16274 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
16275 /* We shouldn't ever see these dynamic relocs in relocatable
16276 files. */
16277 /* Fall through. */
16278
16279 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16:
16280 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
16281 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16282 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HI:
16283 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO:
16284 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
16285 case R_PPC64_PLTREL32:
16286 case R_PPC64_PLTREL64:
16287 /* These ones haven't been implemented yet. */
16288
16289 info->callbacks->einfo
16290 /* xgettext:c-format */
16291 (_("%P: %pB: %s is not supported for `%pT'\n"),
16292 input_bfd,
16293 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, sym_name);
16294
16295 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
16296 ret = FALSE;
16297 goto copy_reloc;
16298 }
16299
16300 /* Multi-instruction sequences that access the TOC can be
16301 optimized, eg. addis ra,r2,0; addi rb,ra,x;
16302 to nop; addi rb,r2,x; */
16303 switch (r_type)
16304 {
16305 default:
16306 break;
16307
16308 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
16309 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
16310 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
16311 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
16312 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HI:
16313 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HI:
16314 /* These relocs would only be useful if building up an
16315 offset to later add to r2, perhaps in an indexed
16316 addressing mode instruction. Don't try to optimize.
16317 Unfortunately, the possibility of someone building up an
16318 offset like this or even with the HA relocs, means that
16319 we need to check the high insn when optimizing the low
16320 insn. */
16321 break;
16322
16323 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL_NOTOC:
16324 if (!unresolved_reloc)
16325 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16326 /* Fall through. */
16327 case R_PPC64_PLTCALL:
16328 if (unresolved_reloc)
16329 {
16330 /* No plt entry. Make this into a direct call. */
16331 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
16332 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16333 insn &= 1;
16334 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B_DOT | insn, p);
16335 if (r_type == R_PPC64_PLTCALL)
16336 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p + 4);
16337 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
16338 r_type = R_PPC64_REL24;
16339 }
16340 break;
16341
16342 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ_NOTOC:
16343 case R_PPC64_PLTSEQ:
16344 if (unresolved_reloc)
16345 {
16346 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16347 goto nop_it;
16348 }
16349 break;
16350
16351 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16352 if (!unresolved_reloc)
16353 htab->notoc_plt = 1;
16354 /* Fall through. */
16355 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16356 if (unresolved_reloc)
16357 {
16358 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
16359 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP >> 32, p);
16360 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, PNOP, p + 4);
16361 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16362 goto copy_reloc;
16363 }
16364 break;
16365
16366 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16367 if (unresolved_reloc)
16368 {
16369 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16370 goto nop_it;
16371 }
16372 /* Fall through. */
16373 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16374 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16375 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16376 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16377 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16378 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16379 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16380 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
16381 {
16382 bfd_byte *p;
16383 nop_it:
16384 p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16385 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
16386 goto copy_reloc;
16387 }
16388 break;
16389
16390 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO:
16391 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16392 if (unresolved_reloc)
16393 {
16394 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
16395 goto nop_it;
16396 }
16397 /* Fall through. */
16398 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
16399 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
16400 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16401 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16402 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO:
16403 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16404 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO:
16405 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16406 if (htab->do_toc_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
16407 && !ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->unexpected_toc_insn)
16408 {
16409 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16410 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16411 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 12u << 26 /* addic */)
16412 {
16413 /* Transform addic to addi when we change reg. */
16414 insn &= ~((0x3f << 26) | (0x1f << 16));
16415 insn |= (14u << 26) | (2 << 16);
16416 }
16417 else
16418 {
16419 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
16420 insn |= 2 << 16;
16421 }
16422 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16423 }
16424 break;
16425
16426 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16427 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
16428 {
16429 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16430 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16431 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
16432 != ((15u << 26) | (13 << 16)) /* addis rt,13,imm */)
16433 /* xgettext:c-format */
16434 info->callbacks->minfo
16435 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
16436 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16437 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name, insn);
16438 else
16439 {
16440 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
16441 goto copy_reloc;
16442 }
16443 }
16444 break;
16445
16446 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO:
16447 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16448 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
16449 {
16450 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
16451 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
16452 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
16453 insn |= 13 << 16;
16454 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
16455 }
16456 break;
16457 }
16458
16459 /* Do any further special processing. */
16460 switch (r_type)
16461 {
16462 default:
16463 break;
16464
16465 case R_PPC64_REL16_HA:
16466 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHA:
16467 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA:
16468 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA:
16469 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16470 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HA:
16471 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHA:
16472 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA:
16473 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA:
16474 case R_PPC64_TOC16_HA:
16475 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_HA:
16476 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HA:
16477 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHA:
16478 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHERA:
16479 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16480 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HA:
16481 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHA:
16482 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHERA:
16483 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_HIGHESTA:
16484 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
16485 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
16486 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
16487 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
16488 if (sec == NULL)
16489 break;
16490 /* Fall through. */
16491
16492 case R_PPC64_GOT16_HA:
16493 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_HA:
16494 case R_PPC64_PLT16_HA:
16495 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
16496 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
16497 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
16498 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
16499 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
16500 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
16501 addend += 0x8000;
16502 break;
16503
16504 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16505 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHERA34:
16506 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_HIGHESTA34:
16507 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHERA34:
16508 case R_PPC64_REL16_HIGHESTA34:
16509 if (sec != NULL)
16510 addend += 1ULL << 33;
16511 break;
16512
16513 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
16514 case R_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
16515 case R_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
16516 case R_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
16517 case R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
16518 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
16519 case R_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
16520 case R_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
16521 case R_PPC64_TOC16_LO_DS:
16522 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_DS:
16523 case R_PPC64_PLTGOT16_LO_DS:
16524 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_DS:
16525 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16526 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_DS:
16527 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16528 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
16529 case R_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
16530 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
16531 case R_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
16532 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16533 mask = 3;
16534 /* If this reloc is against an lq, lxv, or stxv insn, then
16535 the value must be a multiple of 16. This is somewhat of
16536 a hack, but the "correct" way to do this by defining _DQ
16537 forms of all the _DS relocs bloats all reloc switches in
16538 this file. It doesn't make much sense to use these
16539 relocs in data, so testing the insn should be safe. */
16540 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (56u << 26)
16541 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) && (insn & 3) == 1))
16542 mask = 15;
16543 relocation += addend;
16544 addend = insn & (mask ^ 3);
16545 if ((relocation & mask) != 0)
16546 {
16547 relocation ^= relocation & mask;
16548 info->callbacks->einfo
16549 /* xgettext:c-format */
16550 (_("%H: error: %s not a multiple of %u\n"),
16551 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16552 ppc64_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name,
16553 mask + 1);
16554 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
16555 ret = FALSE;
16556 goto copy_reloc;
16557 }
16558 break;
16559 }
16560
16561 /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
16562 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
16563 not process them. */
16564 howto = ppc64_elf_howto_table[(int) r_type];
16565 if (unresolved_reloc
16566 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
16567 && h->elf.def_dynamic)
16568 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
16569 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
16570 {
16571 info->callbacks->einfo
16572 /* xgettext:c-format */
16573 (_("%H: unresolvable %s against `%pT'\n"),
16574 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16575 howto->name,
16576 h->elf.root.root.string);
16577 ret = FALSE;
16578 }
16579
16580 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
16581 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
16582 have different reloc types. */
16583 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
16584 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
16585 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
16586 {
16587 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
16588
16589 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
16590 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
16591 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
16592 else if (howto->rightshift == 0
16593 ? ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
16594 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
16595 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
16596 : ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 29u << 26 /* andis */
16597 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 25u << 26 /* oris */
16598 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 27u << 26 /* xoris */))
16599 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
16600 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
16601 {
16602 alt_howto = *howto;
16603 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
16604 howto = &alt_howto;
16605 }
16606 }
16607
16608 switch (r_type)
16609 {
16610 /* Split field relocs aren't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
16611 case R_PPC64_D34:
16612 case R_PPC64_D34_LO:
16613 case R_PPC64_D34_HI30:
16614 case R_PPC64_D34_HA30:
16615 case R_PPC64_PCREL34:
16616 case R_PPC64_GOT_PCREL34:
16617 case R_PPC64_TPREL34:
16618 case R_PPC64_DTPREL34:
16619 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSGD34:
16620 case R_PPC64_GOT_TLSLD34:
16621 case R_PPC64_GOT_TPREL34:
16622 case R_PPC64_GOT_DTPREL34:
16623 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34:
16624 case R_PPC64_PLT_PCREL34_NOTOC:
16625 case R_PPC64_D28:
16626 case R_PPC64_PCREL28:
16627 if (rel->r_offset + 8 > input_section->size)
16628 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
16629 else
16630 {
16631 relocation += addend;
16632 if (howto->pc_relative)
16633 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
16634 + input_section->output_offset
16635 + input_section->output_section->vma);
16636 relocation >>= howto->rightshift;
16637
16638 pinsn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
16639 pinsn <<= 32;
16640 pinsn |= bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
16641
16642 pinsn &= ~howto->dst_mask;
16643 pinsn |= (((relocation << 16) | (relocation & 0xffff))
16644 & howto->dst_mask);
16645 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn >> 32, contents + rel->r_offset);
16646 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, pinsn, contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
16647 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
16648 if (howto->complain_on_overflow == complain_overflow_signed
16649 && (relocation + (1ULL << (howto->bitsize - 1))
16650 >= 1ULL << howto->bitsize))
16651 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
16652 }
16653 break;
16654
16655 case R_PPC64_REL16DX_HA:
16656 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
16657 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
16658 else
16659 {
16660 relocation += addend;
16661 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
16662 + input_section->output_offset
16663 + input_section->output_section->vma);
16664 relocation = (bfd_signed_vma) relocation >> 16;
16665 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
16666 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
16667 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
16668 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
16669 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
16670 if (relocation + 0x8000 > 0xffff)
16671 r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
16672 }
16673 break;
16674
16675 default:
16676 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
16677 contents, rel->r_offset,
16678 relocation, addend);
16679 }
16680
16681 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
16682 {
16683 char *more_info = NULL;
16684 const char *reloc_name = howto->name;
16685
16686 if (reloc_dest != DEST_NORMAL)
16687 {
16688 more_info = bfd_malloc (strlen (reloc_name) + 8);
16689 if (more_info != NULL)
16690 {
16691 strcpy (more_info, reloc_name);
16692 strcat (more_info, (reloc_dest == DEST_OPD
16693 ? " (OPD)" : " (stub)"));
16694 reloc_name = more_info;
16695 }
16696 }
16697
16698 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
16699 {
16700 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
16701 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
16702 if (!warned
16703 && (reloc_dest == DEST_STUB
16704 || !(h != NULL
16705 && (h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
16706 || h->elf.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
16707 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))))
16708 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow (info, &h->elf.root,
16709 sym_name, reloc_name,
16710 orig_rel.r_addend,
16711 input_bfd, input_section,
16712 rel->r_offset);
16713 }
16714 else
16715 {
16716 info->callbacks->einfo
16717 /* xgettext:c-format */
16718 (_("%H: %s against `%pT': error %d\n"),
16719 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
16720 reloc_name, sym_name, (int) r);
16721 ret = FALSE;
16722 }
16723 if (more_info != NULL)
16724 free (more_info);
16725 }
16726 copy_reloc:
16727 if (wrel != rel)
16728 *wrel = *rel;
16729 }
16730
16731 if (wrel != rel)
16732 {
16733 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
16734 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
16735
16736 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
16737 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
16738 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
16739 {
16740 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
16741 one NONE reloc.
16742 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
16743 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
16744 deleted -= 1;
16745 }
16746 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
16747 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
16748 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
16749 }
16750
16751 /* If we're emitting relocations, then shortly after this function
16752 returns, reloc offsets and addends for this section will be
16753 adjusted. Worse, reloc symbol indices will be for the output
16754 file rather than the input. Save a copy of the relocs for
16755 opd_entry_value. */
16756 if (is_opd && (info->emitrelocations || bfd_link_relocatable (info)))
16757 {
16758 bfd_size_type amt;
16759 amt = input_section->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela);
16760 rel = bfd_alloc (input_bfd, amt);
16761 BFD_ASSERT (ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs == NULL);
16762 ppc64_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->opd.relocs = rel;
16763 if (rel == NULL)
16764 return FALSE;
16765 memcpy (rel, relocs, amt);
16766 }
16767 return ret;
16768 }
16769
16770 /* Adjust the value of any local symbols in opd sections. */
16771
16772 static int
16773 ppc64_elf_output_symbol_hook (struct bfd_link_info *info,
16774 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
16775 Elf_Internal_Sym *elfsym,
16776 asection *input_sec,
16777 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
16778 {
16779 struct _opd_sec_data *opd;
16780 long adjust;
16781 bfd_vma value;
16782
16783 if (h != NULL)
16784 return 1;
16785
16786 opd = get_opd_info (input_sec);
16787 if (opd == NULL || opd->adjust == NULL)
16788 return 1;
16789
16790 value = elfsym->st_value - input_sec->output_offset;
16791 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
16792 value -= input_sec->output_section->vma;
16793
16794 adjust = opd->adjust[OPD_NDX (value)];
16795 if (adjust == -1)
16796 return 2;
16797
16798 elfsym->st_value += adjust;
16799 return 1;
16800 }
16801
16802 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
16803 dynamic sections here. */
16804
16805 static bfd_boolean
16806 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
16807 struct bfd_link_info *info,
16808 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
16809 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
16810 {
16811 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
16812 struct plt_entry *ent;
16813
16814 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
16815 if (htab == NULL)
16816 return FALSE;
16817
16818 if (!htab->opd_abi && !h->def_regular)
16819 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
16820 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
16821 {
16822 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
16823 defined in glink. Leave the value if there were
16824 any relocations where pointer equality matters
16825 (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to make
16826 function pointer comparisons work between an
16827 application and shared library), otherwise set it
16828 to zero. */
16829 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
16830 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
16831 sym->st_value = 0;
16832 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
16833 {
16834 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
16835 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
16836 function pointer. */
16837 sym->st_value = 0;
16838 }
16839 break;
16840 }
16841
16842 if (h->needs_copy
16843 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
16844 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
16845 && (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
16846 || h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro))
16847 {
16848 /* This symbol needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
16849 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
16850 asection *srel;
16851 bfd_byte *loc;
16852
16853 if (h->dynindx == -1)
16854 abort ();
16855
16856 rela.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.value
16857 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
16858 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
16859 rela.r_info = ELF64_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC64_COPY);
16860 rela.r_addend = 0;
16861 if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
16862 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
16863 else
16864 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
16865 loc = srel->contents;
16866 loc += srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela);
16867 bfd_elf64_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
16868 }
16869
16870 return TRUE;
16871 }
16872
16873 /* Used to decide how to sort relocs in an optimal manner for the
16874 dynamic linker, before writing them out. */
16875
16876 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
16877 ppc64_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
16878 const asection *rel_sec,
16879 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
16880 {
16881 enum elf_ppc64_reloc_type r_type;
16882 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
16883
16884 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
16885 return reloc_class_ifunc;
16886
16887 r_type = ELF64_R_TYPE (rela->r_info);
16888 switch (r_type)
16889 {
16890 case R_PPC64_RELATIVE:
16891 return reloc_class_relative;
16892 case R_PPC64_JMP_SLOT:
16893 return reloc_class_plt;
16894 case R_PPC64_COPY:
16895 return reloc_class_copy;
16896 default:
16897 return reloc_class_normal;
16898 }
16899 }
16900
16901 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
16902
16903 static bfd_boolean
16904 ppc64_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
16905 struct bfd_link_info *info)
16906 {
16907 struct ppc_link_hash_table *htab;
16908 bfd *dynobj;
16909 asection *sdyn;
16910
16911 htab = ppc_hash_table (info);
16912 if (htab == NULL)
16913 return FALSE;
16914
16915 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
16916 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
16917
16918 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
16919 {
16920 Elf64_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
16921
16922 if (sdyn == NULL || htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
16923 abort ();
16924
16925 dyncon = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
16926 dynconend = (Elf64_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
16927 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
16928 {
16929 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
16930 asection *s;
16931
16932 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
16933
16934 switch (dyn.d_tag)
16935 {
16936 default:
16937 continue;
16938
16939 case DT_PPC64_GLINK:
16940 s = htab->glink;
16941 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
16942 /* We stupidly defined DT_PPC64_GLINK to be the start
16943 of glink rather than the first entry point, which is
16944 what ld.so needs, and now have a bigger stub to
16945 support automatic multiple TOCs. */
16946 dyn.d_un.d_ptr += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE_SIZE (htab) - 8 * 4;
16947 break;
16948
16949 case DT_PPC64_OPD:
16950 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
16951 if (s == NULL)
16952 continue;
16953 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
16954 break;
16955
16956 case DT_PPC64_OPT:
16957 if ((htab->do_multi_toc && htab->multi_toc_needed)
16958 || htab->notoc_plt)
16959 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_MULTI_TOC;
16960 if (htab->has_plt_localentry0)
16961 dyn.d_un.d_val |= PPC64_OPT_LOCALENTRY;
16962 break;
16963
16964 case DT_PPC64_OPDSZ:
16965 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".opd");
16966 if (s == NULL)
16967 continue;
16968 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size;
16969 break;
16970
16971 case DT_PLTGOT:
16972 s = htab->elf.splt;
16973 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
16974 break;
16975
16976 case DT_JMPREL:
16977 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
16978 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
16979 break;
16980
16981 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
16982 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
16983 break;
16984
16985 case DT_TEXTREL:
16986 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
16987 info->callbacks->einfo
16988 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
16989 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
16990 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
16991 info->callbacks->einfo
16992 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
16993 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
16994 continue;
16995 }
16996
16997 bfd_elf64_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
16998 }
16999 }
17000
17001 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->elf.sgot->size != 0
17002 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17003 {
17004 /* Fill in the first entry in the global offset table.
17005 We use it to hold the link-time TOCbase. */
17006 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd,
17007 elf_gp (output_bfd) + TOC_BASE_OFF,
17008 htab->elf.sgot->contents);
17009
17010 /* Set .got entry size. */
17011 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17012 = 8;
17013 }
17014
17015 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
17016 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
17017 {
17018 /* Set .plt entry size. */
17019 elf_section_data (htab->elf.splt->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
17020 = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE (htab);
17021 }
17022
17023 /* brlt is SEC_LINKER_CREATED, so we need to write out relocs for
17024 brlt ourselves if emitrelocations. */
17025 if (htab->brlt != NULL
17026 && htab->brlt->reloc_count != 0
17027 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17028 htab->brlt,
17029 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->rela.hdr,
17030 elf_section_data (htab->brlt)->relocs,
17031 NULL))
17032 return FALSE;
17033
17034 if (htab->glink != NULL
17035 && htab->glink->reloc_count != 0
17036 && !_bfd_elf_link_output_relocs (output_bfd,
17037 htab->glink,
17038 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->rela.hdr,
17039 elf_section_data (htab->glink)->relocs,
17040 NULL))
17041 return FALSE;
17042
17043
17044 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
17045 && htab->glink_eh_frame->size != 0
17046 && htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
17047 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
17048 htab->glink_eh_frame,
17049 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
17050 return FALSE;
17051
17052 /* We need to handle writing out multiple GOT sections ourselves,
17053 since we didn't add them to DYNOBJ. We know dynobj is the first
17054 bfd. */
17055 while ((dynobj = dynobj->link.next) != NULL)
17056 {
17057 asection *s;
17058
17059 if (!is_ppc64_elf (dynobj))
17060 continue;
17061
17062 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->got;
17063 if (s != NULL
17064 && s->size != 0
17065 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17066 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17067 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17068 s->size))
17069 return FALSE;
17070 s = ppc64_elf_tdata (dynobj)->relgot;
17071 if (s != NULL
17072 && s->size != 0
17073 && s->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr
17074 && !bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, s->output_section,
17075 s->contents, s->output_offset,
17076 s->size))
17077 return FALSE;
17078 }
17079
17080 return TRUE;
17081 }
17082
17083 #include "elf64-target.h"
17084
17085 /* FreeBSD support */
17086
17087 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
17088 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
17089
17090 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
17091 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf64_fbsd_vec
17092 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
17093 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf64-powerpc-freebsd"
17094
17095 #undef ELF_OSABI
17096 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
17097
17098 #undef elf64_bed
17099 #define elf64_bed elf64_powerpc_fbsd_bed
17100
17101 #include "elf64-target.h"
This page took 0.56245 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.